Manual TTL
Manual TTL
1
FAST/LS TTL
2 Circuit Characteristics
Design Considerations,
3 Testing and Applications
Assistance Form
5 LS Data Sheets
6 Reliability Data
Package Information
7 Including
Surface Mount
Selection Information
1
FAST/LS TTL
Circuit Characteristics 2
Design Considerations,
Testing and Applications 3
Assistance Form
LS Data Sheets 5
Reliability Data 6
Package Information
Including 7
Surface Mount
DATA CLASSIFICATION
Product Preview
This heading on a data sheet
DATA CLASSIFICATION
Product Preview
This heading on a data sheet indicates that the device is in the formative
stages or in design (under development). This disclaimer at the bottom
of the first page reads: “This document contains information on a product
under development. Motorola reserves the right to change or discontinue
this product without notice.”
Advance Information
This heading on a data sheet indicates that the device is in sampling,
preproduction, or first production stages. The disclaimer at the bottom of
the first page reads: “This document contains information on a new
product. Specifications and information herein are subject to change
without notice.”
Fully Released
A fully released data sheet contains neither a classification heading nor
a disclaimer at the bottom of the first page. This document contains
information on a product in full production. Guaranteed limits will not be
changed without written notice to your local Motorola Semiconductor
Sales Office.
Low Power Schottky (LSTTL) has become the industry standard logic in recent years, replacing the
original 7400 TTL with lower power and higher speeds. In addition to offering the standard LS TTL
circuits, Motorola offers the FAST Schottky and TTL family. Complete specifications for each of these
families are provided in data sheet form. Functional selector guides not only provide an overview of
already introduced devices but planned introduction dates of new products.
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola
makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any
particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any
product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation
consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters can and do vary in different applications.
All operating parameters, including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by
customer’s technical experts. Motorola does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the
rights of others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components
in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or
sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a
situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products
for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and
its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs,
damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim
of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim
alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. Motorola and
are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative
Action Employer.
Fifth Edition
First Printing
Motorola Inc., 1992
Previous Edition Q1/1989
“All Rights Reserved”
Page
INDEX OF DEVICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ii
MC74F323 8-Input Shift/Storage Register with Synchronous Reset and Common I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . 4-154
MC54/74F350 4-Bit Shifter/3-State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-157
MC54/74F352 Dual 4-Input Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-161
MC54/74F353 Dual 4-Input Multiplexer/3-State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-164
MC54/74F365 Hex Buffer, Non-Inverting, 3-State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-167
MC74F657B Octal Bidirectional Transceiver with 8-Bit Parity Generator/Checker, 3-State . . . . . . . . . . . 4-254
MC74F779 8-Bit Bidirectional Binary Counter (3-State) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-259
MC74F803 Clock Driver, Quad D-Type Flip-Flop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-263
MC54/74F827 10-Bit Buffer, Line Driver, Non-Inverting, 3-State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-266
MC54/74F828 10-Bit Buffer, Line Driver, Inverting, 3-State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-266
Abbreviations
S = Synchronous
A = Asynchronous
B = Both Synchronous and Asynchronous
2S = 2-State Output
3S = 3-State Output
OC = Open-Collector Output
Register Files
Type of
Description Output No. LS FAST
4x4 OC 170 X
3S 670 X
Shift Registers
Mode*
No. of Type of
Description Bits Output SR SL Hold Reset No. LS FAST
Serial In-Parallel Out 8 2S X A 164 X X
Parallel In-Serial Out 8 2S X X 165 X
8 2S X X A 166 X
Parallel In-Parallel Out 4 2S X 95B X
4 2S X X X A 194 X
4 2S X X X A 194A X
4 2S X A 195 X
4 2S X A 195A X
4 3S X A 395 X
Parallel In-Parallel Out, Bidirectional 8 3S X X X A 299 X X
8 3S X X X S 323 X X
Sign Extended Bidirectional 8 3S X X A 322A X
* SR = Shift Right
* SL = Shift Left
* The 48 and 248 have internal pull up resistors to VCC on their outputs.
MSI Flip-Flops/Registers
No. of Type of Set or Clock
Description Bits Output Reset Enable No. LS FAST
D-Type, Non-Inverting 4 3S A X 173A X
4 2S X 377 X X
6 2S A 174 X X
6 2S X 378 X X
8 2S A 273 X
8 3S 374 X X
8 3S 574 X
Quad 2-Port 4 2S A X 398 X X
4 2S A X 399 X X
D-Type, Inverting 8 3S 534 X
8 3S 564
D-Type, Q and Q Outputs 4 2S A 175 X X
4 2S X 379 X X
Clock Drivers
FAMILY CHARACTERISTICS
LS TTL
The Low Power Schottky (LSTTL) family combines a current and power reduction improvement over standard 7400 TTL by a factor
of 5. This is accomplished by using Schottky diode clamping to prevent saturation and advanced processing.
FAST TTL
The FAST Schottky TTL family provides a 75 – 80% power reduction compared to standard Schottky (54/74S) TTL and yet offers a
20 – 40% improvement in circuit performance over the standard Schottky due to the MOSAIC process. Also, FAST circuits contain
additional circuitry to provide a flatter power/frequency curve. The input configuration of FAST uses a lower input current which
translates into higher fanout.
CIRCUIT FEATURES
Circuit features of LS and FAST are best understood by examining the TTL 2-input NAND gate of each family (Figures 2-1a, b). The
input/output circuits of other functions are almost identical.
VCC
110 Ω
18K 7.6K
A
D3 Q2
D1
Q4
5K
OUTPUT
B Q1
D4 15K Q5
D2
2.8K 3.5K
Q3
VCC
35 Ω
D5 Q6
A
D3 Q2
D1
Q4
D6 5K
D4 OUTPUT
B Q1
Q5 D10
D2
D8 D9
15K 2K 3K
D7
Q3 Q9
VCC VCC
INPUT CHARACTERISTICS — Figure 2-4 shows the typical input characteristics of LS and FAST. Typical transfer characteris-
tics can be found in Figure 2-5 and input threshold variation with temperature information is provided in Table 2-1.
5
0 TA = 25°C
V OUT , OUTPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
VCC = 5 V
4
–100
LS
FAST 3
I IN ( µA)
–200 LS
FAST
2
–300
TA = 25°C 1
–400 VCC = 5 V
0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5
VIN (VOLTS) VIN, INPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
Figure 2-4. Typical Input Current Figure 2-5. Typical Output versus Input
versus Input Voltage Voltage Characteristic
OUTPUT CONFIGURATION. The output circuitry of LSTTL has several features not found in conventional TTL. A few of these
features are discussed below.
Referring to Figures 2-1a, b, the base of the pull-down output transistor Q5 is returned to ground through Q3 and a pair of resis-
tors instead of through a simple resistor. This arrangement is called a squaring network since it squares up the transfer characteris-
tics (Figure 2-5) by preventing conduction in the phase splitter Q1 until the input voltage rises high enough to allow Q1 to supply
base current to Q5. The squaring network also improves the propagation delay by providing a low resistance path to discharge
capacitance at the base of Q5 during turn-off.
The output pull-up circuit is a 2-transistor Darlington circuit with the base of the output transistor returned through a 5.0K resistor
to the output terminals, unlike 74H and 74S where it is returned to ground which is a more power consuming configuration. This
configuration allows the output to pull up to one VBE below VCC for low values of output current.
The F00 output includes clamping diodes to limit undershoot and control ringing on long signal lines. As with the input diode
clamps, these diodes are intended for transient suppression only and should not be used as steady-state clamps.
The F00 output configuration also includes additional circuitry to improve the rise time and decrease the power consumption at
high operating frequencies. This circuit, which consists of Q9, D7, D8, and D9 causes Q5 to off more quickly on LOW to HIGH
output transitions.
Figure 2-6 shows the extra circuitry used to obtain the “high Z” condition in 3-state outputs. When the Output Enable signal is
HIGH, both the phase splitter and the Darlington pull-up are turned off. In this condition the output circuitry is non-conducting, which
allows the outputs of two or more such circuits to be connected together in a bus application wherein only one output is enabled at
any particular time.
FAST 3-state outputs have some additional circuitry due to the nature of the environment in which they are used. The effective
capacitive load of a 3-state output tends to increase at high bus rates. The addition of Q10 reduces this effect by clamping the base
of Q5 low when the device is in the high impedance state. In the high Z state, the output capacitance is about 5.0 pF for 24 mA
outputs and about 12 pF for 64 mA outputs.
An additional feature of many FAST 3-state devices is the incorporation of power-up circuitry to guarantee that the output will
not sink current if the device is disabled during the application or removal of power.
VCC
OUTPUT
FROM (FAST ONLY)
LOGIC Q5
ACTIVE
PULLDOWN
OUTPUT
Q10
ENABLE FAST ONLY
OUTPUT CHARACTERISTICS. Figure 2-7 shows the LOW-state output characteristics for LS and FAST. For LOW IOL values,
the pull-down transistor is clamped out of deep saturation to shorten the turn-off delay. Figure 2-8 shows the HIGH-state output
characteristics.
F240
F00
0.5
0.5
0
0
0 20 40 60 50 100 150 200
IOL, OUTPUT CURRENT (mA) IOL, OUTPUT CURRENT (mA)
Figure 2-7a. Output Low Characteristic Figure 2-7b. Output Low Characteristic
4 4
V OH, OUTPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
3 3
LS240
F240
2 2
LS00 F00
1 1
0 0
–50 –100 –150 –50 –100 –150 –200
IOH, OUTPUT CURRENT (mA) IOH, OUTPUT CURRENT (mA)
Figure 2-8a. Output High Characteristic Figure 2-8b. Output High Characteristic
AC SWITCHING CHARACTERISTICS. The propagation through a logic element depends on power supply voltage, ambient tem-
perature, and output load. The effect of each of these parameters on ac propagation is shown in Figures 2-9 through 2-11.
Propagation delays are specified with only one output switching, the delay through a logic-element will increase to some extent
when multiple outputs switch simultaneously due to inductance internal to the IC package. This effect can be seen by comparing
Figures 2-11c and 2-11d.
For LS TTL, limits are guaranteed at 25°C, VCC = 5.0 V, and CL = 15 pF (normally, resistive load has minimal effect on propagation
delay) FAST and TTL limits are guaranteed over the commercial or military temperature and supply voltage ranges and with CL =
50 pF.
+4 +4
VCC = 5 V TA = +25°C
t PD , PROPAGATION DELAY CHANGE (ns)
CL = 15 pF CL = 15 pF
LS00 LS00
+2 +2
tPLH
tPLH
0 0
tPHL
tPHL
–2 –2
–4 –4
–75 –25 +25 +75 +125 4.5 4.75 5 5.25 5.5
TA, AMBIENT TEMPERATURE (°C) VCC, SUPPLY VOLTAGE (V)
3
4
20 20
t PD , PROPAGATION DELAY (ns)
tPHL
tPHL
10 10
VCC = 5 V
VCC = 5 V TA = 25°C
TA = 25°C F240
F240 All Outputs Driven
0 0
0 500 1000 0 500 1000
CL, LOAD CAPACITANCE (pF) CL, LOAD CAPACITANCE (pF)
*Data for Figures 2-11a through 2-11c was taken with only one output switching at a time. Figure 2-11d data was taken with all 8 inputs of the F240 tied together.
LS/FAST ESD CHARACTERISTICS. Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitivity for Motorola TTL is characterized using several
methodologies (HBM, MM, CDM). It is extremely important to understand that ESD sensitivity values alone are not sufficient when
comparing devices. In an attempt to reduce correlation problems between various pieces of test equipment, all of which meet
Mil-Std-883C requirements, tester specific information as well as actual device ESD hardness levels are given in controlled docu-
ments and are available upon request. The continuing improvements of ESD sensitivity through redesigns of Motorola TTL has
resulted in minimum ESD levels for all new products and redesigns of >4000 volts for FAST and >3500 volts for LS. For device
specific values reference the following specifications:
NOISE IMMUNITY. When mixing TTL families it is often desirable to know the guaranteed noise immunity for both LOW and HIGH
logic levels. Table 3.1 lists the guaranteed logic levels for various TTL families and can be used to calculate noise margin. Table 3.2
specifies these noise margins for systems containing LS, S, ALS and/or FAST TTL. Note that Table 3.2 represents “worst case”
limits and assumes a maximum power supply and temperature variation across the IC’s which are interconnected, as well as maxi-
mum rated load. Increased noise immunity can be achieved by designing with decreased maximum allowable operating ranges.
Table 3.1
Worst Case TTL Logic Levels
Electrical Characteristics
Military (– 55 to +125°C) Commercial (0 to 70°C)
TTL Families VIL VIH VOL VOH VIL VIH VOL VOH Unit
TTL Standard TTL 9000, 54/74 0.8 2.0 0.4 2.4 0.8 2.0 0.4 2.4 V
HTTL High Speed TTL 54/74H 0.8 2.0 0.4 2.4 0.8 2.0 0.4 2.4 V
LPTTL Low Power TTL 93L00 (MSI) 0.7 2.0 0.3 2.4 0.8 2.0 0.3 2.4 V
STTL Schottky TTL 54/74S, 93S00 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.5 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.7 V
LSTTL Low Power Schottky TTL 54/74LS 0.7 2.0 0.4 2.5 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.7 V
ALS TTL (5% VCC) Advanced LS TTL, 54/74ALS 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.75 V
(10% VCC) 0.8 2.0 0.4 2.5 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.5 V
FAST TTL (5% VCC) Advanced S TTL, 54/74F 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.7 V
(10% VCC) 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.5 0.8 2.0 0.5 2.5 V
VOL and VOH are the voltages generated at the output VIL and VIH are the voltage required at the input to generate the appropriate levels. The
numbers given above are guaranteed worst-case values.
POWER CONSUMPTION. With the exception of ECL, all logic families exhibit increased power consumption at high frequencies.
Care must be taken when switching multiple gates at high frequencies to assure that their combined dissipation does not exceed
package and/or device capabilities. TTL devices are more efficient at high frequencies than CMOS.
Input loading and output drive factors of all products described in this handbook are related to these definitions.
2. The 74LS95B which has a value of IIL = 0.8 mA and IIH of 40 µA on the CP terminal, is specified as having an input LOW load
factor of:
0.8 mA 40 µA
or 0.5 U.L. and an input HIGH load factor of or 1 U.L.
1.6 mA 40 µA
3. The 74LS00 gate which has an IIL of 0.4 mA and an IIH of 20 µA, has an input LOW load factor of:
0.4 mA 20 µA
or 0.25 U.L. an input HIGH load factor of or 0.5 U.L.
1.6 mA 40 µA
800 µA
or 20 U.L.
40 µA
2. The output of the 74LS00 will sink 8.0 mA in the LOW state and source 400 µA in the HIGH state. The normalized output LOW
drive factor is:
8.0 mA
= 5 U.L.
1.6 mA
400 µA
or 10 U.L.
40 µA
Relative load and drive factors for the basic TTL families are given in Table 3.3.
Table 3.3
Values for MSI devices vary significantly from one element to another. Consult the appropriate data sheet for actual characteristics.
where:
Example: Four 74LS03 gate outputs driving four other LS gates or MSI inputs.
N1 =4
N2 (HIGH) = 4 • 0.5 U.L. = 2 U.L.
N2 (LOW) = 4 • 0.25 U.L. = 1 U.L.
IOH = 100 µA
IOL = 8.0 mA
VOL = 0.5 V
VOH = 2.4 V
Any value of pull-up resistor between 742 Ω and 4.9 kΩ can be used. The lower values yield the fastest speeds while the higher
values yield the lowest power dissipation.
UNUSED INPUTS. For best noise immunity and switching speed, unused TTL inputs should not be left floating, but should be held
between 2.4 V and the absolute maximum input voltage.
1. Connect unused input to VCC, LS and FAST TTL inputs have a breakdown voltage > 7.0 V and require, therefore no series
resistor.
2. Connect the unused input to the output of an unused gate that is forced HIGH.
CAUTION: Do not connect an unused LS or FAST input to another input of the same NAND or AND function. This method,
recommended for normal TTL, increases the input coupling capacitance and thus reduces the ac noise immunity.
INPUT CAPACITANCE. As a rule of thumb, LS and FAST TTL inputs have an average capacitance of 5.0 pF for DIP packages.
For an input that serves more than one internal function, each additional function adds approximately 1.5 pF.
OUTPUT RISE AND FALL TIMES provide important information in determining reflection waveforms and crosstalk coefficients.
Typical rise and fall times are approximately 6 ns for LS and about 2.0 ns for FAST with a 50 pF load (measured 10 – 90%). Output
rise and fall times become longer as capacitive load is increased.
INTERCONNECTION DELAYS. For those parts of a system in which timing is critical, designers should take into account the finite
delay along the interconnections. These range from about 0.12 to 0.15 ns/inch for the type of interconnections normally used in TTL
systems. Exceptions occur in systems using ground planes to reduce ground noise during a logic transition; ground planes give
higher distributed capacitance and delays of about 0.15 to 0.22 ns/inch.
Most interconnections on a logic board are short enough that the wiring and load capacitance can be treated as a lumped capaci-
tance for purposes of estimating their effect on the propagation delay of the driving circuit. When an interconnection is long enough
that its delay is one-fourth to one-half of the signal transition time, the driver output waveform exhibits noticeable slope changes
during a transition. This is evidence that during the initial portion of the output voltage transition the driver sees the characteristic
impedance of the interconnection (normally 100 Ω to 200 Ω), which for transient conditions appears as a resistor returned to the
quiescent voltage existing just before the beginning of the transition. This characteristic impedance forms a voltage divider with the
driver output impedance, tending to produce a signal transition having the same rise or fall time as in the no-load condition but with a
reduced amplitude. This attenuated signal travels to the far end of the interconnection, which is essentially an unterminated trans-
mission line, whereupon the signal starts doubling. Simultaneously, a reflection voltage is generated which has the same amplitude
and polarity as the original signal, e.g., if the driver output signal is positive-going the reflection will be positive-going, and as it
travels back toward the driver it adds to the line voltage. At the instant the reflection arrives at the driver it adds algebraically to the
still-rising driver output, accelerating the transition rate and producing the noticeable change in slope.
Table 3.4
Output Characteristics for Schottky TTL Logic
If an interconnection is of such length that its delay is longer than half the signal transition time, the attenuated output of the driver
has time to reach substantial completion before the reflection arrives. In the limit, the waveform observed at the driver output is a
2-step signal with a pedestal. In this circumstance the first load circuit to receive a full signal is the one at the far end, because of the
doubling effect, while the last one to receive a full signal is the one nearest the driver since it must wait for the reflection to complete
the transition. Thus, in a worst-case situation, the net contribution to the overall delay is twice the delay of the interconnection be-
cause the initial part of the signal must travel to the far end of the line and the reflection must return.
When load circuits are distributed along an interconnection, the input capacitance of each will cause a small reflection having a
polarity opposite that of the signal transition, and each capacitance also slows the transition rate of the signal as it passes by. The
series of small reflections, arriving back at the driver, is subtractive and has the effect of reducing the apparent amplitude of the
signal. The successive slowing of the transition rate of the transmitted signal means that it takes longer for the signal to rise or fall to
the threshold level of any particular load circuit. A rough but workable approach is to treat the load capacitances as an increase in
the intrinsic distributed capacitance of the interconnection. Increasing the distributed capacitance of a transmission line reduces its
impedance and increases its delay. A good approximation for ordinary TTL interconnections is that distributed load capacitance
decreases the characteristic impedance by about one-third and increases the delay by one-half.
CHARACTERISTIC LS FAST
Storage Temperature – 65°C to + 150°C – 65°C to + 150°C
Temperature (Ambient) Under Bias – 55°C to + 125°C – 55°C to + 125°C
VCC Pin Potential to Ground Pin – 0.5 V to + 7.0 V – 0.5 V to + 7.0 V
*Input Voltage (dc) Diode Inputs – 0.5 V to 15 V – 0.5 V to 7.0 V
*Input Current (dc) – 30 mA to + 5.0 mA – 30 mA to + 5.0 mA
Voltage Applied to Open Collector
Outputs (Output HIGH) – 0.5 V to + 10 V – 0.5 V to + 5.5 V
High Level Voltage Applied to
Disabled 3-State Output 5.5 V 5.5 V
Current Applied to Output
in Low State (Max) Twice Rated IOL Twice Rated IOL
*Either input voltage limit or input current limit is sufficient to protect the inputs — Circuits with 5.5 V maximum limits
*are listed below.
VOLTAGES — All voltages are referenced to ground. Negative voltage limits are specified as absolute values (i.e., – 10 V is
greater than –1.0 V).
VCC Supply voltage — The range of power supply voltage over which the device is guaranteed to operate within the
specified limits.
VIK(MAX) Input clamp diode voltage — The most negative voltage at an input when the specified current is forced out
of that input terminal. This parameter guarantees the integrity of the input diode which is intended to clamp nega-
tive ringing at the input terminal.
VIH Input HIGH voltage — The range of input voltages recognized by the device as a logic HIGH.
VIH(MIN) Minimum input HIGH voltage — The minimum allowed input HIGH in a logic system. This value represents the
guaranteed input HIGH threshold for the device.
VIL Input LOW voltage — The range of input voltages recognized by the device as a logic LOW.
VIL(MAX) Maximum input LOW voltage — The maximum allowed input LOW in a system. This value represents the
guaranteed input LOW threshold for the device.
VOH(MIN) Output HIGH voltage — The minimum guaranteed voltage at an output terminal for the specified output current
IOH and at the minimum value of VCC.
VOL(MAX) Output LOW voltage — The maximum guaranteed voltage at an output terminal sinking the maximum specified
load current IOL.
VT+ Positive-going threshold voltage — The input voltage of a variable threshold device (ie., Schmitt Trigger) that
is interpreted as a VIH as the input transition rises from below VT–(MIN).
VT– Negative-going threshold voltage — The input voltage of a variable threshold device (ie., Schmitt Trigger) that
is interpreted as a VIL as the input transition falls from above VT+(MAX).
VIN VIN
tPHL tPLH tPHL
Vout tPLH
Vout
tr tf
90% 90%
10% 10%
Enable
Enable tPHZ
tPZH
VOH ≈ 3.5 V
.5 for LS
.3 for FAST
Vout
Enable
Enable
tPLZ
tPZL
Vout
VOZ = 1.5 V
.5 for LS
.3 for FAST
Asynch
Asynch
trec
Control
th Hold Time
The interval of time from the active edge of the control signal (usually the clock) to when the data to be recognized
is no longer required to ensure proper interpretation of the data. A negative hold time indicates that the data may
be removed at some time prior to the active edge of the control signal.
ts Setup time
The interval of time during which the data to be recognized is required to remain constant prior to the active edge
of the control signal to ensure proper data recognition. A negative setup time indicates that data may be initiated
sometime after the active transition of the timing pulse and still be recognized.
VIN VIN
CP CP
twL
twH
TESTING
DC TEST CIRCUITS
The following test circuits and forcing functions represent Motorola’s typical DC test procedures.
VOH AND VOL TESTS IIHH, IIH AND IIL TESTS IOS TEST
Force IOHMAX or IOLMAX Force 7, 5.5, 2.7, or 0.4 V Measure
Measure VOH or VOL Measure IIHH, IIH, or IIL IOS
VIHMIN
DUT
or VILMAX
VIHMIN DUT
DUT +
or VILMAX
Io Vi
Vo
Ii = –18 mA GND
Vik ± Vo DUT Outputs
or
Open
4.5 V*
–
*Unless otherwise indicated, input conditions are selected to produce a worst case condition.
Testing noise (noise generated by the test system itself and noise generated by TTL devices under test interacting with the test
system) adds to, or subtracts from the threshold voltage applied to the TTL device under test. For this reason Motorola does not
recommend functional testing of TTL devices using threshold levels of 0.8 V and 2.0 V. Instead, good TTL testing techniques call for
hard levels of less than 0.5 V VIL and greater than 2.4 V VIH to be applied for functional testing. Input threshold voltages should be
tested separately, and only (for noise reasons above) after setting the device state with a hard level.
VOH
VOUT Trigger
Threshold
VOL
VIN Dynamic
Threshold
The VIN versus VOUT plot shows the practical effect of testing noise on a logic IC device. The actual device Trigger threshold is
represented by the initial low to high output transition. The device will oscillate if the input voltage does not exceed the trigger thresh-
old plus the noise generated by the interaction of the test system or given application with the device.
The Dynamic threshold (that creates Quiescent outputs), is the input logic level required to overcome the interactive DYNAMIC
NOISE generated by a device switching states. The amount of interactive DYNAMIC NOISE can be characterized by the difference
between the Trigger threshold and the Dynamic threshold of the device under test. A simple number cannot be assigned to this
parameter as it is heavily dependent on any given application or test environment.
So although the Trigger threshold of any given device will correlate well between any test system, the correlation of “Dynamic”
threshold cannot be made directly and will have meaning only in a relative sense.
RL
VIN
DUT VOUT
PULSE GEN
FAST TEST CIRCUITS
51 Ω 15 pF* +7 V OPEN
*includes all probe and jig capacitance tPZL, tPLZ, O.C. ALL OTHER
R1
Optional LS Load (Guaranteed—Not Tested) 500 Ω
DUT
VCC
R2
50 pF* 500 Ω
RL
*includes all probe and jig capacitance
CL
8) Please describe the device correlation operating parameters as completely as possible for device(s) in question:
> Describe all pin conditions (e.g. floating, high, low, under test, stimulated but not under test, whatever ...), including any input or
output loading conditions (resistors, caps, clamps, driving devices or devices being driven ...). Potentially critical information
includes:
Input waveform timing relationships
Input edge rates
Input Overshoot or Undershoot — Magnitude and Duration
Output Overshoot or Undershoot — Magnitude and Duration
> Photographs, plots or sketches of relevent inputs and outputs with voltages and time divisions clearly identified for all wave-
forms are greatly desirable.
> VCC and Ground waveforms should be carefully described as these characteristics vary greatly between applications and test
systems. Dynamic characteristics of Ground and VCC during device switching can dramatically effect input and internal operat-
ing levels. Ground & VCC measurements should be made as physically close to the device in question as possible.
> Are there specific circumstances that seem to make the questionable unit(s) worse? Better?
Temperature
VCC
Input rise/fall time
Output loading (current/capacitance)
Others
> ATE functional data should include pattern with decoding key and critical parameters such as VCC, input voltages, Func step
rate, voltage expected, time to measure.
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14 CASE 751A-02
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.4 5.0 2.0 7.0 2.4 6.0 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.3 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.3 ns
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14 CASE 751A-02
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.5 2.5 7.5 2.5 6.5 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.3 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.3 ns
HEX INVERTER
FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14 CASE 751A-02
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min MAX Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.4 5.0 2.0 7.0 2.4 6.0 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.3 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.3 ns
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14 CASE 751A-02
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.6 2.5 7.5 3.0 6.6 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 2.5 5.3 2.0 7.5 2.5 6.3 ns
VCC
FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.4 5.0 2.0 7.0 2.4 6.0 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.3 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.3 ns
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.6 2.5 7.5 3.0 6.6 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 2.5 5.5 2.0 7.5 2.5 6.5 ns
VCC D C N/C B A O
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
D SUFFIX
A B N/C C D O GND
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
MC54/74F14
VCC A O A O A O
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A O A O A O GND
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.5
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
IT+ Input Current at Positive-Going Threshold –0.14 mA VCC = 5.0 V, VIN = VT+
IT– Input Current at Negative-Going Threshold –0.18 mA VCC = 5.0 V, VIN = VT–
A B C D O A O
L X X X H L H
X L X X H H L
X X L X H
X X X L H
H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1
CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.4 5.0 2.0 7.0 2.4 6.0 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.3 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.3 ns
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1
CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 5.6 2.0 7.5 2.0 6.6 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 2.5 5.3 2.0 7.5 2.5 6.3 ns
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1
CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.6 3.0 7.5 3.0 6.6 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 3.0 5.3 2.5 7.5 3.0 6.3 ns
QUAD 2-INPUT
NAND BUFFER
VCC A B Y A B Y FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
A B Y A B Y GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1
CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 1.5 5.5 1.5 6.5 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.0 4.5 1.0 5.0 ns
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
A B Y
L L H
L H H
H L H
H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
VCC A B Y A B Y
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A B Y A B Y GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 7.5 12.5 7.5 13 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.0 5.0 1.0 5.5 ns
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
A B Y
L L H
L H H
H L H
H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
A B N/C C D Y GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 1.5 6.0 1.5 7.0 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.0 5.0 1.0 5.5 ns
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
A B C D Y
L X X X H
X L X X H
X X L X H
X X X L H
H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
J SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1A 2A 2B 2C 2D 2Y GND 14
1
FUNCTION TABLE
N SUFFIX
For 3-Input Gates For 2-Input Gates PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
Inputs Inputs Output Inputs Output
1
A B C D E F 1Y A B C D 2Y
H H H X X X L H H X X L
X X X H H H L X X H H L D SUFFIX
SOIC
All other combinations H All other combinations H 14
1
CASE 751A-02
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
1A
1 2A
1B 2 2B
12
1C 3
13 1Y 2Y
1D 8 6
9 2C
1E 4
10 2D
1F 5
11
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 5.5 1.5 7.5 1.5 6.5
ns
tPHL A, B, C, D, E, F, to nY 1.0 4.0 1.0 5.5 1.0 4.5
4-2-3-2-INPUT
AND-OR-INVERT GATE
VCC
FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5 ns
tPHL Propagation Delay 1.5 4.5 1.5 6.5 1.5 5.5 ns
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
VCC CD2 D2 CP2 SD2 Q2 Q2 14
1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
FUNCTION TABLE (Each Half)
Input Outputs
ORDERING INFORMATION
@ tn @ tn + 1
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
D Q Q MC74FXXN Plastic
L L H MC74FXXD SOIC
H H L
Asynchronous Inputs:
LOW Input to SD sets Q to HIGH level LOGIC SYMBOL
LOW Input to CD sets Q to LOW level
Clear and Set are independent of clock
Simultaneous LOW on CD and SD makes both Q and Q HIGH 4 10
1 13
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Q Q
CP
SD
CD
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 100 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.8 6.8 3.8 8.5 3.8 7.8
ns
tPHL CPn to Qn or Qn 4.4 8.0 4.4 10.5 4.4 9.2
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.1 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.1
ns
tPHL CDn or SDn to Qn or Qn 3.5 9.0 3.5 11.5 3.5 10.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 3.0 2.0
ts(L) Dn to CPn 3.0 4.0 3.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 2.0 1.0
th(L) Dn to CPn 1.0 2.0 1.0
tw(H) CPn Pulse Width, HIGH 4.0 4.0 4.0
ns
tw(L) or LOW 5.0 6.0 5.0
tw(L) CDn or SDn Pulse Width, LOW 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
Recovery Time
trec 2.0 3.0 2.0 ns
CDn or SDn to CP
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
N SUFFIX
VCC A3 B2 A2 A1 B1 A0 B0
PLASTIC
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B3 IA<B IA=B IA>B A>B A=B A<B GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
Comparing Inputs Expansion Inputs Outputs
A3, B3 A2, B2 A1, B1 A0, B0 IA > B IA < B IA = B A>B A<B A=B
A3 > B3 X X X X X X H L L
A3 < B3 X X X X X X L H L
A3 = B3 A2 > B2 X X X X X H L L
A3 = B3 A2 < B2 X X X X X L H L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 > B1 X X X X H L L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 < B1 X X X X L H L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 > B0 X X X H L L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 < B0 X X X L H L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 H L L H L L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 L H L L H L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 L L H L L H
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 X X H L L H
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 H H L L L L
A3 = B3 A2 = B2 A1 = B1 A0 = B0 L L L H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
(MSB) B23 B3
A23 A3
B22 B2
The parallel expansion scheme shown in Figure 1 demon-
A22 A2
strates the most efficient general use of these comparators.
B21 B1 A<B In the parallel expansion scheme, the expansion inputs can
A21 A1 A=B NC
B0
be used as a fifth input bit position except on the least signifi-
B20 A>B
A0
cant device which must be connected as in the Serial
A20
Scheme. The expansion inputs are used by labelling IA>B
B19 IA < B
L IA = B
as an “A” input, IA<B as a “B” input and setting IA=B low. The
A19 IA > B
‘F85 can be used as a 5-bit comparator only when the out-
puts are used to drive the (A0-A3) and (B0-B3) inputs of
another ‘F85 device. The parallel technique can be ex-
panded to any number of bits as shown in Table 1.
B18 B3
A18 A3
B17 B2
A17 A2
B16 B1 A<B
A16 A1 A=B NC
B15 B0 A>B
A15 A0
B14 IA < B
L IA = B
A14 IA > B
B13 B3 B3
A13 A3 A3
B12 B2 B2
A12 A2 A2
B11 B1 A<B B1 OUTPUTS
A<B
A11 A1 A=B NC A1 A=B
B10 B0 A>B B0 A>B
A10 A0 A0
B9 IA < B A<B
L IA = B A=B
A9 IA > B A>B
B8 B3
A8 A3
B7 B2
A7 A2
B6 B1 A<B
A6 A1 A=B NC
B5 B0 A>B
A0
Table 1
A5
B4 IA < B
Word Number of Typical Speeds
L IA = B
Length Packages 74F
A4 IA > B
1–4 Bits 1 12 ns
5–25 Bits 2–6 22 ns
B3 B3
A3 A3
25–120 Bits 8–31 34 ns
B2 B2
A2 A2
B1 B1 A<B
A1 A1 A=B
(LSB) B0 B0 A>B
A0 A0
L IA < B
H IA = B
L IA > B
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH A or B Input to 6.0 11 5.5 14 5.5 13
ns
tPHL A < B, A > B Output 6.0 14 5.5 16.5 5.5 15.5
tPLH A or B Input to 5.5 11.5 5.0 15 5.0 14
ns
tPHL A = B Output 7.0 14 6.5 15.5 6.5 14.5
tPLH IA<B and IA=B Input 3.0 7.5 2.5 10 2.5 9.0
ns
tPHL to A>B Output 3.0 9.0 2.5 11 2.5 10
tPLH IA=B Input to 2.5 7.0 2.0 10 2.0 9.0
ns
tPHL A = B Output 3.5 10 2.5 13 2.5 12
tPLH IA>B and IA=B Input 3.0 8.0 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
ns
tPHL to A<B Output 3.0 9.0 2.0 10.5 2.0 9.5
The expansion inputs IA>B, IA=B, and IA<B are the least sig- is added with each additional stage. For proper operation the
nificant bit positions. When used for series expansion, the expansion inputs of the least significant word should be tied
A>B, A=B, and A<B outputs of the least significant word are as follows: IA>B = LOW, IA=B = HIGH, and IA<B = LOW.
connected to the corresponding IA>B, IA=B, and IA<B inputs of
the next higher stage. Stages can be added in this manner
to any length, but a propagation delay penalty of about 15 ns
A3 (15)
B3 (1)
(5)
A>B
A2 (13)
B2 (14)
IA < B (2)
(6)
IA = B (3) A=B
IA > B (4)
A1 (12)
B1 (11)
(7)
A<B
A0 (10)
B0 (9)
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used
to estimate propagation delays.
QUAD 2-INPUT
EXCLUSIVE-OR GATE
FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14
CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXN Plastic
MC74FXXD SOIC
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 3.4 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 3.4 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.35 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 4.0 5.5 2.5 7.0 3.0 6.5
ns
tPHL (Other Input LOW) 3.0 4.2 5.5 3.0 7.0 3.0 6.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 5.3 7.0 3.5 8.5 3.5 8.0
ns
tPHL (Other Input HIGH) 3.0 4.7 6.5 3.0 8.0 3.0 7.5
CD J K CP SD Q
Q J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CD1 CASE 620-09
J1 K1 CP1 SD1 Q1 Q1 16
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CD1 J1 K1 CP1 SD1 Q1 Q1 GND N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
FUNCTION TABLE (Each Half)
Input Output
D SUFFIX
@ tn @ tn + 1 SOIC
16
J K Q Q 1 CASE 751B-03
L H No Change
L L L H
ORDERING INFORMATION
H H H L
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
H L Toggles MC74FXXXN Plastic
Asynchronous Inputs: MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOW Input to SD sets Q to HIGH level
LOW Input to CD sets Q to LOW level
Clear and Set are independent of clock
LOGIC SYMBOL
Simultaneous LOW on CD and SD makes both Q and Q HIGH
3 K C Q 7 13 K Q 9
D CD
1 15
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
Q Q
CP
SD
CD
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations
and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 PF CL = 50 PF CL = 50 PF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 125 70 90 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.8 5.3 7.0 3.8 9.0 3.8 8.0
ns
tPHL CPn to Qn or Qn 4.4 6.2 8.0 4.4 10.5 4.4 9.2
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.2 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
ns
tPHL CDn or SDn to Qn or Qn 3.5 7.0 9.0 3.5 11.5 3.5 10.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.0 3.0
ts(L) Jn or Kn to CPn 3.0 3.0 3.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0 1.0
th(L) Jn or Kn to CPn 1.0 1.0 1.0
tw(H) CPn Pulse Width, HIGH 4.0 4.0 4.0
ns
tw(L) or LOW 5.0 5.0 5.0
tw(L) CDn or SDn Pulse Width, LOW 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
Recovery Time
trec 2.0 2.0 2.0 ns
CDn or SDn to CP
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
VCC CD1 CD2 CP2 K2 J2 SD2 Q2 J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 CASE 620-09
16
C S 1
K D Q J D Q
CP CP
J Q K Q N SUFFIX
SD CD
PLASTIC
16
CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
CP1 K1 J1 SD1 Q1 Q1 Q2 GND
15 14
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
Q Q
CD SD
J K
CP
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 PF CL = 50 PF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 110 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 6.5 2.0 7.5
ns
tPHL CPn to Qn or Qn 2.0 6.5 2.0 7.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 6.5 2.0 7.5
ns
tPHL CDn or SDn to Qn or Qn 2.0 6.5 2.0 7.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
ts (H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 4.0
ts (L) Jn or Kn to CPn 3.0 3.0
ns
th (H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
th (L) Jn or Kn to CPn 0 0
tw (H) CPn Pulse Width, HIGH 4.5 4.5
ns
tw (L) or LOW 4.5 4.5
tw (L) CDn or SDn Pulse Width, LOW 4.5 4.5 ns
Recovery Time
trec 4.0 5.0 ns
CDn or SDn to CP
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1C 1A 1Y 2C 2A 2Y GND
MC54/74F126 N SUFFIX
VCC 4C 4A 4Y 3C 3A 3Y PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1C 1A 1Y 2C 2A 2Y GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
IOZL Output Off Current LOW –50 µA VOUT = 0.5 V VCC = MAX
IIH Input HIGH Current 20 VIN = 2.7 V VCC = MAX
100 µA VIN = 7.0 V VCC = 0 V
IIL Input LOW Current –20 µA VIN = 0.5 V VCC = MAX
IOS Output Short Ciru‘cuit Current Note 2 –100 –225 mA VOUT = GND VCC = MAX
ICCH 24
F125 ICCL 40
ICCZ 35
mA VCC = MAX
ICC ICCH 30
F126 ICCL 48
ICCZ 39
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25 °C TA = 0°C to 70°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, F125 1.5 4.0 6.0 1.5 7.5 1.5 6.5 ns
tPHL nA to nY 3.0 5.5 7.5 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 5.5 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPZL to HIGH and LOW level 3.0 6.0 8.0 3.0 10 3.0 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.5 3.5 5.0 1.5 7.0 1.5 6.0 ns
tPLZ from HIGH and LOW level 1.5 3.5 5.5 1.5 7.0 1.5 6.0
tPLH Propagation Delay, F126 1.5 4.0 6.5 1.5 8.0 1.5 7.0 ns
tPHL nA to nY 3.0 5.5 8.0 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 6.0 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPZL to HIGH and LOW level 3.0 6.0 8.0 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 4.5 6.5 2.0 8.5 2.0 7.5 ns
tPLZ from HIGH and LOW level 3.0 5.5 7.5 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
VCC A B Y A B Y N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A B Y A B Y GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
GUARANTEED OPERATING RANGES
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit
VCC Supply Voltage 54,74 4.5 5.0 5.5 V
TA Operating Ambient Temperature Range 54 –55 25 125 °C
74 0 25 70
IOH Output Current — High 54,74 –1.0 mA
IOL Output Current — Low 54,74 20 mA
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
A B Y
L L H
L H H
H L H
H H L
H = HIGH Voltage level
L= LOW voltage level
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54,74 2.5 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
IT+ Input Current at Positive-Going Threshold 0 µA VCC = 5.0 V, VIN = VT+
IT– Input Current at Negative-Going Threshold –350 µA VCC = 5.0 V, VIN = VT–
ICC Total, Supply Current ICCH 8.5 12 mA VIN = GND VCC = MAX
ICCL 13 19.5 VIN = 4.5 V
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation delay 3.5 5.5 7.0 3.5 9.0 3.5 8.0
ns
tPHL A, B to Y 3.0 5.0 6.5 3.0 8.0 3.0 7.0
4-52
MC54/74F138
1-OF-8 DECODER/
DEMULTIPLEXER
The MC54/74F138 is a high speed 1-of-8 Decoder/Demultiplexer. This de-
vice is ideally suited for high speed bipolar memory chip select address de-
coding. The multiple input enables allow parallel expansion to a 1-of-24 de- 1-OF-8 DECODER/
coder using just three F138 devices or to a 1-of-32 decoder using four F138s DEMULTIPLEXER
and one inverter.
FAST SHOTTKY TTL
• Demultiplexing Capability
• Multiple Input Enable for Easy Expansion
• Active Low Mutually Exclusive Outputs
• Input Clamp Diodes Limit High-Speed Termination Effects
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW)
CERAMIC
VCC O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 CASE 620-09
16
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1
A0 A1 A2 E1 E2 E3 O7 GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
LOGIC SYMBOL
1 2 3 456
1 2 3
A0 A1 A2
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
7 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 7
O7 O6 O5 O4 O3 O2 O1 O0 VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25 °C TA = +25°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
Levels VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
of CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Delay Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, 3 3.0 7.5 3.0 12 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL Address to Output 3.0 8.0 3.0 9.5 3.0 9.0
tPLH Enable to Output 2 3.5 7.0 3.5 11 3.5 8.0 ns
tPHL E1 or E2 3.0 7.0 3.0 8.0 3.0 7.5
tPLH Enable to Output 3 4.0 8.0 4.0 12.5 4.0 9.0 ns
tPHL E3 3.5 7.5 3.5 8.5 3.5 8.5
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The decoder accepts three binary weighted inputs (AO, A1, expansion of the device to a 1-of-32 (5 lines to 32 lines)
A2) and when enabled provides eight mutually exclusive decoder with just four F138s and one inverter.
active LOW outputs (O0–O7). The F138 features three Enable The F138 can be used as an 8-output demultiplexer by
inputs, two active LOW (E1, E2) and one active HIGH (E3). All using one of the active LOW Enable inputs as the data input
outputs will be HIGH unless E1 and E2 are LOW and E3 is and the other Enable inputs as strobes. The Enable inputs
HIGH. This multiple enable function allows easy parallel which are not used must be permanently tied to their
appropriate active HIGH or active LOW states.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
E1 E2 E3 A0 A1 A2 O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
H X X X X X H H H H H H H H
X H X X X X H H H H H H H H
X X L X X X H H H H H H H H
L L H L L L L H H H H H H H
L L H H L L H L H H H H H H
L L H L H L H H L H H H H H
L L H H H L H H H L H H H H
L L H L L H H H H H L H H H
L L H H L H H H H H H L H H
L L H L H H H H H H H H L H
L L H H H H H H H H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
A0
A1
A2
FO4
A3
A4 H
123 123 123 123
A0 A1 A2 E A0 A1 A2 E A 0 A 1 A2 E A0 A1 A2 E
O0 O31
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
CONNECTION DIAGRAM 16
1
VCC Eb A0b A1b O0b O1b O2b O3b
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Ea A0a A1a O0a O1a O2a O3a GND D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
LOGIC SYMBOL
1 2 3 15 14 13
E A0 A1 E A0 A1
O0 O1 O2 O3 O0 O1 O2 O3
4 5 6 7 12 11 10 9 4 5 6 7 12 11 10 9
O0a O1a O2a O3a O0b O1b O2b O3b
VCC = Pin 16
GND = Pin 8
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, 3.5 7.0 2.5 12.0 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL Address to Output 3.5 8.0 3.5 9.5 3.5 9.0
tPLH Enable to Output 3.5 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.5 8.0 ns
tPHL 2.5 6.5 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.5
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F139 is a high speed dual 1-of-4 decoder/demultiplexer Each half of the F139 generates all four miniterms of two
fabricated with the Schottky barrier diode process. The device variables. These four miniterms are useful in some applica-
has two independent decoders, each of which accepts two tions, replacing multiple gate functions as shown in Figure 1,
binary weighted inputs (AO, A1) and provide four mutually ex- and thereby reducing the number of packages required in a
clusive active LOW outputs (O0-O3). Each decoder has an ac- logic network.
tive LOW Enable (E). When E is HIGH all outputs are forced
HIGH. The enable can be used as the data input for a 4-output
demultiplexer application.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
E A0 A1 O0 O1 O2 O3
H X X H H H H
L L L L H H H
L H L H L H H
L L H H H L H
L H H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
E E
A0 O0 A0 O0
A1 A1
E E
A0 O1 A0 O1
A1 A1
E E
A0 O2 A0 O2
A1 A1
E E
A0 O3 A0 O3
A1 A1
Figure 1.
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
VCC EO GS I3 I2 I1 I0 A0 16
1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I4 I5 I6 I7 E1 A2 A1 GND
D SUFFIX
LOGIC DIAGRAM
SOIC
16
(10) 1 CASE 751B-03
I0 (15)
EO
(11) (14)
GS
ORDERING INFORMATION
I1
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
(12) MC74FXXXN Plastic
I2 MC74FXXXD SOIC
(9)
A0
(13)
I3
LOGIC SYMBOL
(1)
I4
(7) 10 11 12 13 1 2 3 4 5
(2) A1
I5
I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 E1
(3)
I6
EO A0 A1 A2 GS
(4) (6)
I7 A2
(5) 15 9 7 6 14
E1
VCC = PIN 16
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not GND = PIN 8
be used to estimate propagation delays.
74 0 25 70
IOH Output Current — High 54, 74 –1.0 mA
IOL Output Current — Low 54, 74 20 mA
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F148 8-input priority encoder accepts data from eight erroneous information at the outputs. A Group Signal output
active LOW inputs (I0–I7) and provides a binary representa- (GS) and Enable Output (EO) are provided along with the
tion on the three active LOW outputs. A priority is assigned to three priority data outputs (A2, A1, A0). GS is active LOW when
each input so that when two or more inputs are simultaneously any input is LOW; this indicates when any input is active. EO
active, the input with the highest priority is represented on the is active LOW when all inputs are HIGH. Using the Enable
output, with input line 7 having the highest priority. A HIGH on Output along with the Enable Input allows cascading for prior-
the Enable Input (E1) will force all outputs to the inactive ity encoding on any number of input signals. Both EO and GS
(HIGH) state and allow new data to settle without producing are in the inactive HIGH state when the Enable Input is HIGH.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
E1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 GS A0 A1 A2 EO
H X X X X X X X X H H H H H
L H H H H H H H H H H H H L
L X X X X X X X L L L L L H
L X X X X X X L H L H L L H
L X X X X X L H H L L H L H
L X X X X L H H H L H H L H
L X X X L H H H H L L L H H
L X X L H H H H H L H L H H
L X L H H H H H H L L H H H
L L H H H H H H H L H H H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
LSB MSB
ENABLE
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 E1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 E1
’F148 ’F148
A0 A1 A2 GS EO A0 A1 A2 GS
A0 A1 A2 A3 FLAG
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 7.0 9.0 3.5 11 3.5 10
ns
tPHL In to An 4.0 8.0 10.5 4.0 13 4.0 12
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.0 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5
ns
tPHL In to EO 2.0 5.5 7.5 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.0 9.0 3.0 11 3.0 10
ns
tPHL In to GS 2.0 6.0 8.0 2.0 10 2.0 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 6.5 8.5 3.5 10.5 3.5 9.5
ns
tPHL E1 to An 3.0 6.0 8.0 3.0 10 3.0 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.0 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
ns
tPHL E1 to GS 3.0 6.0 7.5 3.0 10 3.0 8.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.5 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
ns
tPHL E1 to EO 4.5 8.0 10.5 4.5 13 4.5 12
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I3 I2 I1 I0 Z Z E GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM 16
1 CASE 751B-03
I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7
S2
S1
ORDERING INFORMATION
S0 MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
E MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
Z Z 12 I7
FUNCTION TABLE 13 I6
14 I5 Z 5
Inputs Outputs 15 I4
E S2 S1 S0 Z Z 1 I3
H X X X H L 2 I2
3 I1 Z 6
L L L L I0 I0
4 I0
L L L H I1 I1
7 ES S S
L L H L I2 I2 0 1 2
L L H H I3 I3
L H L L I4 I4 11 10 9
L H L H I5 I5
L H H L I6 I6 VCC = PIN 16
L H H H I7 I7 GND = PIN 8
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.5 3.4 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.50 V
74 2.7 3.4 V IOH = –1.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.35 0.5 V IOL = 20 mA VCC = MIN
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 8.0 3.5 10 3.5 9.0
ns
tPHL Sn to Z 3.2 6.1 3.0 8.0 3.2 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 13 3.0 17.5 4.0 14
ns
tPHL Sn to Z 4.5 9.0 4.0 11.5 4.0 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.1 2.5 7.5 2.5 7.0
ns
tPHL E to Z 3.0 8.5 2.5 10.5 2.5 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 9.5 3.0 14.5 4.0 11
ns
tPHL E to Z 3.5 7.0 3.0 9.5 3.5 8.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.7 2.5 7.5 2.5 6.5
ns
tPHL In to Z 1.5 4.0 1.5 6.0 1.5 5.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 9.5 2.5 11.5 2.5 11 ns
tPHL In to Z 3.0 6.5 3.0 8.0 3.0 7.5
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
VCC = PIN 16
7 GND = PIN 8 9
= PIN NUMBERS
Za Zb
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
FUNCTION TABLE
Select Inputs Inputs (a or b) Output
S0 S1 E I0 I1 I2 I3 Z
X X H X X X X L
L L L L X X X L
L L L H X X X H
H L L X L X X L
H L L X H X X H
L H L X X L X L
L H L X X H X H
H H L X X X L L
H H L X X X H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 10.5 4.5 14 4.5 12 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 3.5 9.0 3.5 11 3.5 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 9.0 4.5 11.5 4.5 10.5 ns
tPHL En to Zn 3.0 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.0 2.5 9.0 3.0 8.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 3.0 6.5 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.5
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
16
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM CASE 648-08
16
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d E S
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
Za Zb Zc Zd
1
FUNCTION TABLE S
E 15
Inputs Output
4 Za I0a 2
E S I0 I1 Z I1a 3
H X X X L 7 Zb I0b 5
L H X L L I1b 6
L H X H H 12 Zc I0c 14
I1c 13
L L L X L
I0d 11
L L H X H 9 Zd
I1d 10
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 10 3.5 11 ns
tPHL S to Zn 3.0 7.0 3.0 8.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 9.5 3.5 11 ns
tPHL E to Zn 2.5 6.5 2.5 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5 ns
tPHL In to Zn 2.5 5.5 2.0 7.0
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F157A is a quad 2-input multiplexer. It selects four bits A common use of the F157A is the moving of data from two
of data from two sources under the control of a common Select groups of registers to four common output busses. The partic-
input (S). The Enable input (E) is active LOW. When E is ular register from which the data comes is determined by the
HIGH, all of the outputs (Z) are forced LOW regardless of all state of the Select input. A less obvious use is as a function
other inputs. The F157A is the logic implementation of a generator. The F157A can generate any four of the 16 different
4-pole, 2-position switch where the position of the switch is de- functions of two variables with one variable common. This is
termined by the logic levels supplied to the Select input. The useful for implementing highly irregular logic.
logic equations for the outputs are shown below:
Za = E • (I1a • S + I0a • S) Zb = E • (I1b • S + I0b • S)
Zc = E • (I1c • S + I0c • S) Zd = E • (I1d • S + I0d • S)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
LOGIC DIAGRAM
1
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d E S
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
Za Zb Zc Zd 1
FUNCTION TABLE
S
Inputs Output E 15
4 Za I0a 2
E S I0 I1 Z
I1a 3
H X X X H 7 I0b
Zb 5
L L L X H I1b 6
L L H X L 12 Zc I0c 14
L H X L H I1c 13
L H X H L I0d 11
9 Zd
I1d 10
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 8.5 3.0 9.5 ns
tPHL S to Z 2.5 6.5 2.5 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.0 2.5 7.0 ns
tPHL E to Zn 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 5.9 2.0 7.0 ns
tPHL In to Z 1.0 4.0 1.0 4.5
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F158A quad 2-input multiplexer selects four bits of data A common use of the F158A is the moving of data from two
from two sources under the control of a common Select input groups of registers to four common output busses. The partic-
(S) and presents the data in inverted form at the four outputs. ular register from which the data comes is determined by the
The Enable input (E) is active LOW. When E is HIGH, all of the state of the Select input. A less obvious use is as a function
outputs (Z) are forced HIGH regardless of all other inputs. The generator. The F158A can generate four functions of two vari-
F158A is the logic implementation of a 4-pole, 2-position ables with one variable in common. This is useful for imple-
switch where the position of the switch is determined by the menting gating functions.
logic levels supplied to the Select input.
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
*R CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP GND D SUFFIX
SOIC
*MR for MC74F160A 16
1 CASE 751B-03
*SR for MC74F162A
FUNCTION TABLE
ORDERING INFORMATION
SR PE CET CEP ACTION ON THE RISING CLOCK EDGE ( )
MC74FXXXAJ Ceramic
L X X X Reset (Clear) MC74FXXXAN Plastic
MC74FXXXAD SOIC
H L X X Load (Pn → Qn)
H H H H Count (Increment)
H H L X No Change (Hold)
LOGIC SYMBOL
H H X L No Change (Hold)
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
9 3 4 5 6
PE P0 P1 P2 P3
7 CEP
STATE DIAGRAM
10 CET TC 15
0 1 2 3 4 2 CP
*R Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
15 5
1 14 13 12 11
14 6
13 7 VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
12 11 10 9 8 *MR for MC74F160A
*SR for MC74F162A
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
PE
MC74F160A MC74F162A
CEP
CET
MC74F162A
TC
ONLY
CP
CP CP
MC74F160A D CP D
ONLY CD Q Q
Q0 DETAIL A DETAIL A DETAIL A
Q0
DETAIL A
MR (MC74F160A)
SR (MC74F162A)
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F160A and MC74F162A count modulo-10 in the MR overrides all other inputs and asynchronously forces all
BCD (8421) sequence. From state 9 (HLLH) they increment outputs LOW. A LOW signal on SR overrides counting and
to state 0 (LLLL). The clock inputs of all flip-flops are driven in parallel loading and allows all outputs to go LOW on the next
parallel through a clock buffer. Thus, all changes of the Q out- rising edge of CP. A LOW signal on PE overrides counting and
puts (except due to Master Reset of the MC74F160A) occur allows information on the Parallel Data (Pn) inputs to be
as a result of, and synchronous with, the LOW-to-HIGH transi- loaded into the flip-flops on the next rising edge of CP. With
tion of the CP input signal. The circuits have four fundamental PE and MR (MC74F160A) or SR (MC74F162A) HIGH, CEP
modes of operation, in order of precedence: asynchronous re- and CET permit counting when both are HIGH. Conversely, a
set (MC74F160A), synchronous reset (MC74F162A), paral- LOW signal on either CEP or CET inhibits counting.
lel load, count-up and hold. Five control inputs — Master Re- The MC74F160A and MC74F162A use D-type edge-trig-
set (MR, MC74F160A), Synchronous Reset (SR, gered flip-flops and changing the SR, PE, CEP, and CET in-
MC74F162A), Parallel Enable (PE), Count Enable Parallel puts when the CP is in either state does not cause errors, pro-
(CEP) and Count Enable Trickle (CET) — determine the mode vided that the recommended setup and hold times, with
of operation, as shown in the Function Table. A LOW signal on respect to the rising edge of CP, are observed.
VIL Input LOW Voltage 0.8 V Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage for
All Inputs
The Terminal Count (TC) output is HIGH when CET is HIGH MC74F162A decade counters, the TC output is fully decoded
and the counter is in state 9. To implement synchronous multi- and can only be HIGH in state 9. If a decade counter is preset
stage counters, the TC outputs can be used with the CEP and to an illegal state, or assumes an illegal state when power is
CET inputs in two different ways. Please refer to the applied, it will return to the normal sequence within two
MC74F568 data sheet. The TC output is subject to decoding counts, as shown in the State Diagram.
spikes due to internal race conditions and is therefore not rec- Logic Equations:
ommended for use as a clock or asynchronous reset for Count Enable = CEP • CET • PE
flip-flops, counters, or registers. In the MC74F160A and TC = Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3 • CET
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Count Frequency 100 90 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay, Count 3.5 7.5 3.5 8.5
tPHL CP to Qn (PE Input HIGH) 3.5 10 3.5 11 ns
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 8.5 3.5 9.5
tPHL CP to Qn (PE Input LOW) 4.0 8.5 4.0 9.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 14 5.0 15 ns
tPHL CP to TC 4.5 14 4.5 15
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.5 2.5 8.5 ns
tPHL CET to TC 2.5 7.5 2.5 8.5
tPHL Propagation Delay 5.5 12 5.5 13 ns
MR to Qn (MC74F160A)
tPHL Propagation Delay 4.5 10.5 4.5 11.5 ns
MR to TC (MC74F160A)
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
ts(L) Pn to CP 5.0 5.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0
th(L) Pn to CP 2.0 2.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 11 11.5
ts(L) PE or SR to CP 8.5 9.5 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0
th(L) PE or SR to CP 0 0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 11 11.5
ts(L) CEP or CET to CP 5.0 5.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
tH(L) CEP or CET to CP 0 0
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width (Load) 5.0 5.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width (Count) 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 6.0 7.0
tw(L) MR Pulse Width, LOW 5.0 5.0
(MC74F160A) ns
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
*R CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP GND
D SUFFIX
*MR for MC74F161A SOIC
*SR for MC74F163A 16
1 CASE 751B-03
FUNCTION TABLE
SR PE CET CEP ACTION ON THE RISING CLOCK EDGE ( ) ORDERING INFORMATION
L X X X Reset (Clear) MC74FXXXAJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXAN Plastic
H L X X Load (Pn → Qn) MC74FXXXAD SOIC
H H H H Count (Increment)
H H L X No Change (Hold)
H H X L No Change (Hold) LOGIC SYMBOL
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
9 3 4 5 6
STATE DIAGRAM PE P0 P1 P2 P3
7 CEP
0 1 2 3 4 10 CET TC 15
2 CP
15 5 *R Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
14 6 1 14 13 12 11
13 7
VCC = PIN 16
12 11 10 9 8 GND = PIN 8
*MR for MC74F161A
*SR for MC74F163A
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
PE
MC74F161A MC74F163A
CEP
CET
MC74F163A
TC
ONLY
CP
CP CP
MC74F161A D CP D
ONLY CD Q Q
Q0 DETAIL A DETAIL A DETAIL A
Q0
DETAIL A
MR (MC74F161A)
SR (MC74F163A)
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F161A and MC74F163A count in modulo-16 all other inputs and asynchronously forces all outputs LOW. A
binary sequence. From state 15 (HHHH) they increment to LOW signal on SR overrides counting and parallel loading
state 0 (LLLL). The clock inputs of all flip-flops are driven in and allows all outputs to go LOW on the next rising edge of
parallel through a clock buffer. Thus all changes of the Q out- CP. A LOW signal on PE overrides counting and allows infor-
puts (except due to Master Reset of the MC74F161A) occur mation on the Parallel Data (Pn) inputs to be loaded into the
as a result of, and synchronous with, the LOW-to-HIGH transi- flip-flops on the next rising edge of CP. With PE and MR
tion of the CP input signal. The circuits have four fundamental (MC74F161A) or SR (MC74F163A) HIGH, CEP and CET per-
modes of operation, in order of precedence: asynchronous re- mit counting when both are HIGH. Conversely, a LOW signal
set (MC74F161A), synchronous reset (MC74F163A), parallel on either CEP or CET inhibits counting.
load, count-up and hold. Five control inputs Master Reset The MC74F161A and MC74F163A use D-type edge-trig-
(MR, MC74F161A), Synchronous Reset (SR, MC74F163A), gered flip-flops and changing the SR, PE, CEP, and CET in-
Parallel Enable (PE), Count Enable Parallel (CEP) and Count puts when the CP is in either state does not cause errors, pro-
Enable Trickle (CET) — determine the mode of operation, as vided that the recommended setup and hold times, with
shown in the Function Table. A LOW signal on MR overrides respect to the rising edge of CP, are observed.
VIL Input LOW Voltage 0.8 V Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage for
All Inputs
The Terminal Count (TC) output is HIGH when CET is HIGH fore not recommended for use as a clock or asynchronous
and the counter is in state 15. To implement synchronous mul- reset for flip-flops, counters, or registers.
tistage counters, the TC outputs can be used with the CEP Logic Equations:
and CET inputs in two different ways. The TC output is subject Count Enable = CEP • CET • PE
to decoding spikes due to internal race conditions and is there- TC = Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3 • CET
AC CHARACTERISTCS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Count Frequency 100 90 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay, Count 3.5 6.0 3.5 7.0
tPHL CP to Qn (PE Input HIGH) 3.5 10 3.5 11 ns
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 7.0 3.5 9.5
tPHL CP to Qn (PE Input LOW) 4.0 8.5 4.0 9.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 14 5.0 15 ns
tPHL CP to TC 4.5 14 4.5 15
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.5 2.5 8.5 ns
tPHL CET to TC 2.5 7.5 2.5 8.5
tPHL Propagation Delay 5.5 12 5.5 13 ns
MR to Qn (MC74F161A)
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
ts(L) Pn to CP 5.0 5.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0
th(L) Pn to CP 2.0 2.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 11 11.5
ts(L) PE or SR to CP 8.5 9.5 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0
th(L) PE or SR to CP 0 0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 11 11.5
ts(L) CEP or CET to CP 5.0 5.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
th(L) CEP or CET to CP 0 0
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width (Load) 5.0 5.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width (Count) 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 6.0 7.0
tw(L) MR Pulse Width, LOW 5.0 5.0
(MC74F161A) ns
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
VCC Q7 Q6 Q5 Q4 MR CP
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
14
1
D SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
SOIC
1 CASE 751A-02
A B Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MODE SELECT TABLE MC74FXXXD SOIC
Inputs Outputs
Operating Mode MR A B Q0 Q1 –Q7
LOGIC SYMBOL
Reset (Clear) L X X L L–L
Shift H l l L q0–q6
H l h L q0–q6
H h l L q0–q6 1 A
2 B
H h h H q0–q6 8 CP
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
H(h) = HIGH Voltage Levels
L(l) = LOW Voltage Levels
X = Don’t Care
9 3 4 5 6 10 11 12 13
qn = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input or output one setup time prior to
the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition. VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q
B
CD CD CD CD CD CD CD CD
CP
MR
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F164 is an edge-triggered 8-bit shift register with se- Each LOW-to-HIGH transition on the Clock (CP) input
rial data entry and an output from each of the eight stages. shifts data one place to the right and enters into Q0 the logical
Data is entered serially through one of two inputs (A or B); ei- AND of the two data inputs (A • B) that existed before the rising
ther of these inputs can be used as an active HIGH Enable clock edge. A LOW level on the Master Reset (MR) input over-
for data entry through the other input. An unused input must rides all other inputs and clears the register asynchronously,
be tied HIGH. forcing all Q outputs LOW.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 80 90 70 80 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.0 8.0 3.0 11 3.0 9.0 ns
tPHL CP to Qn 5.0 7.5 10 5.0 13 5.0 11
tPHL Propagation Delay 5.5 10.5 13 5.5 16 5.5 14 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = + 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 7.0 7.0 7.0
ts(L) Dn to CP 7.0 7.0 7.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0 1.0
th(L) Dn to CP 1.0 1.0 1.0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width, HIGH or LOW 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) 7.0 7.0 7.0
tw(L) MR Pulse Width, LOW 7.0 7.0 7.0 ns
trec Recovery Time, MR to CP 7.0 7.0 7.0 ns
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
U/D CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP GND
D SUFFIX
MODE SELECT TABLE SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
Action on Rising
PE CEP CET U/D Clock Edge
L X X X Load (Pn → Qn)
ORDERING INFORMATION
H L L H Count Up (Increment)
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
H L L L Count Down (Decrement)
MC74FXXXN Plastic
H H X X No Change (Hold) MC74FXXXD SOIC
H X H X No Change (Hold)
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
MC54/74F168
PE P0 P1 P2 P3
CEP
CET
T LD
AT TC
AF
LD T
ENF
BT
U/D BF
UP UP
DN
DN DETAIL A DETAIL A DETAIL A
ENF
CP CP
CP
DETAIL A
J CP K Q
Q Q
Q
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
MC54/74F169
PE P0 P1 P2 P3
CEP
CET
T LD
AT TC
AF
LD T
ENF
BT
U/D BF
UP UP
DN
DN DETAIL A DETAIL A DETAIL A
ENF
CP CP
CP
DETAIL A
J CP K Q
Q Q
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
NOTE:
These diagrams are provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F168 and F169 use edge-triggered J-K type flip-flops output state is not a function of the Count Enable Parallel
and have no constraints on changing the control or data input (CEP) input level. The TC output of the F168 decade counter
signals in either state of the clock. The only requirement is that can also be LOW in the illegal states 11, 13, and 15, which can
the various inputs attain the desired state at least a setup time occur when power is turned on or via parallel loading. If an ille-
before the rising edge of the clock and remain valid for the rec- gal state occurs, the F168 will return to the legitimate se-
ommended hold time thereafter. The parallel load operation quence within two counts. Since the TC signal is derived by
takes precedence over other operations, as indicated in the decoding the flip-flop states, there exists the possibility of de-
Mode Select Table. When PE is LOW, the data on the P0-P3 coding spikes on TC. For this reason the use of TC as a clock
inputs enters the flip-flops on the next rising edge of the clock. signal is not recommended (see logic equations below).
In order for counting to occur, both CEP and CET must be
LOW and PE must be HIGH; the U/D input then determines 1) Count Enable = CEP • CET • PE
the direction of counting. The Terminal Count (TC) output is 2) Up: (′F168): TC = Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3 • (Up) • CET
normally HIGH and goes LOW, provided that CET is LOW, (′F169): TC = Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3 • (Up) • CET
when a counter reaches zero in the Count Down mode or 3) Down: TC = Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3 • (Down) • CET
reaches 9 (15 for the F169) in the Count Up mode. The TC
VIL Input LOW Voltage 0.8 V Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage for
All Inputs
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 60 85 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5 ns
tPHL CP to Qn (PE HIGH or LOW) 4.0 11.5 4.0 14 4.0 13
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 5.5 4.5 ns
ts(L) Pn to CP 4.0 5.5 4.5
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MR Q0 D0 D1 Q1 D2 Q2 GND ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
@ tn, MR = H @ tn + 1 LOGIC SYMBOL
Dn Qn
H H
14 D5 Q5 15
L L
13 D4 Q4 12
tn = Bit time before clock pulse 11 10
D3 Q3
tn + 1 = Bit time after clock pulse
H = HIGH Voltage Level 6 D2 Q2 7
L = LOW Voltage Level 4 D1 Q1 5
3 D0 Q0 2
CP MR
9 1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
MR CP D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q
CP CP CP CP CP CP
CD CD CD CD CD CD
Q5 Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1 Q0
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 140 80 80 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 5.5 8.0 3.5 10.0 3.5 9.0 ns
tPHL CP to Qn 4.5 7.0 10 4.5 12.0 4.5 11.0
tPHL Propagation Delay 5.0 10 14 5.0 16.0 5.0 15.0 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 4.0 4.0
ts (L) Dn to CP 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 1.0 0
th(L) Dn to CP 0 1.0 0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width, HIGH 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) or LOW 6.0 6.0 6.0
tw(L) MR Pulse Width LOW 5.0 5.0 5.0 ns
trec Recovery Time MR to CP 5.0 5.0 5.0 ns
QUAD D FLIP-FLOP
The MC54/74F175 is a high-speed quad D flip-flop. The device is useful for
general flip-flop requirements where both true and complementary outputs
are required and clock and clear inputs are common to all flip-flops. The in- QUAD D FLIP-FLOP
formation on the D inputs is stored during the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition.
Both true and complemented outputs of each flip-flop are provided. A Master FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
Reset input resets all flip-flops, independent of the Clock or D inputs when
LOW.
• Four Edge-triggered D-type Inputs
• Buffered Positive Edge-triggered Common Clock
• Buffered Asynchronous Common Reset
• True and Complementary Outputs J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
• ESD > 4000 Volts CASE 620-09
16
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 1
VCC Q3 Q3 D3 D2 Q2 Q2 CP
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16
CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SOIC
16
MR Q0 Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q1 GND 1 CASE 751B-03
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
MR CP D3 D2 D1 D0
D Q D Q D Q D Q
CP Q CP Q CP Q CP Q
CD CD CD CD
Q3 Q3 Q2 Q2 Q1 Q1 Q0 Q0
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F175 consists of four edge-triggered D flop-flops with Q outputs to follow. A LOW input on the Master Reset (MR) will
individual D inputs and Q and Q outputs. The Clock and force all Q outputs LOW and Q outputs HIGH independent of
Master Reset are common. The four flip-flops will store the Clock or Data inputs. The F175 is useful for general logic
state of their individual D inputs, one setup time before, on the applications where a common Master Reset and Clock are
LOW-to-HIGH clock (CP) transition, causing individual Q and acceptable.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 140 100 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 5.0 6.5 3.5 8.5 3.5 7.5 ns
tPHL CP to Qn or Qn 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 10.5 4.0 9.5
tPHL Propagation Delay 4.5 9.0 11.5 4.5 15 4.5 13 ns
MR to Qn
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 10 4.0 9.0 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.0 3.0
ts(L) Dn to CP 3.0 3.0 3.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0 1.0
th(L) Dn to CP 1.0 1.0 1.0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width, HIGH 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) or LOW 5.0 5.0 5.0
tw(L) MR Pulse Width, LOW 5.0 5.0 5.0 ns
trec Recovery Time, MR to CP 5.0 5.0 5.0 ns
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
VCC A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 G Cn+4 P A = B F3 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 CASE 724-03
24
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 MC54/74FXXXN Plastic
B0 A0 S3 S2 S1 S0 Cn M F0 F1 F2 GND
LOGIC SYMBOLS
ACTIVE-HIGH OPERANDS ACTIVE-LOW OPERANDS
2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
7 Cn 7 Cn
Cn + 4 16 Cn + 4 16
8 M 8 M
6 S0 A=B 14 6 S0 A=B 14
5 S1 G 17 5 S1 G 17
4 S2 4 S2
P 15 P 15
3 S3 3 S3
F0 F1 F2 F3 F0 F1 F2 F3
9 10 11 13 9 10 11 13
VCC = PIN 24
GND = PIN 12
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Cn M A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
S0
S1
S2
S3
F0 F1 A=B F2 F3 P Cn + 4 G
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F181 is a 4-bit high-speed parallel Arithmetic Logic Unit each group of four F181 devices. Carry lookahead can be pro-
(ALU). Controlled by the four Function Select inputs (S0 – S3) vided at various levels and offers high-speed capability over
and the Mode Control input (M), it can perform all the 16 pos- extremely long word lengths.
sible logic operations or 16 different arithmetic operations on The A = B output from the device goes HIGH when all four
active-HIGH or active-LOW operands. The Function Table F outputs are HIGH and can be used to indicate logic equiva-
lists these operations. lence over four bits when the unit is in the Subtract mode. The
When the Mode Control input (M) is HIGH, all internal carries A = B output is open collector and can be wired-AND with other
are inhibited and the device performs logic operations on the A = B outputs to give a comparison for more than four bits. The
individual bits as listed. When the Mode Control input is LOW, A = B signal can be used with the Cn + 4 signal to indicate A >
the carries are enabled and the device performs arithmetic op- B and A < B.
erations on the two 4-bit words. The device incorporates full in- The Function Table lists the arithmetic operations that are
ternal carry lookahead and provides for either ripple carry be- performed without a carry in. An incoming carry adds a one to
tween devices using the Cn + 4 output, or for carry lookahead each operation. Thus, select code LHHL generates A minus
between packages using the signals P (Carry Propagate) and B minus 1 (2s complement notation) without a carry in and
G (Carry Generate). In the Add mode, P indicates that F is 15 generates A minus B when a carry is applied. Because sub-
or more, while G indicates that F is 16 or more. In the Subtract traction is actually performed by complementary addition (1s
mode, P indicates that F is zero or less, while G indicates that complement), a carry out means borrow; thus a carry is gener-
F is less than zero. P and G are not affected by carry in. When ated when there is no underflow and no carry is generated
speed requirements are not stringent, it can be used in a sim- when there is underflow. As indicated, this device can be used
ple Ripple Carry mode by connecting the Carry output (Cn + 4) with either active-LOW inputs producing active-LOW outputs
signal to the Carry input (Cn) of the next unit. For high-speed or with active-HIGH inputs producing active-HIGH outputs.
operation the device is used in conjunction with a carry looka- For either case the table lists the operations that are performed
head circuit. One carry lookahead package is required for to the operands labeled inside the logic symbol.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
Parameter CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Path Mode Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
Cn to Cn + 4 ns
tPHL 3.0 8.0 3.0 10 3.0 9.0
tPLH 5.0 13 5.0 15 5.0 14
A or B to Cn + 4 Sum ns
tPHL 5.0 12 5.0 14 5.0 13
tPLH 5.0 14 5.0 16 5.0 15
A or B to Cn + 4 Dif ns
tPHL 5.0 13 5.0 15 5.0 14
tPLH 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
Cn to F Any ns
tPHL 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
tPLH 3.0 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5
A or B to G Sum ns
tPHL 3.0 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5
tPLH 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
A or B to G Dif ns
tPHL 3.0 9.5 3.0 11.5 3.0 10.5
tPLH 3.0 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
A or B to P Sum ns
tPHL 3.0 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5
tPLH 4.0 7.5 4.0 9.5 4.0 8.5
A or B to P Dif ns
tPHL 3.5 8.5 3.5 10.5 3.5 9.5
tPLH 3.0 9.0 3.0 11 3.0 10
Ai or Bi to Fi Sum ns
tPHL 3.0 10 3.0 11 3.0 10
tPLH 3.0 11 3.0 13 3.0 12
Ai or Bi to Fi Dif ns
tPHL 3.0 11 3.0 13 3.0 12
tPLH Any A or B 4.0 10.5 4.0 12.5 4.0 11.5
Sum ns
tPHL to Any F 4.0 10 4.0 12 4.0 11
tPLH Any A or B 4.5 12 4.5 14 4.5 13
Dif ns
tPHL to Any F 4.5 12 4.5 14 4.5 13
tPLH 4.0 9.0 4.0 11 4.0 10
A or B to F Logic ns
tPHL 4.0 10 4.0 12 4.0 11
tPLH 11 27 11 31 11 29
A or B to A = B Dif ns
tPHL 7.0 12.5 7.0 14.5 7.0 13.5
FUNCTION TABLE
Mode Select Active-LOW Operands Active-HIGH Operands
Inputs & Fn Outputs & Fn Outputs
Logic Arithmetic** Logic Arithmetic**
S3 S2 S1 S0 (M = H) (M = L) (Cn = L) (M = H) (M = L) (Cn = H)
L L L L A A minus 1 A A
L L L H AB AB minus 1 A+B A+B
L L H L A+B AB minus 1 AB A+B
L L H H Logic 1 minus 1 Logic 0 minus 1
VCC P2 G2 Cn Cn + x Cn + y G Cn + z
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
16
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
G1 P1 G0 P0 G3 P3 P GND
16
CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
LOGIC SYMBOL
13
Cn
P0 4
G0 3
Cn + x P1 2
12
G1 1 VCC = PIN 16
Cn + x Cn + y Cn + z G P 11 Cn + y GND = PIN 8
P2 15
Cn + z G2 14
9
P3 6
G3 5
P G
7 10
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
Cn G0 P0 G1 P1 G2 P2 G3 P3 Cn+x Cn+y Cn+z G P
X H H L
L H X L
X L X H
H X L H
X X X H H L
X H H H X L
L H X H X L
X X X L X H
X L X X L H
H X L X L H
X X X X X H H L
X X X H H H X L
X H H H X H X L
L H X H X H X L
X X X X X L X H
X X X L X X L H
X L X X L X L H
H X L X L X L H
X X X X X H H H
X X X H H H X H
X H H H X H X H
H H X H X H X H
X X X X X L X L
X X X L X X L L
X L X X L X L L
L X L X L X L L
H X X X H
X H X X H
X X H X H
X X X H H
L L L L L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
ICCL Power Supply Current (All Outputs LOW) 23.5 36 mA G0, G1, G2 = 4.5 V VCC = MAX
All Other Inputs = GND
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under guaranteed operating ranges.
2. No more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.6 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
ns
tPHL Cn to Cn + x, Cn + y, Cn + z 3.0 6.8 9.0 3.0 11 3.0 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.2 8.0 2.5 10.7 2.5 9.0
tPHL P0, P1, or P2 to Cn + x, 1.5 3.7 5.0 1.5 6.5 1.5 6.0 ns
Cn + y, Cn + z
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.5 8.5 2.5 10.5 2.5 9.5
tPHL G0, G1, or G2 to Cn + x, 1.5 3.9 5.2 1.5 6.5 1.5 6.0 ns
Cn + y, Cn + z
AC CHARACTERISTICS (Continued)
54/74F 54F 74F
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F182 carry lookahead generator accepts up to four G = G3 + P3G2 + P3P2G1 + P3P2P1G0
pairs of active-LOW Carry Propagate (P0-P3) and carry Gen- P = P3P2P1P0
erate (G0-G3) signals and an active-HIGH Carry input (Cn) and Also, the F182 can be used with binary ALUs in an active-
provides anticipated active-HIGH carries (Cn + x, Cn + y, Cn + z) LOW or active-HIGH input operand mode. The connections
across four groups of binary adders. The F182 also has ac- (Figure 1) to and from the ALU to the carry lookahead genera-
tive-LOW Carry Propagate (P) and Carry Generate (G) out- tor are identical in both cases. Carries are rippled between
puts which may be used for further levels of lookahead. The lookahead blocks. The critical speed path follows the circled
logic equations provided at the output are: numbers. There are several possible arrangements for the
Cn + x = G0 + P0Cn carry interconnects, but all achieve about the same speed. A
Cn + y = G1 + P1G0 + P1P0Cn 28-bit ALU is formed by dropping the last F181 or F381.
Cn + z = G2 + P2G1 + P2P1G0 + P2P1P0Cn
Cn Cn
ALU** G ALU** G
P P
A, B
1 5
C16
Cn Cn + 4 Cn Cn Cn + 4 Cn Cn Cn + 4 Cn Cn + 4 COUT
ALU** G ALU** G ALU** G ALU** G ALU** (C32)
P P P ALU**
P
2 6
F
P0 G0 P1 G1 P2G2 P3 G3 P0 G0 P1 G1 P2 G2 P3 G3
CIN Cn F182 G Cn F182 G
Cn + x Cn + y Cn + zP Cn + x Cn + y Cn + z P
3
4
Figure 1. 32-Bit ALU with Ripple Carry Between 16-Bit Lookahead ALUs
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
VCC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 CP S1 S0 D SUFFIX
SOIC
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MC74FXXXD SOIC
MR DSR P0 P1 P2 P3 DSL GND
Operating
p g Inputs Outputs 11 10 9
Mode MR S1 S0 DSR DSL Pn Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
Reset L X X X X X L L L L CP S1 S0
Hold H I I X X X q0 q1 q2 q3 1 MR DSR 2
15 Q0 P0 3
H h I X I X q1 q2 q3 L
Shift Left P1 4
H h I X h X q1 q2 q3 H 14 Q1
P2 5
H I h I X X L q0 q1 q2 13 Q2
Shift Right P3 6
H I h h X X H q0 q1 q2
12 Q3 DSL 7
Parallel Load H h h X X pn p0 p1 p2 p3
I = LOW voltage level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition.
h = HIGH voltage level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition.
pn, qn = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input or output one setup VCC = PIN 16
time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition. GND = PIN 8
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
S1
S0
DSR DSR
S Q0 S Q1 S Q2 S Q3
CP CP CP CP
R R R R
CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR
CP
MR
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate
propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Shift Frequency 105 90 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.0 3.5 8.0
ns
tPHL CP to Qn 3.5 7.5 3.5 8.0
Propagation Delay
tPHL 4.5 12 4.5 14 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Set up Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 4.0
ts(L) Pn or DSR or DSL to CP 4.0 4.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 1.0
th(L) Pn or DSR or DSL to CP 0 1.0
ts(H) Set up Time, HIGH or LOW 8.0 9.0
ts(L) Sn to CP 8.0 8.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
th(L) Sn to CP 0 0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width HIGH 5.0 5.5 ns
tw(L) MR Pulse Width LOW 5.0 5.0 ns
Recovery Time
trec 7.0 8.0 ns
MR to CP
ORDERING INFORMATION
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
VCC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q3 CP PE MC74FXXXD SOIC
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
LOGIC SYMBOL
9 4 5 6 7
PE D0 D1 D2 D3
2 J
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 10 CP Q3 11
MR J K D0 D1 D2 D3 GND 3 K
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
1 15 14 13 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
J K D0 D1 D2 D3
PE
CP
MR
RD RD RD RD
R Q R R R Q
CP CP CP CP
S Q S Q S Q S Q
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q3
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
Operating Modes MR CP PE J K Dn Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q3
Asynchronous Reset L X X X X X L L L L H
Shift, Set First Stage H ↑ h h h X H q0 q1 q2 q2
Shift, Reset First Stage H ↑ h l l X L q0 q1 q2 q2
Shift, Toggle First Stage H ↑ h h l X q0 q0 q1 q2 q2
Shift, Retain First Stage H ↑ h l h X q0 q0 q1 q2 q2
Parallel Load H ↑ l X X dn d0 d1 d2 d3 d3
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
dn (qn) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition.
↑ = LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under guaranteed operating ranges.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax 105 90 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0 ns
tPHL CP to Q/Q 2.5 8.0 2.5 9.0
tPHL Propagation Delay, MR to Q 3.0 10 3.0 11 ns
tPLH Propagation Delay, MR to Q 3.0 10.5 3.0 11 ns
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
ts (H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW J, K, D to CP 4.0 4.0 ns
ts (L) 4.0 4.0
th (H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW J, K, D to CP 0 1.0 ns
th (L) 0 1.0
ts (H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW PE to CP 8.0 9.0 ns
ts (L) 8.0 9.0
th (H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW PE to CP 0 0 ns
th (L) 0 0
tw (H) CP Pulse Width, HIGH 5.0 5.5 ns
tw (L) MR Pulse Width, LOW 5.0 5.0 ns
trec Recovery Time, MR to CP 7.0 8.0 ns
CONNECTION DIAGRAMS
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
MC54/74F240 20 CASE 732-03
VCC OEb Ya0 Ib0 Ya1 Ib1 Ya2 Ib2 Ya3 Ib3 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OEa Ia0 Yb0 Ia1 Yb1 Ia2 Yb2 Ia3 Yb3 GND DW SUFFIX
20 SOIC
CASE 751D-03
1
MC54/74F241
VCC OEb Ya0 Ib0 Ya1 Ib1 Ya2 Ib2 Ya3 Ib3
ORDERING INFORMATION
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OEa Ia0 Yb0 Ia1 Yb1 Ia2 Yb2 Ia3 Yb3 GND
MC54/74F244
VCC OEb Ya0 Ib0 Ya1 Ib1 Ya2 Ib2 Ya3 Ib3
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OEa Ia0 Yb0 Ia1 Yb1 Ia2 Yb2 Ia3 Yb3 GND
AC CHARACTERISTICS – MC54/74F240
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, Data to Output 2.5 5.1 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0 ns
tPHL 1.5 3.5 4.7 1.5 6.0 1.5 5.7
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 3.5 5.2 2.0 6.5 2.0 5.7 ns
tPZL 4.0 6.9 9.0 4.0 13.5 4.0 10
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 4.0 5.3 2.0 6.5 2.0 6.3 ns
tPLZ 1.5 6.0 8.0 2.0 12.5 1.5 9.5
AC CHARACTERISTICS – MC54/74F241
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, Data to Output 2.5 4.0 5.2 2.0 6.5 2.5 6.2 ns
tPHL 2.5 4.0 5.2 2.0 7.0 2.5 6.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 4.3 5.7 2.0 7.0 2.0 6.7 ns
tPZL 2.0 5.4 7.0 2.0 8.5 2.0 8.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 4.5 6.0 2.0 7.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 4.5 6.5 2.0 12.5 2.0 7.5
AC CHARACTERISTICS – MC54/74F244
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, Data to Output 2.5 4.0 5.2 2.5 6.5 2.5 6.2 ns
tPHL 2.5 4.0 5.2 2.5 7.0 2.5 6.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 4.3 5.7 2.0 7.0 2.0 6.7 ns
tPZL 2.0 5.4 7.0 2.0 8.5 2.0 8.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 4.5 6.0 2.0 7.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 4.5 6.0 2.0 10.0 2.0 7.0
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
OE1 NC 1A 2A 3A 4A GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
OE1 NC 1A 2A 3A 4A GND
AC CHARACTERISTICS – MC54/74F242
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, 2.5 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0 ns
tPHL Data to Output 1.5 4.7 1.5 6.0 1.5 5.7
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 4.7 2.0 6.5 2.0 5.7 ns
tPZL 4.0 9.0 4.0 12 4.0 10
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 5.3 2.0 6.5 2.0 6.3 ns
tPLZ 1.5 6.5 1.5 12.5 1.5 8.0
AC CHARACTERISTICS – MC54/74F243
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay, 2.5 5.2 2.0 6.5 2.0 6.2 ns
tPHL Data to Output 2.5 5.2 2.0 8.5 2.0 6.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 5.7 2.0 8.0 2.0 6.7 ns
tPZL 2.0 7.5 2.0 10.5 2.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 6.0 1.5 7.5 1.5 7.0 ns
tPLZ 1.5 6.5 2.0 12.5 1.5 7.5
MC54/74F245
OCTAL BIDIRECTIONAL
TRANSCEIVER WITH
3-STATE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
OCTAL BIDIRECTIONAL
The MC54/74F245 contains eight noninverting bidirectional buffers with
3-state outputs and is intended for bus-oriented applications. Current sinking TRANSCEIVER WITH 3-STATE
capability is 24 mA at the A ports and 64 mA at the B ports. The Transmit/Re- INPUTS/OUTPUTS
ceive (T/R) input determines the direction of data flow through the bidirectional FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
transceiver. Transmit (active HIGH) enables data from A ports to B ports; Re-
ceive (active LOW) enables data from B ports to A ports. The Output Enable
input, when HIGH, disables both A and B ports by placing them in a high-Z
condition.
• Noninverting Buffers
• Bidirectional Data Path J SUFFIX
• B Outputs Sink 64 mA CERAMIC
• ESD > 4000 Volts 20 CASE 732-03
1
CONNECTION DIAGRAM (TOP VIEW)
VCC OE B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
DW SUFFIX
20 SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CASE 751D-03
1
T/R A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.0 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0 ns
tPHL An to Bn or Bn to An 2.5 6.0 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0 ns
tPZL 3.5 8.0 3.5 10 3.5 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.5 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5 ns
tPLZ 2.0 6.5 2.0 8.5 2.0 7.5
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
This device is a logical implementation of a single-pole, 8-position switch J SUFFIX
with the switch position controlled by the state of three Select inputs, S0, S1, CERAMIC
S2. Both assertion and negation outputs are provided. The Output Enable in- CASE 620-09
16
put (OE) is active LOW. When it is activated, the logic function provided at the 1
output is:
Z = OE • (I0 • S0 • S1 • S2 + I1 • S0 • S1 • S2 +
I2 • S0 • S1 • S2 + I3 • S0 • S1 • S2 +
I4 • S0 • S1 • S2 + I5 • S0 • S1 • S2 + N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
I6 • S0 • S1 • S2 + I7 • S0 • S1 • S2 + CASE 648-08
16
When the Output Enable is HIGH, both outputs are in the high impedance
1
(high Z) state. This feature allows multiplexer expansion by tying the outputs
of up to 128 devices together. When the outputs of the 3-state devices are tied
together, all but one device must be in the high impedance state to avoid high
currents that would exceed the maximum ratings. The Output Enable signals D SUFFIX
SOIC
should be designed to ensure there is no overlap in the active LOW portion 16
1 CASE 751B-03
of the enable voltages.
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
CONNECTION DIAGRAM MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
VCC I4 I5 I6 I7 S0 S1 S2
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
LOGIC SYMBOL
9 10 11
S2 S1 S0
OE 7
I0 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
6 I1 3
I3 I2 I1 I0 Z Z OE GND I2 2
I3 1
I4 15
5 I5 14
I6 13
I7 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
OE S2 S1 S0 Z Z
H X X X Z Z
L L L L I0 I0
L L L H I1 I1
L L H L I2 I2
L L H H I3 I3
L H L L I4 I4
L H L H I5 I5
L H H L I6 I6
L H H H I7 I7
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
LOGIC DIAGRAM
I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7
S2
S1
S0
OE
Z Z
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55 °Cto +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 8.0 3.5 9.5 4.0 9.0 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 3.2 7.5 3.2 9.5 3.2 8.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 13 3.5 16.5 4.5 14 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 4.5 9.0 3.0 10.5 4.0 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.7 2.5 8.0 3.0 7.0 ns
tPHL In to Z 1.5 4.0 1.5 6.0 1.5 5.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 9.5 3.5 11.5 4.0 10.5 ns
tPHL In to Z 3.0 6.5 3.0 7.5 3.0 7.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 7.0 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.0 ns
tPZL OE to Z 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 3.0 6.5 3.0 8.5 3.0 7.5 ns
tPLZ OE to Z 2.0 4.5 2.0 8.0 2.0 5.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 4.0 9.0 4.0 10 4.0 10 ns
tPZL OE to Z 3.5 8.0 3.5 10 3.5 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 3.0 6.0 3.0 7.0 3.0 7.0 ns
tPLZ OE to Z 2.0 4.5 2.0 8.0 2.0 5.5
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) CASE 620-09
16
VCC OEb S0 I3b I2b I1b I0b Zb 1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16
CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OEa S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM
OEb 13b 12b 11b 10b S0 S1 13a 12a 11a 10a OEa
15 13 12 11 10 14 2 3 4 5 6 1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
Zb 9 Za 7
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F253 contains two identical 4-input Multiplexers with Za = OEa • (I0a • S1 • S0 + I1a • S1 • S0 +
3-State Outputs. They select two bits from four sources se- I2a • S1 • S0 + 13a • S1 • S0)
lected by common Select Inputs (S0, S1). The 4-input multi- Zb = OEb • (I0b • S1 • S0 + I1b • S1 • S0 +
plexers have individual Output Enable (OEa, OEb) inputs I2b • S1 • S0 + I3b • S1 • S0)
which, when HIGH, force the outputs to a high impedance If the outputs of 3-state devices are tied together, all but one
(high Z) state. device must be in the high impedance state to avoid high cur-
The F253 is the logic implementation of a 2-pole, 4-position rents that would exceed the maximum ratings. Designers
switch, where the position of the switch is determined by the should ensure that Output Enable signals to 3-state devices
logic levels supplied to the two select inputs. The logic equa- whose outputs are tied together are designed so that there is
tions for the outputs are shown below: no overlap.
FUNCTION TABLE
Select Output
Inputs Data Inputs Enable Output
S0 S1 I0 I1 I2 I3 OE Z
X X X X X X H Z
L L L X X X L L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L L H X X X L H L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
H L X L X X L L Z = High Impedance (off)
Address inputs S0 and S1
H L X H X X L H
are common to both sections.
L H X X L X L L
L H X X H X L H
H H X X X L L L
H H X X X H L H
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = -55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 11.5 3.5 15 4.5 13.5 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 3.0 9.0 2.5 11 3.0 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.0 2.5 9.0 3.0 8.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 2.5 6.0 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 8.0 2.5 10 3.0 9.0 ns
tPZL 3.0 8.0 2.5 10 3.0 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 5.0 2.0 6.5 2.0 6.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 6.0 2.0 8.0 2.0 7.0
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A0 A1 Da Q0a Q1a Q2a Q3a GND MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
FUNCTION TABLE MC74FXXXD SOIC
Inputs Outputs
Operating Mode MR E D A0 A1 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
LOGIC SYMBOL
Master Reset L H X X X L L L L 3 13
L L d L L Q=d L L L
Demulti lex (Active
Demultiplex
L L d H L L Q=d L L Da Db
HIGH Decoder when
L L d L H L L Q=d L 1 A0 E 14
D = H)
L L d H H L L L Q=d
Store (Do Nothing) H H X X X q0 q1 q2 q3 2 A1 MR 15
Q0a Q1a Q2a Q3a Q0b Q1b Q2b Q3b
H L d L L Q=d q1 q2 q3
Addressable H L d H L q0 Q=d q2 q3
Latch H L d L H q0 q1 Q=d q3 4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12
H L d H H q0 q1 q2 Q=d
H = HIGH Voltage Level Steady State
L = LOW Voltage Level Steady State
X = Immaterial
d = HIGH or LOW Data one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH Enable transition.
q = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced output established during the last cycle
in which it was addressed or cleared.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
E Da A0 A1 MR Db
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 5%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.5 9.0 3.5 11.5 3.5 10
ns
tPHL Dn to Qn 3.0 7.0 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.5 14 3.5 15.5 3.5 14.5
ns
tPHL An to Qn 4.0 9.5 4.0 11 4.0 10
Propagation Delay
tPHL 5.0 9.0 4.5 11.5 4.5 10 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to 70°C
Unit
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 5%
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16
CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D SUFFIX
OE I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d S SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXAJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXAN Plastic
MC74FXXXAD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
1
Za Zb Zc Zd S
OE 15
4 Za I0a 2
FUNCTION TABLE
I1a 3
Output Select Data
Enable Input Inputs Outputs 7 Zb I0b 5
I1b 6
OE S I0 I1 Z
12 Zc I0c 14
H X X X Z
I1c 13
L H X L L
9 Zd I0d 11
L H X H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level VCC = PIN 16 I1d 10
L L L X L L = LOW Voltage Level GND = PIN 8
X = Don’t Care
L L H X H
Z = High Impedance
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F257A is a quad 2-input multiplexer with 3-state out- Za = OE • (I1a • S + I0a • S)
puts. It selects four bits of data from two sources under control Zb = OE • (I1b • S + I0b • S)
of a Common Data Select input. When the Select input is Zc = OE • (I1c • S + I0c • S)
LOW, the I0x inputs are selected and when Select is HIGH, the Zd = OE • (I1d • S + I0d • S)
I1x inputs are selected. The data on the selected inputs ap- When the Output Enable input (OE) is HIGH, the outputs are
pears at the outputs in true (non-inverted) form. The device is forced to a high impedance OFF state. If the outputs are tied
the logic implementation of a 4-pole, 2-position switch where together, all but one device must be in the high impedance
the position of the switch is determined by the logic levels sup- state to avoid high currents that would exceed the maximum
plied to the Select input. The logic equations for the outputs are ratings. Designers should ensure the Output Enable signals to
shown below: 3-state devices whose outputs are tied together are designed
so there is no overlap.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 1.5 5.5 1.5 6.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 2.0 5.5 2.0 6.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 9.5 3.0 10.5 ns
tPHL S to Zn 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 6.5 2.0 7.0 ns
tPZL 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 6.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 6.0 2.0 7.0
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16
CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXAJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXAN Plastic
MC74FXXXAD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
1
S
OE 15
4 Za I0a 2
Za Zb Zc Zd I1a 3
7 Zb I0b 5
I1b 6
12 Zc I0c 14
I1c 13
I0d 11
9 Zd
I1d 10
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
FUNCTION TABLE
Output Select Data
Enable Input Inputs Output
OE S I0 I1 Z
H X X X Z
L H X L H
L H X H L
L L L X H
L L H X L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
AC CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.3 2.0 6.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 1.0 4.0 1.0 5.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL S to Zn 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 6.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPZL 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 6.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPLZ 1.5 6.0 1.5 7.0
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F258A is a quad 2-input multiplexer with 3-state out- Za = OE • (I1a • S + I0a • S)
puts. It selects four bits of data from two sources under control Zb = OE • (I1b • S + I0b • S)
of a common Select input (S). When the Select input is LOW, Zc = OE • (I1c • S + I0c • S)
the I0x inputs are selected and when Select is HIGH, the I1x Zd = OE • (I1d • S + I0d • S)
inputs are selected. The data on the selected inputs appears When the Output Enable input (OE) is HIGH, the outputs are
at the outputs in inverted form. The F258A is the logic imple- forced to a high impedance OFF state. If the outputs of the
mentation of a 4-pole, 2-position switch where the position of 3-state devices are tied together, all but one device must be in
the switch is determined by the logic levels supplied to the Se- the high impedance state to avoid high currents that would ex-
lect input. The logic equations for the outputs are shown be- ceed the maximum ratings. Designers should ensure the Out-
low: put Enable signals to 3-state devices whose outputs are tied
together are designed so there is no overlap.
The MC54/74F259 has four modes of operation as shown in the Mode Se-
lect Table. In the addressable latch mode, data on the Data line (D) is written
into the addressed latch. The addressed latch will follow the data input with
N SUFFIX
all non-addressed latches remaining in their previous states in the memory
PLASTIC
mode. All the latches remain in their previous state and are unaffected by the
16 CASE 648-08
Data or Address inputs.
In the one-of-eight decoding or demultiplexing mode, the addressed output 1
will follow the state of the D input with all other outputs in the LOW state. In
the clear mode all outputs are LOW and unaffected by the address and data
inputs. When operating the MC54/74F259 as an addressable latch, changing D SUFFIX
more than one bit of the address could impose a transient wrong address. SOIC
16
Therefore, this should only be done while in the memory mode. The Truth 1 CASE 751B-03
Table below summarizes the operations of the MC54/74F259.
ORDERING INFORMATION
CONNECTION DIAGRAM MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
VCC MR E D Q7 Q6 Q5 Q4 MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
LOGIC SYMBOL
14 15
13 D E MR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A0
1
A0 A1 A2 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND
2 A1
3 A2
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12
Q7
Q6
Q5
MR
Q4
Q3
A2
A1
Q2
A0
Q1
D
Q0
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
Operating
Mode MR E D A0 A1 A2 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
Master Reset L H X X X X L L L L L L L L
L L d L L L Q=d L L L L L L L
Demultiplex L L d H L L L Q=d L L L L L L
(Active HIGH L L d L H L L L Q=d L L L L L
Decoder when • • • • • • • • • • • • • •
D = H) • • • • • • • • • • • • • •
• • • • • • • • • • • • • •
L L d H H H L L L L L L L Q=d
Store
H H X X X X q0 q1 q2 q3 q4 q5 q6 q7
(Do Nothing)
H L d L L L Q=d q1 q2 q3 q4 q5 q6 q7
H L d H L L q0 Q=d q2 q3 q4 q5 q6 q7
H L d L H L q0 q1 Q=d q3 q4 q5 q6 q7
Addressable • • • • • • • • • • • • • •
Latch • • • • • • • • • • • • • •
• • • • • • • • • • • • • •
H L d H H H q0 q1 q2 q3 q4 q5 q6 Q=d
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
d = HIGH or LOW Data one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH Enable transition.
q = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced output established during the last cycle in which it was addressed or cleared.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.5 9.0 3.5 11.5 3.5 10
ns
tPHL Dn to Qn 3.0 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.0
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.5 13 3.5 15.5 3.5 14.5
ns
tPHL An to Qn 4.0 9.0 4.0 11 4.0 9.5
Propagation
g Delay
y
tPHL 50
5.0 90
9.0 45
4.5 11 5
11.5 45
4.5 10 ns
MR to Qn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to +70 °C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
PIN ASSIGNMENT
PE P0 P1 P2 P3 VCC P4 P5 P6 P7 TC CET
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
24
J SUFFIX
1 CERAMIC
CASE 758-01
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
U/D Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 GND Q5 Q6 Q7 CP CEP N SUFFIX
24
PLASTIC
1
CASE 724-03
DW SUFFIX
24 SOIC
1 CASE 751E-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
Operating Mode CP U/D CEP CET PE Pn Qn TC
↑ X X X l l L ( )
(a)
Parallel Load
↑ X X X l h H (a)
Count Up ↑ h l l h X Count Up (a)
Count Down ↑ l l l h X Count Down (a)
Hold ↑ X h X h X qn ( )
(a)
Do Nothing ↑ X X h h X qn H
H = HIGH voltage level steady state
h = HIGH voltage level one set-up time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
L = LOW voltage level steady state
l = LOW voltage level one set-up time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
X = Don’t care
q = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced output prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
↑ = LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
(a) = The TC is LOW when CET is LOW and the counter is at Terminal Count. Terminal Count Up is with all Qn outputs HIGH and Terminal Count Down is with all
(a) = Qn outputs LOW.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 DETAIL A Q0
P1 Q1
DETAIL A
P2 DETAIL A Q2
P3 DETAIL A Q3
DETAIL A
Pn DATA P4 DETAIL A Q4
D Q
CP Q
P5 DETAIL A Q5
PE CLOCK
P6 DETAIL A Q6
P7 DETAIL A Q7
CE
CP
U/D
CEP
CET
TC
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 100 85 MHz
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.0 5.5 9.0 3.0 9.5
ns
tPHL CP to Qn (Load) PE = LOW 4.0 5.0 9.0 4.0 9.5
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.0 6.0 9.0 2.5 10
ns
tPHL CP to Qn (Count) PE = HIGH 4.5 7.0 10 4.5 10.5
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 4.5 7.5 10 4.5 10.5
ns
tPHL CP to TC 5.0 7.5 10 5.0 11
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 3.5 5.0 9.0 3.5 10
ns
tPHL CET to TC 3.5 5.5 9.0 3.5 10
tPLH Propagation
g Delay
y 4.0 6.0 9.0 4.0 10
ns
tPHL U/D to TC 4.5 5.5 9.5 4.5 10
AC SETUP REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Parameter
Symbol Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts((H)) Set-up Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.5
ns
ts(L) P to CP 2.0 2.5
TIMING DIAGRAM
PE
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
CP
U/D
Q0
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q5
Q6
Q7
TC
253 254 255 0 1 2 2 1 0 255 254 253
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
VCC I5 I4 I3 I2 I1 I0
J SUFFIX
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 N SUFFIX
I6 I7 NC I8 ∑E ∑O GND PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D SUFFIX
I8 I7 I6 I5 I4 I3 I2 I1 I0 SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
8 9 10 11 12 13 1 2 4
I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8
ΣO ΣE
6 5
ΣO ΣE
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not
be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTION TABLE
Number of HIGH Inputs Outputs
I0-I8 ∑ Even ∑ Odd
0, 2, 4, 6, 8 H L
1, 3, 5, 7, 9 L H
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 15 4.5 20 4.5 16 ns
tPHL In to ∑E 4.5 16 4.5 21 4.5 17
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 15 4.5 20 4.5 16 ns
tPHL In to ∑O 4.5 16 4.5 21 4.5 17
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F283 adds two 4-bit binary words (A plus B) plus the incoming carry C0.
The binary sum appears on the Sum (S0–S3) and outgoing carry (C4) outputs. J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
The binary weight of the various inputs and outputs is indicated by the sub-
CASE 620-09
script numbers, representing powers of two. 16
1
20 (A0 + B0 + C0) + 21 (A1 + B1) + 22 (A2 + B2) + 23 (A3 + B3)
= S0 + 2S1 + 4S2 + 8S3 + 16C4
Where (+) = plus
Interchanging inputs of equal weight does not affect the operation.Thus C0, N SUFFIX
A0, B0 can be arbitrarily assigned to pins 5, 6 and 7. Due to the symmetry of PLASTIC
the binary add function, the F283 can be used either with all inputs and outputs 16 CASE 648-08
active HIGH (positive logic) or with all inputs and outputs active LOW (nega- 1
tive logic). See Figure A. Note that if C0 is not used it must be tied LOW for
active-HIGH logic or tied HIGH for active-LOW logic.
Due to pin limitations, the intermediate carries of the F283 are not brought
D SUFFIX
out for use as inputs or outputs. However, other means can be used to effec-
SOIC
tively insert a carry into, or bring a carry out from, an intermediate stage. Fig- 16
1 CASE 751B-03
ure B shows how to make a 3-bit adder. Tying the operand inputs of the fourth
adder (A3, B3) LOW makes S3 dependent only on, and equal to, the carry from
the third adder. Using somewhat the same principle, Figure C shows a way
ORDERING INFORMATION
of dividing the F283 into a 2-bit and a 1-bit adder. The third stage adder (A2,
B2, S2) is used merely as a means of getting a carry (C10) signal into the fourth MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
stage (via A2 and B2) and bringing out the carry from the second stage on S2. MC74FXXXN Plastic
Note that as long as A2 and B2 are the same, whether HIGH or LOW, they do MC74FXXXD SOIC
not influence S2. Similarly, when A2 and B2 are the same the carry into the third
stage does not influence the carry out of the third stage. Figure D shows a
method of implementing a 5-input encoder, where the inputs are equally LOGIC SYMBOL
weighted. The outputs S0, S1 and S2 present a binary number equal to the 7
number of inputs I1–I5 that are true. Figure E shows one method of implement-
ing a 5-input majority gate. When three or more of the inputs I1–I5 are true, the
output M5 is true. C0
A0 5
CONNECTION DIAGRAM 4 S0
B0 6
VCC B2 A2 S2 A3 B3 S3 C4 A1 3
1 S1
B1 2
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
A2 14
13 S2
B2 15
A3 12
10 S3
B3 11
C4
VCC = PIN 16
9 GND = PIN 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S1 B1 A1 S0 A0 B0 C0 GND
LOGIC DIAGRAM
C0 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
S0 S1 S2 S3 C4
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to
estimate propagation delays.
C10
A0 B0 A1 B1 A10 B10
L
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
C0 C4 C0 C0 C4 C11
S0 S1 S2 S3 S0 S1 S2 S3
C3
S0 S1 C2 S10
Figure B. 3-Bit Adder Figure C. 2-Bit and 1-Bit Adders
I3
I3 I1 I2 I4 I5
I1 I2 L I4 I5
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
C0 C4
C0 C4 S0 S1 S2 S3
S0 S1 S2 S3
20 21 22
M5
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 7.0 9.5 3.5 14 3.5 10.5
ns
tPHL C0 to Sn 4.0 7.0 9.5 4.0 14 4.0 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 7.0 9.5 3.0 14 3.0 10.5
ns
tPHL An or Bn to Sn 3.5 7.0 9.5 3.5 14 3.5 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 5.7 7.5 3.5 10.5 3.5 8.5
ns
tPHL C0 to C4 3.0 5.4 7.0 3.0 10 3.0 8.0
tPLH Propagation 3.0 5.7 7.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 8.5
ns
tPHL An or Bn to C4 3.0 5.3 7.0 3.0 10 3.0 8.0
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 MC74FXXXN Plastic
S0 OE1 OE2 I/O6 I/O4 I/O2 I/O0 Q0 SR GND MC74FXXXDW SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs
SR S1 S0 CP Response
L X X ↑ Synchronous Reset: Q0–Q7 = LOW
H H H ↑ Parallel Load: I/On → Qn
H L H ↑ Shift Right: DS0 → Q0, Q0 → Q1, etc.
H H L ↑ Shift Left: DS7 → Q7, Q7 → Q6, etc.
H L L X Hold
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
↑ = LOW-to-HIGH clock transition.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F323 contains eight edge-triggered D-type state changes are initiated by the LOW-to-HIGH CP transition.
flips-flops and the interstage logic necessary to perform Inputs can change when the clock is in either state provided
synchronous reset, shift left, shift right, parallel load and hold only that the recommended set-up and hold times, relative to
operations. The type of operation is determined by S0 and S1, the rising edge of CP, are observed.
as shown in the Function Table. All flip-flop outputs are A HIGH signal on either OE1 or OE2 disables the 3-state
brought out through 3-state buffers to separate I/O pins that buffers and puts the I/O pins in the high impedance state. In
also serve as data inputs in the parallel load mode. Q0 and Q7 this condition the shift, hold, load and reset operations can still
are also brought out on other pins for expansion in serial occur. The 3-state buffers are also disabled by HIGH signals
shifting of longer words. on both S0 and S1 in preparation for a parallel load operation.
A LOW signal on SR overrides the Select inputs and allows
the flip-flops to be reset by the next rising edge of CP. All other
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Input Frequency 70 70 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 9.0 3.5 10
ns
tPHL CP to Q0 or Q7 3.5 8.5 3.5 9.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 9.0 3.5 10
ns
tPHL CP to I/On 5.0 11 5.0 12
tPZH Output Enable Time to 3.5 8.0 3.5 9.0
ns
tPZL HIGH or LOW Level 4.0 10 4.0 11
tPHZ Output Disable Time to 2.0 6.0 2.0 7.0
ns
tPLZ HIGH or LOW Level 2.0 5.5 2.0 6.5
AC SETUP REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Set-Up Time, HIGH or LOW 8.5 8.5
ns
ts(L) S0 or S1 to CP 8.5 8.5
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0.0 0.0
ns
th(L) S0 or S1 to CP 0.0 0.0
ts(H) Set-Up Time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
ns
ts(L) I/On, DS0, DS7 to CP 5.0 5.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0
ns
th(L) I/On, DS0, DS7 to CP 2.0 2.0
ts(H) Set-Up Time, HIGH or LOW 10 10
ns
ts(L) SR to CP 10 10
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0.0 0.0
ns
th(L) SR to CP 0.0 0.0
tw(H) 7.0 7.0
CP Pulse Width
Width, HIGH or LOW ns
tw(L) 7.0 7.0
1 LOGIC DIAGRAM
19 S0
S1
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
= PIN NUMBERS
18
DS7
DS0
11
SR
9
CP
12
D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP
8 Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q 17
Q0
Q7
2
OE1
OE2 3 7 13 6 14 5 15 4 16
I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 GND
LOGIC DIAGRAM
I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 S1 S0 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3
GUARANTEED OPERATING RANGES
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit
VCC Supply Voltage 54, 74 4.5 5.0 5.5 V
54 – 55 25 125
TA Operating Ambient Temperature Range °C
74 0 25 70
IOH Output Current — High 54, 74 — — – 3.0 mA
IOL Output Current — Low 54, 74 — — 24 mA
DC CHARACTERISTICS OVER OPERATING TEMPERATURE RANGE (unless otherwise specified)
Limits
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions
VIH Input HIGH Voltage 2.0 V Guaranteed Input HIGH Voltage
VIL Input LOW Voltage 0.8 V Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage –1.2 V IIN = –18 mA VCC = MIN
54, 74 2.4 3.3 V IOH = – 3.0 mA VCC = 4.5 V
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.3 V IOH = – 3.0 mA VCC = 4.75 V
VOL Output LOW Voltage 0.35 0.5 V IOL = 24 mA VCC = MIN
IOZH Output OFF Current — HIGH 50 µA VOUT = 2.7 V VCC = MAX
IOZL Output OFF Current — LOW – 50 µA VOUT = 0.5 V VCC = MAX
20 VIN = 2.7 V
IIH Input HIGH Current µA VCC = MAX
100 VIN = 7.0 V
IIL Input LOW Current –1.2 mA VIN = 0.5 V VCC = MAX
Output Short Circuit
IOS – 60 –150 mA VOUT = 0 V VCC = MAX
Current (Note 2)
ICCH 22 35 Outputs HIGH
ICCL Power Supply Current 26 41 mA Outputs LOW VCC = MAX
ICCZ 26 42 Outputs OFF
NOTES: 1. For conditions such as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under guaranteed operating ranges.
NOTES: 2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.0 3.0 7.5 3.0 7.0
ns
tPHL In to 0n 2.5 5.5 2.5 7.0 2.5 6.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 10 4.0 13.5 4.0 11
ns
tPHL Sn to On 3.0 8.5 3.0 10 3.0 9.5
tPZH 2.5 7.0 2.5 10.5 2.5 8.0
Output
Out ut Enable Time ns
tPZL 4.0 9.0 4.0 11 4.0 10
tPHZ 2.0 5.5 2.0 7.0 2.0 6.5
Output
Out ut Disable Time ns
tPLZ 1.5 5.5 1.5 9.0 1.5 6.5
APPLICATIONS
GND
I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3
S0 S0 S0 S0
S1 S1 S1 S1
OE OE OE OE
Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3
S0
S1
OE
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
S1 S0
L L NO SHIFT
L H SHIFT 1 PLACE
H L SHIFT 2 PLACES
H H SHIFT 3 PLACES
I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3 I–3 I–2 I–1 I0 I1 I2 I3
S0 S0 S0 S0
S1 S1 S1 S1
OE OE OE OE
Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3
S0
S1
S2
S2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S2 S1 S0 S2 S1 S0
L L L NO SHIFT H L H SHIFT END AROUND 5
L L H SHIFT END AROUND 1 H H L SHIFT END AROUND 6
L H L SHIFT END AROUND 2 H H H SHIFT END AROUND 7
L H H SHIFT END AROUND 3
H L L SHIFT END AROUND 4
S0
S1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 S
S1 S0 SCALE
L L÷8 1/8
L H÷4 1/4
H L÷2 1/2
H H NO CHANGE 1
N SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
PLASTIC
Ea S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND CASE 648-08
16
1
D SUFFIX
LOGIC DIAGRAM SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
Ea I0a I1a I2a I3a S1 S0 I0b I1b I2b I3b Eb
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
2 14
S1 S0
Ea 1
I0a 6
I1a 5
7 Za
I2a 4
I3a 3
Za Zb I0b 10
I1b 11
9 Zb I2b 12
I3b 13
VCC = PIN 14 Eb 15
GND = PIN 7
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F352 is a dual 4-input multiplexer. It selects two bits of The F352 can be used to move data from a group of regis-
data from up to four sources under the control of the common ters to a common output bus. The particular register from
Select inputs (S0, S1).The two 4-input multiplexer circuits which the data came would be determined by the state of the
have individual active-LOW Enables(Ea, Eb) which can be Select inputs. A less obvious application is as a function gen-
used to strobe the outputs independently. When the Enables erator. The F352 can generate two functions of three vari-
(Ea, Eb) are HIGH, the corresponding outputs (Za, Zb) are ables. This is useful for implementing highly irregular random
forced HIGH. logic.
The logic equations for the outputs are shown below:
FUNCTION TABLE
Select
Inputs Inputs (a or b) Output
S0 S1 E I0 I1 I2 I3 Z
X X H X X X X H
L L L L X X X H
L L L H X X X L
H L L X L X X H
H L L X H X X L
L H L X X L X H
L H L X X H X L
H H L X X X L H
H H L X X X H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 7.4 11 3.0 14 3.0 12.5 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 3.0 7.0 8.5 2.5 11 2.5 9.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.0 7.0 2.0 10 2.0 8.0 ns
tPHL En to Zn 3.0 5.0 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 4.9 7.0 2.0 9.0 2.0 8.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 1.5 3.0 3.5 1.0 5.0 1.0 4.0
J SUFFIX
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
16
The MC54/74F353 contains two identical 4-input multiplexers with 3-state 1
outputs. They select two bits from four sources selected by common Select
inputs (S0, S1).The 4-input multiplexers have individual Output enable (OEa,
OEb) inputs which, when HIGH, force the outputs to a high impedance (high
Z) state. The logic equations for the outputs are shown below: N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 648-08
Za=OEa • (I0a • S1 • S0 +I1a • S1 • S0 + I2a • S1 • S0 + I3a • S1 • S0) 16
If the outputs of 3-state devices are tied together, all but one device must
D SUFFIX
be in the high impedance state to avoid high currents that would exceed the SOIC
maximum ratings. Designers should ensure that Output Enable signals to 16
1 CASE 751B-03
3-state devices whose outputs are tied together are designed so that there is
no overlap.
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
CONNECTION DIAGRAM (TOP VIEW) MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
VCC OEb S0 I3b I2b I1b I0b Zb
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
LOGIC SYMBOL
2 14
S1 S0
OEa 1
I0a 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I1a 5
OEa S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND 7 Za
I2a 4
I3a 3
I0b 10
I1b 11
9 Zb I2b 12
I3b 13
VCC = PIN 16 OEb 15
GND = PIN 8
FUNCTION TABLE
Select Output
Inputs Data Inputs Enable Output
S0 S1 I0 I1 I2 I3 OE Z
X X X X X X H (Z)
L L L X X X L H
L L H X X X L L
H L X L X X L H
H L X H X X L L
L H X X L X L H
L H X X H X L L
H H X X X L L H
H H X X X H L L
Address inputs S0 and S1 are common to both sections.
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
(Z) = High Impedance
LOGIC DIAGRAM
OEb I3b I2b I1b I0b S0 S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a OEa
Zb Za
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = - 55°C to + 125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 11 3.0 14 3.0 12.5 ns
tPHL Sn to Zn 3.0 8.5 2.5 11 2.5 9.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.0 2.0 9.0 2.0 8.0 ns
tPHL In to Zn 1.0 3.5 1.0 5.0 1.0 4.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 8.0 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.0
tPZL 3.5 8.0 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 5.0 2.0 7.0 1.5 6.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 6.0 1.5 8.0 1.5 7.0
MC54/74F365
HEX BUFFER/DRIVER MC54/74F366
GATED ENABLE
NONINVERTING AND INVERTING,
3-STATE F365
HEX BUFFER/DRIVER
CONNECTION DIAGRAM GATED ENABLE
NONINVERTING, 3-STATE
MC54/74F365
VCC OE2 I O I O I O F366
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 HEX BUFFER/DRIVER
GATED ENABLE
INVERTING, 3-STATE
FAST SCHOTTKY TTL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OE1 I O I O I O GND J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
MC54/74F366 CASE 620-09
16
VCC OE2 I O I O I O 1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OE1 I O I O I O GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE 16
1 CASE 751B-03
Inputs Outputs
OE1 OE2 I O O
ORDERING INFORMATION
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L L L L H
L = LOW Voltage Level MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
L L H H L X = Don’t Care
MC74FXXXN Plastic
Z = High Impedance
X H X Z Z MC74FXXXD SOIC
H X X Z Z
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay F365 2.0 4.5 6.5 2.0 8.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPHL In to On 3.0 5.5 7.0 3.0 8.5 3.0 7.5
tPLH Propagation Delay F366 2.0 5.0 6.5 2.0 8.5 2.0 7.5 ns
tPHL In to On 1.0 3.0 5.0 1.0 6.5 1.0 5.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 6.5 9.5 3.0 11 3.0 10 ns
tPZL to HIGH and LOW Level 4.0 6.0 9.0 4.0 10.5 4.0 9.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.5 4.5 6.5 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0 ns
tPLZ from HIGH and LOW Level 1.5 4.0 6.0 1.5 7.5 1.5 6.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OE1 I O I O I O GND J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
MC54/74F368 CASE 620-09
16
VCC OE2 I O I O I O 1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OE1 I O I O I O GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
FUNCTION TABLE 1 CASE 751B-03
Inputs Outputs
OE I O O H = HIGH Voltage Level ORDERING INFORMATION
L L L H L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
L H H L Z = High Impedance MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
H X Z Z
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay F367 2.0 4.5 6.5 2.0 8.0 2.0 7.0 ns
tPHL In to On 3.0 5.5 7.0 3.0 8.5 3.0 7.5
tPLH Propagation Delay F368 2.0 5.0 6.5 2.0 8.5 2.0 7.5 ns
tPHL In to On 1.0 3.0 5.0 1.0 6.5 1.0 5.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.5 5.5 7.5 2.5 9.5 2.5 8.5 ns
tPZL to HIGH and LOW Level 3.0 6.5 8.5 3.0 10 3.0 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.5 4.5 6.5 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0 ns
tPLZ from HIGH and LOW Level 1.5 4.0 6.0 1.5 7.5 1.5 6.5
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND
DW SUFFIX
20 SOIC
CASE 751D-03
1
LOGIC SYMBOL
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18 ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 MC74FXXXN Plastic
11 LE MC74FXXXDW SOIC
VCC = PIN 20
1 OE GND = PIN 10
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F373 contains eight D-type latches with 3-state output preceding the HIGH-to-LOW transition of LE. The 3-state buff-
buffers. When the Latch Enable (LE) input is HIGH, data on the ers are controlled by the Output Enable (OE) input. When (OE)
Dn inputs enters the latches. In this condition the latches are is LOW, the buffers are in the bi-state mode. When OE is HIGH
transparent; i.e., a latch output will change state each time its the buffers are in the high impedance mode, but this does not
D input changes. When LE is LOW the latches store the interfere with entering new data into the latches.
information that was present on the D inputs one setup time
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
D D D D D D D D
GO GO GO GO GO GO GO GO
LE
OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.3 7.0 3.0 8.5 3.0 8.0 ns
tPHL Dn to On 2.0 3.7 5.0 2.0 7.0 2.0 6.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 9.0 11.5 5.0 15 5.0 13 ns
tPHL LE to On 3.0 5.2 7.0 3.0 8.5 3.0 8.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 5.0 11 2.0 13.5 2.0 12 ns
tPZL 2.0 5.6 7.5 2.0 10 2.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.5 4.5 6.5 1.5 10 1.5 7.5 ns
tPLZ 1.5 3.8 6.0 1.5 7.0 1.5 6.0
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0 2.0
ts(L) Dn to LE 2.0 2.0 2.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.0 3.0
th(L) Dn to LE 3.0 3.0 3.0
tw(H) LE Pulse Width, HIGH 6.0 6.0 6.0 ns
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND
DW SUFFIX
20 SOIC
CASE 751D-03
1
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
ORDERING INFORMATION
Dn CP OE On
H L H MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
L L L MC74FXXXDW SOIC
X X H Z
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
LOGIC SYMBOL
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
11 CP
1 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F374 consists of eight edge-triggered flip-flops with LOW-to-HIGH Clock (CP) transition. With the Output Enable
individual D-type inputs and 3-state true outputs. The buffered (OE) LOW, the contents of the eight flip-flops are available at
clock and buffered Output Enable are common to all flip-flops. the outputs. When the OE is HIGH, the outputs go to the high
The eight flip-flops will store the state of their individual D impedance state. Operation of the OE input does not affect the
inputs that meet the setup and hold time requirements on the state of the flip-flops.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 60 70 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 10.5 4.0 10 ns
tPHL CP to On 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 11 4.0 10
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 9.0 11.5 2.0 14 2.0 12.5 ns
tPZL 2.0 5.8 7.5 2.0 10 2.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 5.3 7.0 2.0 8.0 2.0 8.0 ns
tPLZ 2.0 4.3 5.5 2.0 7.5 2.0 6.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts (H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.5 2.0
ts (L) Dn to CP 2.0 2.0 2.0 ns
th (H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0 2.0
th (L) Dn to CP 2.0 2.5 2.0
tw (H) CP Pulse Width, 7.0 7.0 7.0 ns
tw (L) HIGH or LOW 6.0 6.0 6.0
DW SUFFIX
20 SOIC
CASE 751D-03
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
E Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q2 D2 D3 Q3 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
Operating Mode CP E Dn Qn
Load “1” ↑ l h H
Load “0” ↑ l l L
Hold (do nothing) ↑ h X No Change
X H X No Change
H = HIGH voltage level steady state; h = HIGH voltage level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH Clock transition; L = LOW voltage level steady state; l =
LOW voltage level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition; X = Don’t Care; ↑ = LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F377 has eight edge-triggered D-type flip-flops The register is fully edge-triggered. The state of each D in-
with individual D inputs and Q outputs. The common buffered put, one setup time before the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition,
Clock (CP) input loads all flip-flops simultaneously, when the is transferred to the corresponding flip-flop’s Q output.
Enable (E) is LOW. The E input must be stable one setup time prior to the LOW-
to-HIGH clock transition for predictable operation.
ICCL 70 90 mA Dn = E = GND, CP = ↑
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 110 120 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 10 ns
tPHL CP to Qn 4.0 7.0 9.0 4.0 10.5
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
(3) (4) (7) (8) (13) (14) (17) (18)
E
(1)
D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q
CP CP CP CP CP CP CP CP
v
v
(11)
CP
(2) (5) (6) (9) (12) (15) (16) (19)
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.0 ns
ts(L) Dn to CP 3.0 3.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0 ns
th(L) Dn to CP 1.0 1.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.5 2.5 ns
ts(L) E to CP 4.0 4.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0 ns
th(L) E to CP 0 0
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width 4.0 5.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 4.0 5.0
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
E Q0 D0 D1 Q1 D2 Q2 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
FUNCTION TABLE MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXD SOIC
Inputs Output
E CP Dn Qn
H X No Change
LOGIC SYMBOL
L H H
L L L
14 D5
H = HIGH Voltage Level Q5 15
L = LOW Voltage Level 13 D4
Q4 12
X = Don’t Care 11 D3
Z = High Impedance Q3 10
6 D2
Q2 7
4 D1
Q1 5
3 D0
Q0 2
1 E
CP
9
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
E E E E E E
Q Q Q Q Q Q
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Input Frequency 80 140 80 80 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.5 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL CP to Qn 3.5 6.0 8.5 3.5 10.5 3.5 9.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 4.0 4.0
ts(L) Dn to CP 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0 0
th(L) Dn to CP 0 0 0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 6.0 6.0 6.0
ts(L) E to CP 6.0 6.0 6.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0 2.0
th(L) E to CP 2.0 2.0 2.0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width, 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 6.0 6.0 6.0
VCC Q3 Q3 D3 D2 Q2 Q2 CP
N SUFFIX
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
E Q0 Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q1 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
E CP Dn Qn Qn MC74FXXXD SOIC
H X NC NC
L H H L
LOGIC SYMBOL
L L L H
H = HIGH Voltage Level 15
L = LOW Voltage Level 13 D3 Q3
X = Don’t Care 14
NC = No Change 12 D2 10
Q2
11
5 D1
7
Q1
4 D0 6
2
1 E Q0
3
9
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D
E E E E
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
Q0 Q0 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q2 Q3 Q3
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 140 90 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 5.0 6.5 3.5 8.5 3.5 7.5 ns
tPHL CP to Qn, Qn 5.0 6.5 8.5 5.0 10.5 5.0 9.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.0 3.0
ts(L) Dn to CP 3.0 3.0 3.0 ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0 1.0
th(L) Dn to CP 1.0 1.0 1.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 6.0 6.0 6.0
ts(L) E to CP 6.0 6.0 6.0
ns
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0 2.0
th(L) E to CP 2.0 2.0 2.0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width, 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0 5.0
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM CERAMIC
VCC A2 B2 A3 B3 Cn P G F3 F2 CASE 732-03
20
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
A1 B1 A0 B0 S0 S1 S2 F0 F1 GND
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
LOGIC SYMBOL 1
3 4 1 2 19 18 17 16
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 ORDERING INFORMATION
15 Cn MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
7 G 13 VCC = PIN 20
S2 MC74FXXXN Plastic
6 GND = PIN 10 MC74FXXXDW SOIC
S1 P 14
5 S0
F0 F1 F2 F3
8 9 11 12
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Cn
B0 Please note that this diagram is provided
only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to
estimate propagation delays.
F0
A0
B1
F1
A1
B2
F2
A2
B3
F3
A3 P
F381
ONLY
S0 G
OVR
F382
Cn+4 ONLY
S1
S2
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
Signals applied to the Select inputs S0–S2 determine the ands, LOW for active-LOW operands) into the Cn input of the
mode of operation, as indicated in the Function Select Table. least significant package.
An extensive listing of input and output levels is shown in the The Carry Generate (G) and Carry Propagate (P) outputs
Truth Table. The circuit performs the arithmetic functions for supply input signals to the F182 carry lookahead generator for
either active-HIGH or active-LOW operands, with output lev- expansion to longer word length, as shown in Figure 1. Note
els in the same convention. In the Subtract operating modes, that an F382 ALU is used for the most significant package.
it is necessary to force a carry (HIGH for active-HIGH oper- Typical delays for Figure 1 are given in Figure 2.
Toward Output
p
Path Segment F Cn + 4, OVR
Ai or Bi to P 7.2 ns 7.2 ns
Pi to Cn + j (’F182) 6.2 ns 6.2 ns
Cn to F 8.1 ns —
Cn to Cn + 4 , OVR — 8.0 ns
Total Delay 21.5 ns 21.4 ns
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = – 55 to +125°C TA = 0 to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 8.1 12 2.5 15 2.5 13
ns
tPHL Cn to Fi 2.5 5.7 8.0 2.5 11 2.5 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 10.4 15 4.0 18 4.0 16
ns
tPHL Any A or B to Any F 3.5 8.2 11 3.5 14 3.5 12
tPLH Propagation 4.5 8.3 20 4.5 23.5 4.5 21.5
ns
tPHL Si to Fi 4.0 8.2 13 4.0 16 4.0 14
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.4 9.0 3.0 12 3.0 10
ns
tPHL Ai or Bi to G 4.0 6.8 10 4.0 13 4.0 11
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.2 10.5 2.5 13.5 2.5 11.5
ns
tPHL Ai or Bi to P 3.5 6.5 9.5 3.5 12.5 3.5 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 7.8 12 4.0 15 4.0 13
ns
tPHL Si to G or P 4.5 10.2 13.5 4.5 16.5 4.5 14.5
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
FUNCTION S0 S1 S2 Cn An Bn F0 F1 F2 F3 G P
CLEAR 0 0 0 X X X 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 0
0 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 0
0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
B MINUS A 1 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
1 1 0 1 0 0 0 1 1
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 0
0 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 0
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
A MINUS B 0 1 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1
1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0
0 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 0
A PLUS B 1 1 0
1 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1
1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
1 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
A⊕B 0 0 1
X 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0
X 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
A+B 1 0 1
X 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1
AB 0 1 1
X 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
X 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
PRESET 1 1 1
X 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
1 = HIGH Voltage Level
0 = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM CERAMIC
VCC A2 B2 A3 B3 Cn Cn+4 OVR F3 F2 CASE 732-03
20
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
A1 B1 A0 B0 S0 S1 S2 F0 F1 GND
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
LOGIC SYMBOL 1
3 4 1 2 19 18 17 16
ORDERING INFORMATION
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
15 Cn MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
7 S2 Cn+4 14 MC74FXXXN Plastic
6 S1 MC74FXXXDW SOIC
OVR 13
5 S0
F0 F1 F2 F3
8 9 11 12
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Cn
B0 Please note that this diagram is provided
only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to
estimate propagation delays.
F0
A0
B1
F1
A1
B2
F2
A2
B3
F3
A3 P
F381
ONLY
S0 G
OVR
F382
Cn+4 ONLY
S1
S2
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
Signals applied to the Select inputs S0–S2 determine the LOW for active LOW operands) into the Cn input of the least
mode of operation, as indicated in the Function Select Table. significant package. Ripple expansion is illustrated in Figure
An extensive listing of input and output levels is shown in the 1. The overflow output OVR is the Exclusive-OR of Cn + 3 and
Truth Table. The circuit performs the arithmetic functions for Cn+4; a HIGH signal on OVR indicates overflow in twos
either active HIGH or active LOW operands, with output levels complement operation. Typical delays for Figure 1 are given
in the same convention. In the Subtract operating modes, it is in Figure 2.
necessary to force a carry (HIGH for active HIGH operands,
3 3 3 3 3
SELECT
Toward Output
p
Path Segment F Cn + 4, OVR
Ai or Bi to Cn + 4 6.5 ns 6.5 ns
Cn to Cn + 4 6.3 ns 6.3 ns
Cn to Cn + 4 6.3 ns 6.3 ns
Cn to F 8.1 —
Cn to Cn + 4, OVR — 8.0 ns
Total Delay 27.2 ns 27.1 ns
Figure 2. 16-Bit Delay Tabulation
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 8.1 12 3.0 15 3.0 13
ns
tPHL Cn to Fi 2.5 5.7 8.0 2.5 11 2.5 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 10.4 15 4.0 18 4.0 16
ns
tPHL Any A or B to Any F 3.5 8.2 11 3.5 14 3.5 12
tPLH Propagation Delay 6.0 11 15 6.0 21 6.0 16
ns
tPHL Si to Fi 4.0 8.2 20.5 4.0 23.5 4.0 21.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 6.0 8.5 3.5 11.5 3.5 9.5
ns
tPHL Ai or Bi to Cn + 4 3.0 6.5 9.0 3.0 12.5 3.0 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 7.0 12.5 16.5 7.0 19.5 7.0 17.5
ns
tPHL Si to OVR or Cn + 4 4.5 9.0 12 4.5 15 4.5 13
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 5.6 8.0 2.5 11 2.5 9.0
ns
tPHL Cn to Cn + 4 2.5 6.3 9.0 2.5 12 2.5 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 8.0 11 3.5 14 3.5 12
ns
tPHL Cn to OVR 3.5 7.1 10 3.5 13 3.5 11
tPLH Propagation Delay 6.5 11.5 15.5 6.5 18.5 6.5 16.5
ns
tPHL Ai or Bi to OVR 5.5 8.0 10.5 5.5 13.5 5.5 11.5
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
Function S0 S1 S2 Cn An Bn F0 F1 F2 F3 OVR Cn + 4
0 X X 0 0 0 0 1 1
CLEAR 0 0 0
1 X X 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
0 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 1
0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
B MINUS A 1 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 1
1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 1
0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
A MINUS B 0 1 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 1
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 1
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
0 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
A PLUS B 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 1
1 1 0
1 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1
1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
A⊕B 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
X 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1
1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
A+B 1 0 1 X 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
X 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
AB 0 1 1 X 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
X 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
X 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
PRESET 1 1 1 X 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 = HIGH Voltage Level
0 = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
N SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PLASTIC
Qa Qa I0a I1a I1b I0b Qb Qb GND CASE 738-03
S 20
1
D Qc
4 5 7 6 14 15 17 16
I1c
CP Qc
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d
1 S
I0d
11 CP
D Qd Qa Qa Qb Qb Qc Qc Qd Qd
I1d CP Qd
2 3 9 8 12 13 19 18
CP
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
NOTES:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and
should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC54/74F398 is a high-speed quad 2-port register. It type output register is fully edge-triggered. The Data inputs
will select four bits of data from either of two sources (Ports) (I0x, I1x) and Select input (S) must be stable only a setup time
under control of a common Select input (S). The selected data prior to and hold time after the LOW-to-HIGH transition of the
is transferred to a 4-bit output register synchronous with the Clock input for predictable operation. The MC54/74F398 has
LOW-to-HIGH transition of the Clock input (CP). The 4-bit D- both Q and Q outputs.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
S I0 I1 Q Q
I I X L H
I h X H L
h X I L H
h X h H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
h = HIGH Voltage Level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
I = LOW Voltage Level; one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
X = Don’t Care
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = –0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 140 80 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.7 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL CP to Q or Q 3.0 6.8 9.5 3.0 11.5 3.0 10.0
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = –0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0V VCC = 5.0 V ±10% VCC = 5.0 V ±10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 4.5 3.0 ns
ts(L) In to CP 3.0 4.5 3.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.5 1.0 ns
th(L) In to CP 1.0 1.5 1.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 7.5 10.5 8.5 ns
ts(L) S to CP 7.5 10.5 8.5
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0 0 ns
th(L) S to CP 0 0 0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 7.0 5.0
N SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
S Qa I0a I1a I1b I0b Qb GND
1
D Qc
I1c 3 4 6 5 11 12 14 13
CP
D Qd 9 CP
Qa Qb Qc Qd
I1d CP
2 7 10 15
CP
VCC = PIN 16
NOTE: GND = PIN 8
This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and
should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC54/74F398 is a high-speed quad 2-port register. It type output register is fully edge-triggered. The Data inputs
will select four bits of data from either of two sources (Ports) (I0x, I1x) and Select input (S) must be stable only a setup time
under control of a common Select input (S). The selected data prior to and hold time after the LOW-to-HIGH transition of the
is transferred to a 4-bit output register synchronous with the Clock input for predictable operation.
LOW-to-HIGH transition of the Clock input (CP). The 4-bit D-
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
S I0 I1 Q
I I X L
I h X H
h X I L
h X h H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
h = HIGH Voltage Level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
I = LOW Voltage Level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
X = Don’t Care
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 140 80 100 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 5.7 7.5 3.0 9.5 3.0 8.5 ns
tPHL CP to Q 3.0 6.8 9.5 3.0 11.5 3.0 10.0
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to + 125°C TA = 0°C to 70°C
VCC = +5.0V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 4.5 3.0 ns
ts(L) In to CP 3.0 4.5 3.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.5 1.0 ns
th(L) In to CP 1.0 1.5 1.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 7.5 9.5 8.5 ns
ts(L) S to CP 7.5 9.5 8.5
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0 0 ns
th(L) S to CP 0 0 0
tw(H) CP Pulse Width 4.0 4.0 4.0 ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 7.0 5.0
N SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PLASTIC
IA = B A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 GND CASE 738-03
20
1
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
NOTE:
This diagram is provided only for the understanding
of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Output
IA = B A, B OA = B
L A = B* L
L A≠B H
H A = B* H
H A≠B H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
*A0 = B0, A1 = B1, A2 = B2, etc.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL= 50 pF CL= 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.5 10 2.5 15 2.5 11 ns
tPHL An or Bn to OA = B 3.0 6.5 10 3.0 12 3.0 11
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 4.5 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5 ns
tPHL IA = B to OA = B 3.5 5.0 9.0 3.5 10 3.5 10
Ripple Expansion
ENABLE IA = B IA = B IA = B
LOW OA = B OA = B OA = B
Parallel Expansion
IA = B IA = B IA = B
OA = B OA = B OA = B
Figure 1. Applications
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 DW SUFFIX
OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
LOGIC SYMBOL
ORDERING INFORMATION
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
11 LE
VCC = PIN 20
1 OE GND = PIN 10
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 9.0 4.0 12 4.0 10
ns
tPHL Dn to On 3.0 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 11 5.0 14 5.0 13
ns
tPHL LE to On 3.0 7.0 3.0 9.0 3.0 8.0
tPZH 2.0 10 2.0 12.5 2.0 11
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 2.0 7.5 2.0 9.0 2.0 8.5
tPHZ 1.5 6.5 1.5 8.5 1.5 7.0
Output Disable Time ns
tPLZ 1.5 5.5 1.5 7.5 1.5 6.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
LOGIC SYMBOL
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
ORDERING INFORMATION
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
11 CP MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
VCC = PIN 20 MC74FXXXN Plastic
1 OE GND = PIN 10 MC74FXXXDW SOIC
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F534 consists of eight edge-triggered flip-flops with LOW-to-HIGH Clock (CP) transition. With the Output Enable
individual D-type inputs and 3-state true outputs. The buffered (OE) LOW, the contents of the eight flip-flops are available at
clock and buffered Output Enable are common to all flip-flops. the outputs. When the OE is HIGH, the outputs go to the high
The eight flip-flops will store the state of their individual D impedance state. Operation of the OE input does not affect the
inputs that meet the setup and hold times requirements on the state of the flip-flops.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 60 70 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 10.5 4.0 10
ns
tPHL CP to On 4.0 6.5 8.5 4.0 11 4.0 10
tPZH 2.0 9.0 11.5 2.0 14 2.0 12.5
Output Enable Time
tPZL 2.0 5.8 7.5 2.0 10 2.0 8.5
ns
tPHZ 2.0 5.3 7.0 2.0 8.0 2.0 8.0
Output Disable Time
tPLZ 2.0 4.3 5.5 2.0 7.5 2.0 6.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts (H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.5 2.0
ts (L) Dn to CP 2.0 2.0 2.0
ns
th (H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 2.0 2.0 2.0
th (L) Dn to CP 2.0 2.5 2.0
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10 1
7
O2 O1 O0 P OE A0 A1 O5 O6 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
LOGIC DIAGRAM MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
A3 MC74FXXXDW SOIC
A2
A1
A0 LOGIC SYMBOL
E1 4 6 7 16 17
P A0 A1 A2 A3
E2
15 E1
14 E2
P 5 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9
3 2 1 19 18 8 9 11 12 13
VCC = PIN 20
OE GND = PIN 10
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and
should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 14 3.5 19 3.5 16
tPHL An to On 2.5 11 2.0 15 2.0 12
ns
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 11 4.0 14 4.0 12
tPHL E1 to On 3.0 11 3.0 14 3.0 12
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
FUNCTION
OE E1 E2 A3 A2 A1 A0 00 01 02 O3 04 05 06 07 08 09
HIGH Impedance H X X X X X X Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z
Disable L H X X X X X
Outputs
Out uts Equal P In
Input
ut
L X L X X X X
L L H L L L L H L L L L L L L L L
L L H L L L H L H L L L L L L L L
L L H L L H L L L H L L L L L L L
L L H L L H H L L L H L L L L L L
L L H L H L L L L L L H L L L L L
Active HIGH
L L H L H L H L L L L L H L L L L
Out ut
Output
L L H L H H L L L L L L L H L L L
(P = L)
L L H L H H H L L L L L L L H L L
L L H H L L L L L L L L L L L H L
L L H H L L H L L L L L L L L L H
L L H H X H X L L L L L L L L L L
L L H H H X X L L L L L L L L L L
L L H L L L L L H H H H H H H H H
L L H L L L H H L H H H H H H H H
L L H L L H L H H L H H H H H H H
L L H L L H H H H H L H H H H H H
L L H L H L L H H H H L H H H H H
Active LOW
L L H L H L H H H H H H L H H H H
Out ut
Output
L L H L H H L H H H H H H L H H H
(P = H)
L L H L H H H H H H H H H H L H H
L L H H L L L H H H H H H H H L H
L L H H L L H H H H H H H H H H L
L L H H X H X H H H H H H H H H H
L L H H H X X H H H H H H H H H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
1
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW)
VCC O3 O4 A2 E1 E2 E3 E4 P O7
N SUFFIX
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CASE 751D-03
1
O2 O1 O0 OE1 OE2 A0 A1 O5 O6 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
LOGIC DIAGRAM
MC74FXXXN Plastic
A2 MC74FXXXDW SOIC
A1
A0 LOGIC SYMBOL
E1
E2 12 6 7 17
E3
E4 P A0 A1 A2
16 E1
15 E2
P 14 E3
13 E4
4 OE1
5 OE2
OE1 O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
OE2
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 3 2 1 14 18 8 9 11
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and VCC = PIN 20
should not be used to estimate propagation delays. GND = PIN 10
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55 to +125′C TA = 0 to 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 11 13 4.0 17 4.0 14
tPHL An to On 3.0 7.5 12.5 3.0 16.5 3.0 13.5
ns
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 8.5 12 3.5 15 3.5 13
tPHL E1 or E2 to On 3.0 6.5 12 3.0 14.5 3.0 12.5
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
FUNCTION
OE1 OE2 E1 E2 E3 E4 A2 A1 A0 O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
High H X X X X X X X X Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z
Impedance X H X X X X X X X Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z
L L H X X X X X X
L L X H X X X X X
Disable Outputs
Out uts Equal P In
Input
ut
L L X X L X X X X
L L X X X L X X X
L L L L H H L L L H L L L L L L L
L L L L H H L L H L H L L L L L L
L L L L H H L H L L L H L L L L L
Active HIGH L L L L H H L H H L L L H L L L L
Output
(P = L) L L L L H H H L L L L L L H L L L
L L L L H H H L H L L L L L H L L
L L L L H H H H L L L L L L L H L
L L L L H H H H H L L L L L L L H
L L L L H H L L L L H H H H H H H
L L L L H H L L H H L H H H H H H
L L L L H H L H L H H L H H H H H
Active LOW L L L L H H L H H H H H L H H H H
Output
(P = H) L L L L H H H L L H H H H L H H H
L L L L H H H L H H H H H H L H H
L L L L H H H H L H H H H H H L H
L L L L H H H H H H H H H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
DW SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
SOIC
O2b O1b O0b Pb OEb A0a A1a O3a O2a GND 20
CASE 751D-03
1
E
LOGIC SYMBOL
13 6 7
P A0 A1
P 15 E
DECODER a
14 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3
12 11 9 8
VCC = PIN 20
4 17 18 GND = PIN 10
OE P A0 A1
16 E
DECODER b
O0 O1 O2 O3 5 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and
should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
3 2 1 19
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = –55 to +125°C TA = 0 to 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 12.5 3.0 18.5 3.0 13.5
ns
tPHL An to On 3.0 12.5 2.5 16 2.5 13
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 11 2.5 14 3.0 12
ns
tPHL E to On 3.0 11 3.0 13.5 3.0 11.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 9.5 3.5 12.5 3.5 10.5
ns
tPHL P to On 3.5 9.5 3.0 11.5 3.0 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 14.5 4.0 19.5 4.0 15.5
ns
tPHL P to On 3.0 9.0 3.0 11.5 3.0 9.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.5 7.5 2.0 10.5 2.0 8.5
tPZL OE to On 4.0 10 3.5 13.5 3.5 11.5
ns
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.5 6.0 1.0 7.5 1.0 6.5
tPLZ OE to On 2.0 8.0 1.5 9.5 1.5 8.5
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
LEBA OEBA A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 EAB GND
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F543 contains two sets of eight D-type latches, transition of the LEAB signal puts the A latches in the storage
with separate input and controls for each set. For data flow mode and their outputs no longer change with the A inputs.
from A to B, for example, the A-to-B Enable (EAB) Input must With EAB and OEAB both LOW, the 3-State B output buffers
be LOW in order to enter data from A0 – A7 or take data from are active and reflects the data present at the output of the A
B0 – B7, as indicated in the Function Table. With EAB LOW, a latches. Control of data flow from B to A is similar, but using
LOW signal on the A-to-B Latch Enable (LEAB) input makes the EBA, LEBA, and OEBA inputs.
the A-to-B latches transparent; a subsequent LOW-to-HIGH
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = + 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 70 100 70 MHz
Propagation Delay
tPLH 3.0 5.5 7.5 3.0 8.5
Transparent Mode ns
tPHL 3.0 5.0 6.5 3.0 7.5
An to Bn or Bn to An
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 8.5 11 4.5 12.5
ns
tPHL LEBA to An 4.5 8.5 11 4.5 12.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 8.5 11 4.5 12.5
ns
tPHL LEAB to Bn 4.5 8.5 11 4.5 12.5
Output Enable Time to
tPZH 3.0 7.0 9.0 3.0 10
OEBA or OEAB to An or Bn ns
tPZL 4.0 7.5 10.5 4.0 12
EBA or EAB to An or Bn
Output Disable Time to
tPHZ 2.5 6.0 8.0 2.5 9.0
OEBA or OEAB to An or Bn ns
tPLZ 2.0 5.5 7.5 2.0 8.5
EBA or EAB to An or Bn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = + 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.5
ns
ts(L) An or Bn to LEBA or LEAB 3.0 3.5
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 3.5
ns
th(L) An to Bn to LEBA or LEAB 3.0 3.5
Latch Enable, B to A
tw(L) 8.0 9.0 ns
Pulse Width, LOW
LOGIC DIAGRAM
DETAIL A
D Q B0
LE
Q D
A0
LE
A1 B1
A2 B2
A3 B3
A4 DETAIL A X 7 B4
A5 B5
A6 B6
A7 B7
OEBA
OEAB
EBA
LEBA EAB
LEAB
NOTE:
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
LEBA OEBA A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 EAB GND
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs
OEXX EXX LEXX Data Outputs Status
H X X X Z Outputs disabled
X H X X Z Outputs disabled
L ↑ L l Z Outputs disabled
L ↑ L h Z Data latched
L L ↑ l H
Data latched
L L ↑ h L
L L L L H
Transparent
L L L H L
L L H X NC Hold
H = HIGH voltage level: h = HIGH state must be present one set-up time before the LOW-to-HIGH transition of LEXX or EXX (XX = AB or BA): L = LOW voltage level:
l = LOW state must be present one set-up time before the LOW-to-HIGH transition of LEXX or EXX (XX = AB or BA): X = Don’t care: Z = HIGH impedance state:
NC = No Change.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F544 contains two sets of eight D-type latches, transition of the LEAB signal puts the A latches in the storage
with separate input and controls for each set. For data flow mode and their outputs no longer change with the A inputs.
from A to B, for example, the A-to-B Enable (EAB) input must With EAB and OEAB both LOW, the 3-State B output buffers
be LOW in order to enter data from A0 – A7 or take data from are active and reflect the inverted data present at the output
B0 – B7, as indicated in the Function Table. With EAB LOW, of the A latches. Control of data flow from B to A is similar, but
a LOW signal on the A-to-B latch enable (LEAB) input makes using the EBA, LEBA, and OEBA inputs.
the A-to-B latches transparent; a subsequent LOW-to-HIGH
DC CHARACTERISTICS OVER OPERATING TEMPERATURE RANGE (unless otherwise specified)
Limits Test Conditions
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit (Note 1)
VIH Input HIGH Voltage 2.0 — — V Guaranteed Input HIGH Voltage
VIL Input LOW Voltage — — 0.8 V Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage — – 0.73 – 1.2 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
2.4 — — VCC = 4.5 V
A0 – A7 74 V IOH = – 3.0
3 0 mA
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 2.7 3.4 — VCC = 4.75 V
B0 – B7 74 2.0 — — V IOH = – 15 mA VCC = 4.5 V
A0 – A7 74 — 0.35 0.5 V IOL = 24 mA
VOL Output LOW Voltage VCC = MIN
B0 – B7 74 — 0.4 0.55 V IOL = 64 mA
I/O Pins — — 1.0 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 5.5 V
Control Pins — — 100 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
IIH Input HIGH Current
Control Pins — — 20 µA
VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 2
2.7
7V
I/O Pins — — 70 µA
EAB, EBA — — – 1.2
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 0
0.5
5V
Other Inputs — — – 0.6
IOZH Off-State Output Current — — 70 µA VCC = MAX, VOUT = 2.7 V
Off-State Output Current,
IOZL — — – 600 µA VCC = MAX, VOUT = 0.5 V
Low-Level Voltage Applied
An Outputs – 60 — –150
IOS Output Short Circuit Current (Note 2) mA VCC = MAX,
MAX VOUT = 0 V
Bn Outputs – 100 — –225
ICCH — 70 105
ICC Total Supply Current ICCL — 95 130 mA VCC = MAX
ICCZ — 95 125
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0 °C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = + 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
Propagation Delay
tPLH 2.0 — 9.5 2.0 10.5
Transparent Mode ns
tPHL 2.0 — 6.5 2.0 7.5
An to Bn or Bn to An
tPLH Propagation Delay 6.0 — 13 6.0 14.5
ns
tPHL LEBA to An 4.0 — 9.5 4.0 10.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 6.0 — 13 6.0 14.5
ns
tPHL LEAB to Bn 4.0 — 9.5 4.0 10.5
Output Enable Time
tPZH 3.0 — 9.0 3.0 10
OEBA or OEAB to An or Bn ns
tPZL 4.0 — 10.5 4.0 12
EBA or EAB to An or Bn
Output Disable Time
tPHZ 1.5 — 8.0 1.5 9.0
OEBA or OEAB to An or Bn ns
tPLZ 1.5 — 7.5 1.5 8.5
EBA or EAB to An or Bn
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = + 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 — — 3.0 — —
ns
ts(L) An or Bn to LEBA or LEAB 3.0 — — 3.0 — —
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 — — 3.0 — —
ns
th(L) An to Bn to LEBA or LEAB 3.0 — — 3.0 — —
tw(L) Latch Enable, B to A
6.0 — — 7.5 — — ns
Pulse Width, LOW
LOGIC DIAGRAM
DETAIL A
D Q B0
LE D
A0 Q LE
A1 B1
A2 B2
A3 B3
A4 DETAIL A X 7 B4
A5 B5
A6 B6
A7 B7
OEBA
OEAB
EBA
EAB
LEBA
LEAB
NOTE:
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
CONNECTION DIAGRAM 20
CASE 751D-03
VCC TC CC OE O0 O1 O2 O3 CET PE 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
U/D CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP MR SR GND
LOGIC SYMBOL
11 3 4 5 6
PE P0 P1 P2 P3
1 U/D
7 CEP
CC 18
12 CET
TC 19
2 CP
17 OE
MR SR O0 O1 O2 O3
8 9 16 15 14 13
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The F568 counts modulo-10 in the BCD (8421) sequence. od is the CP to TC delay of the first stage plus the CEP to CP
From state 9 (HLLH) it will increment to 0 (LLLL) in the Up setup time of the last stage. The TC output is subject to decod-
mode; in Down mode it will decrement from 0 to 9.The F569 ing spikes due to internal race conditions and is therefore not
counts in the modulo-16 binary sequence. From state 15 it will recommended for use as a clock or asynchronous reset for
increment to state 0 in the Up mode; in the Down mode it will flip-flops, registers or counters. For such applications, the
decrement from 0 to 15. The clock inputs of all flip-flops are Clocked Carry (CC) output is provided. The CC output is nor-
driven in parallel through a clock buffer. All state changes (ex- mally HIGH. When CEP, CET, and TC are LOW, the CC output
cept due to Master Reset) occur synchronously with the LOW- will go LOW when the clock next goes LOW and will stay LOW
to-HIGH transition of the Clock Pulse (CP) input signal. until the clock goes HIGH again, as shown in the CC Truth
The circuits have five fundamental modes of operation, in Table. When the Output Enable (OE) is LOW, the parallel data
order of precedence: asynchronous reset, synchronous reset, outputs O0–O3 are active and follow the flip-flop Q outputs. A
parallel load, count and hold. Five control inputs — Master Re- HIGH signal on OE forces O0–O3 to the High Z state but does
set (MR), Synchronous Reset (SR), Parallel Enable (PE), not prevent counting, loading or resetting.
Count Enable Parallel (CEP) and Count Enable Trickle (CET) LOGIC EQUATIONS:
— plus the Up/Down (U/D) input, determine the mode of op- Count Enable = CEP⋅CET⋅PE
eration, as shown in the Mode Select Table. A LOW signal on Up (’F568): TC = Q0⋅Q1⋅Q2⋅Q3⋅(Up)⋅CET
MR overrides all other inputs and asynchronously forces the
(’F569): TC = Q0⋅Q1⋅Q2⋅Q3⋅(Up)⋅CET
flip-flop Q outputs LOW. A LOW signal on SR overrides count-
Down (Both): TC = Q0⋅Q1⋅Q2⋅Q3⋅(Down)⋅CET
ing and parallel loading and allows the Q outputs to go LOW
on the next rising edge of CP. A LOW signal on PE overrides CC TRUTH TABLE
counting and allows information on the Parallel Data (Pn) in- Inputs Output
puts to be loaded into the flip-flops on the next rising edge of
SR PE CEP CET TC* CP CC
CP. With MR, SR and PE HIGH, CEP and CET permit counting
when both are LOW. Conversely, a HIGH signal on either CEP L X X X X X H
or CET inhibits counting. X L X X X X H
The F568 and F569 use edge-triggered flip-flops and X X H X X X H
changing the SR, PE, CEP , CET or U/D inputs when the CP X X X H X X H
is in either state does not cause errors, provided that the rec- X X X X H X H
ommended setup and hold times, with respect to the rising H H L L L
edge of CP, are observed. * = TC is generated internally X = Don’t Care
Two types of outputs are provided as overflow/underflow in- L = LOW Voltage Level = Low Pulse
dicators. The Terminal Count (TC) output is normally HIGH H = HIGH Voltage Level
and goes LOW providing CET is LOW, when the counter FUNCTION TABLE
reaches zero in the Down mode, or reaches maximum (9 for
the F568,15 for the F569) in the Up mode. TC will then remain Inputs
Operating Mode
LOW until a state change occurs, whether by counting or pre- MR SR PE CEP CET U/D CP
setting, or until U/D or CET is changed. To implement synchro- L X X X X X X Asynchronous reset
nous multistage counters, the connections between the TC
h l X X X X ↑ Synchronous reset
output and the CEP and CET inputs can provide either slow
or fast carry propagation. Figure A shows the connections for h h l X X X ↑ Parallel load
simple ripple carry, in which the clock period must be longer Count up
than the CP to TC delay of the first stage, plus the cumulative h h h l l h ↑
(increment)
CET to TC delays of the intermediate stages, plus the CET to
Count down
CP setup time of the last stage. This total delay plus setup time h h h l l l ↑
(decrement)
sets the upper limit on clock frequency. For faster clock rates,
the carry lookahead connections shown in Figure B are rec- h H H H X X X
Hold (do nothing)
ommended. In this scheme the ripple delay through the inter- h H H X H X X
mediate stages commences with the same clock that causes
H = HIGH voltage level
the first stage to tick over from max to min in the Up mode, or
h = HIGH voltage level one setup prior to the Low-to-High Clock transition
min to max in the Down mode, to start its final cycle. Since this L = LOW voltage level
final cycle takes 10 (F568) or 16 (F569) clocks to complete, l = LOW voltage level one setup prior to the Low-to-High clock transition
there is plenty of time for the ripple to progress through the in- X = Don’t care
termediate stages. The critical timing that limits the clock peri- ↑ = Low-to-High clock transition
MC54/74F568 MC54/74F569
P0 P1 P2 P3 P0 P1 P2 P3
PE PE
CEP CEP
CET CET
T LD T LD
AT AT
TC AF TC
AF
4-225
CC ENF
ENF CC
LD T BT LD T BT
BF BF
U/D UP U/D UP
UP DETAIL A UP DETAIL A
DETAIL A DN DETAIL A
DETAIL A
DN DN
CP SR CP ENF CP
SR CP ENF
CD Q SR CD Q SR
CP CP CP
CP
MC54/74F568 • MC54/74F569
J CP K J CP K
CD CD
Q Q Q Q
SR SR
DETAIL A Q CD DETAIL A Q CD
MR MR
OE OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O0 O1 O2 O3
Please note that these diagrams are provided only for the understanding of logic
operations and should not be used to estimate propagation delays.
MC54/74F568 • MC54/74F569
CP TO ALL STAGES
CP TO ALL STAGES
STATE DIAGRAMS
MC54/74F568 MC54/74F569
0 1 2 3 0 1 2 3 4
15 5
10 15
9 4 13 14 6
11 14
13 7
8 7 6 5 12 12 11 10 9 8
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55 to + 125°C TA = 0 to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fmax Maximum Clock Frequency 100 60 85 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 8.5 3.0 10.5 3.0 9.5
ns
tPHL CP to On (PE HIGH or LOW) 4.0 11.5 4.0 14 4.0 13
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.5 15.5 5.5 18.5 5.5 17.5
ns
tPHL CP to TC 4.0 11 4.0 13.5 4.0 12.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.0 2.5 8.0 2.5 7.0
ns
tPHL CET to TC 2.5 8.0 2.5 10 2.5 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 11 3.5 13.5 3.5 12.5
ns
tPHL U/D to TC (′F568) 4.0 16 4.0 19 4.0 18
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 11 3.5 13.5 3.5 12.5
ns
tPHL U/D to TC (′F569) 4.0 10.5 4.0 13 4.0 12
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
ns
tPHL CP to CC 2.0 6.0 2.0 8.0 2.0 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 6.5 2.5 8.5 2.5 7.5
ns
tPHL CEP, CET to CC 4.0 11 4.0 13.5 4.0 12.5
Propagation Delay
tPHL 5.0 13 5.0 15.5 5.0 14.5 ns
MR to On
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.5 7.0 2.5 9.0 2.5 8.0
ns
tPZL OE to On 3.0 8.0 3.0 10 3.0 9.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.5 6.5 1.5 8.5 1.5 7.5
ns
tPLZ OE to On 2.0 6.0 2.0 8.0 2.0 7.0
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54 / 74F 54F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = – 55°C to + 125°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
VCC O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 CP 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 DW SUFFIX
OE D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 GND SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
LOGIC SYMBOL
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
ORDERING INFORMATION
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
11 MC74FXXXN Plastic
CP
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
1 OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Internal Outputs
Operating Mode
OE CP Dn Register Q0–Q7
L ↑ l L L
Load and read register
L ↑ h H H
L ↑ X NC NC Hold
H ↑ Dn Dn Z
Disable outputs
H X X X Z
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The MC74F574 consists of eight edge-triggered flip-flops on the LOW-to-HIGH Clock (CP) transition. With the Output
with individual D-type inputs and 3-state true outputs. The Enable (OE) LOW, the contents of the eight flip-flops are avail-
buffered clock and buffered Output Enable are common to all able at the outputs. When the OE is HIGH, the outputs go to
flip-flops. The eight flip-flops will store the state of their individ- the high impedance state. Operation of the OE input does not
ual D inputs that meet the setup and hold times requirements affect the state of the flip-flops.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 100 — — 70 — MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.5 — 8.5 2.5 8.5
ns
tPHL CP to On 2.5 — 8.5 2.5 8.5
tPZH 3.0 — 9.0 2.5 10.0
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 3.0 — 9.0 2.5 10.0
tPHZ 1.5 — 5.5 1.5 6.5
Output Disable Time ns
tPLZ 1.0 — 5.5 1.0 6.5
AC OPERATING CHARACTERISTICS
54 / 74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 2.5 — — 2.5 — —
ns
ts(L) Dn to CP 2.0 — — 3.0 — —
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH to LOW 2.0 — — 2.0 — —
ns
th(L) Dn to CP 2.0 — — 2.0 — —
tw(H) CP Pulse Width 5.0 — — 5.0 — —
ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 — — 5.0 — —
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ORDERING INFORMATION
CP I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 GND I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7 MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
LOGIC SYMBOL MC74FXXXDW SOIC
13 12 20 19 14
PE CS MR SR U/D
1 CP
18 CEP
TC 15
17 CET
11 OE
I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FUNCTION TABLE
MR SR CS PE CEP CET U/D OE CP Function
X X H X X X X X X I/O0 to I/O7 in Hi-Z (PE disabled)
X X L H X X X H X I/O0 to I/O7 in Hi-Z
X X L H X X X L X Flip-Flop outputs appear on I/O lines
L X X X X X X X X Asynchronous reset for all flip-flops
H L X X X X X X ↑ Synchronous reset for all flip-flops
H H L L X X X X ↑ Parallel load all flip-flops
H H (not LL) H X X X ↑ Hold
H H (not LL) X H X X ↑ Hold (TC held high)
H H (not LL) L L H X ↑ Count up
H H (not LL) L L L X ↑ Count down
H = High voltage level L = Low voltage level
X = Don’t care ↑ = Low-to-High clock transition
(not LL) = CS and PE should never both be low voltage at the same time
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage –0.73 – 1.2 V VCC = 4.5 V, IIN = – 18 mA
I/On 1.0 mA VIN = 5.5 V
VCC = 5
5.5
5V
others 100 µA VIN = 7.0 V
IIH Input HIGH Current
I/On 70
µA VCC = 5
5.5
5VV, VIN = 2
2.7
7V
others 20
Except
IIL Input LOW Current –0.6 mA VCC = 5.5 V, VIN = 0.5 V
I/On
OFF-State Current
IOZH 70 VOUT = 2.7 V
High-Level Voltage Applied
I/On µA VCC = 5
5.5
5V
OFF-State Current
IOZL –600 VOUT = 0.5 V
Low-Level Voltage Applied
IOS Output Short Circuit Current (Note 3) – 60 –80 –150 mA VCC = MAX, VOUT = 0 V
ICCH 95 135
ICC Total Supply Current (total) ICCL 105 145 mA VCC = MAX
ICCZ 105 150
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under guaranteed operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. All typical values are at VCC = 5.0 V, TA = 25°C.
3. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time. For IOS testing, the use of high-speed test apparatus and/or sample-and-hold techniques are prefer-
able in order to minimize internal heating and more accurately reflect operational values. Otherwise, prolonged shorting of a HIGH output may raise the chip
temperature well above normal and thereby cause invalid readings in other parameter tests. In any sequence of parameter tests, IOS tests should be per-
formed last.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 100 80 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 10.5 5.0 11.5
ns
tPHL CP to I/On 5.0 10.5 5.0 11.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 10 4.5 11
ns
tPHL CP to TC 5.5 10 5.0 11
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 8.0 3.5 9.0
ns
tPHL U/D to TC 4.5 8.0 4.5 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.5 7.0 3.5 8.5
ns
tPHL CET to TC 3.5 8.0 3.5 8.5
Propagation Delay
tPHL 5.0 10 5.0 11 ns
MR to I/On
tPZH Output Enable Time to HIGH or 4.5 10.5 4.5 11.5
ns
tPZL LOW Level CS, PE to I/On 6.5 10.5 6.0 11.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time to HIGH or 3.0 7.5 3.0 9.0
ns
tPLZ LOW Level CS, PE to I/On 4.0 9.5 4.0 11
tPZH Output Enable Time to HIGH or 4.0 8.5 4.0 9.5
ns
tPZL LOW Level OE to I/On 6.0 9.5 5.0 10.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time to HIGH or 1.0 6.0 1.0 6.5
ns
tPLZ LOW Level OE to I/On 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0
AC SETUP REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = + 25°C TA = 0°C to + 70°C
VCC = + 5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 3.0 4.0
ns
ts(L) I/On to CP 3.0 4.0
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 1.0
ns
th(L) I/On to CP 1.0 1.0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 9.5 10
ns
ts(L) PE, SR or CS to CP 9.5 10
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
ns
th(L) PE, SR or CS to CP 0 0
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.5
ns
ts(L) CET, CEP to CP 9.0 10.5
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
ns
th(L) CET, CEP to CP 0 0
tw CP Pulse Width 4.5 6.0 ns
tw(L) MR Pulse Width 3.5 4.5 ns
trec MR Recovery Time 4.0 4.5 ns
LOGIC DIAGRAM
SR
LOAD CONTROL CPMR
PE
CE
OE DETAIL A
I/O0
DETAIL A
I/O1
DETAIL A
I/O2
DETAIL A
I/O3
DETAIL A
I/O4
DETAIL A
I/O5
DETAIL A
I/O6
DETAIL A
I/O7
DOWN
U/D UP
CEP
CET
TC
TOGGLE CP MR
DATA
MR
LOAD D Q
CP Q
Q
Q
Detail A
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
PIN ASSIGNMENTS
F620 F623
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OEAB A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND OEAB A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
LOGIC SYMBOLS
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7
1 OEAB 1 OEAB
F620 F623
19 OEBA 19 OEBA
B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Operating Modes
OEBA OEAB F620 F623
L L B data to A bus B data to A bus
H H A data to B bus A data to B bus
H L Z Z
B data to A bus B data to A bus
L H A data to B bus A data to B bus
H = HIGH voltage level: L = LOW voltage level: X = Don’t care: Z = High impedance “off” state
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
F620 F623
19 19
OEBA OEBA
1 1
OEAB OEAB
2 18 2 18
A0 B0 A0 B0
3 17 3 17
A1 B1 A1 B1
4 16 4 16
A2 B2 A2 B2
5 15 5 15
A3 B3 A3 B3
6 14 6 14
A4 B4 A4 B4
7 13 7 13
A5 B5 A5 B5
8 12 8 12
A6 B6 A6 B6
9 11 9 11
A7 B7 A7 B7
N SUFFIX
PIN ASSIGNMENT PLASTIC
VCC OE B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 CASE 738-03
20
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
T/R A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
FUNCTION TABLE MC74FXXXDW SOIC
19 OE
B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
Vout = LOW
ICC Power Supply Current ICCL 120 mA VCC = MAX
T/R = 0 V
OE = 4.5 V
ICCZ 100
Vout = HIGH Z
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
19
OE
1
T/R
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
VCC = PIN 20 B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
GND = PIN 10
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
RL = 500 Ω RL = 500 Ω
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 7.0 2.0 8.0
ns
tPHL An to Bn, Bn to An 1.0 5.0 1.0 5.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.5 11 3.5 13
ns
tPZL to High or Low Level 6.0 11 6.0 12
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.5 8.0 1.5 9.0
ns
tPLZ to High or Low Level 1.0 7.0 1.0 7.5
N SUFFIX
24
F646 PLASTIC
1
CASE 724-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CPAB SAB DIR A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
DW SUFFIX
VCC CPBA SBA OE B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 24 SOIC
1 CASE 751E-03
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
ORDERING INFORMATION
F648
MC54FXXXJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXN Plastic
MC74FXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CPAB SAB DIR A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
LOGIC SYMBOLS
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
A A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7
1 CPAB 0 1 CPAB 0
2 SAB 2 SAB
3 DIR 3 DIR
23 F646 23 F648
CPBA CPBA
22 SBA 22 SBA
21 OE B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 21 OE B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
This document contains information on a product under development. Motorola reserves the right to change or discontinue this product without notice.
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Data I/O*
Operation/F nction
Operation/Function
OE bar DIR CPAB CPBA SAB SBA A0–A7 B0–B7
H X H or L H or L X X Input Input Isolation
H X ↑ X X X Input Input Store An Data in A Register
H X X ↑ X X Input Input Store Bn Data in B Register
H X ↑ ↑ X X Input Input Store An/Bn Data in A/B Register
L H X X L X Input Output An to Bn — Real Time (Transparent Mode)
L H ↑ X L X Input Output Store An Data in A Register
L H H or L X H X Input Output A Register to Bn (Stored Mode)
L H ↑ X H X Input Output Clock An Data to Bn and into A Register
L L X X X L Output Input Bn to An — Real Time (Transparent Mode)
L L X ↑ X L Output Input Store Bn Data in B Register
L L X H or L X H Output Input B Register to An (Stored Mode)
L L X ↑ X H Output Input Clock An Data to Bn and into B Register
*The data output function may be enabled or disabled by various signals at the OE bar and DIR inputs. Data input functions are always enabled; i.e., data at the
*bus pins will be stored on every low-to-high transition of the appropriate clock inputs.
H = HIGH voltage level
L = LOW voltage level
X = Don’t Care
↑ = Low-to-High transition
LOGIC DIAGRAM
F646
OE
DIR
CPBA
SBA
SAB
CPAB
1 OF 8 CHANNELS
C0
A0 D0 B0
D0
C0
TO 7 OTHER CHANNELS
LOGIC DIAGRAM
F648
OE
DIR
CPBA
SBA
SAB
CPAB
1 OF 8 CHANNELS
C0
A0 D0 B0
D0
C0
TO 7 OTHER CHANNELS
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10% VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
RL = 500 Ω RL = 500 Ω RL = 500 Ω
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 100 — 75 — 90 — MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 7.0 2.0 8.5 2.0 8.0 ns
tPHL Clock to Bus 2.0 8.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 9.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 1.0 7.0 1.0 8.0 1.0 7.5 ns
tPHL Bus to Bus (F646) 1.0 6.5 1.0 8.0 1.0 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 1.0 7.0 1.0 10.0 1.0 7.5 ns
tPHL Bus to Bus (F648) 1.0 6.5 1.0 9.0 1.0 7.0
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 7.5 2.0 10.0 2.0 9.0 ns
tPHL SBA or SAB to An or Bn 2.0 7.5 2.0 10.0 2.0 9.0
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5 ns
tPZL OE to An or Bn 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.0 7.0 1.0 9.5 1.0 8.5 ns
tPLZ OE to An or Bn 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5 ns
tPZL DIR to An or Bn 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5
tPHZ Output Disable Time 1.0 7.0 1.0 9.5 1.0 8.5 ns
tPLZ DIR to An or Bn 2.0 7.0 2.0 9.5 2.0 8.5
AC OPERATING REQUIREMENTS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = –55°C to +125°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10% VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
RL = 500 Ω RL = 500 Ω RL = 500 Ω
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
ts(H) Setup Time, HIGH or LOW 4.0 — 5.0 — 5.0 — ns
ts(L) Bus to Clock 4.0 — 5.0 — 5.0 —
th(H) Hold Time, HIGH or LOW 0.0 — 0.0 — 0.0 — ns
th(L) Bus to Clock 0.0 — 0.0 — 0.0 —
tw(H) Clock Pulse Width 4.0 — 4.0 — 4.0 — ns
tw(L) HIGH or LOW 5.0 — 5.0 — 5.0 —
PIN ASSIGNMENT
DW SUFFIX
OE B0 B1 B2 B3 GND GND B4 B5 B6 B7 PARITY 24 SOIC
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 1 CASE 751E-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXAJ/BJ Ceramic
MC74FXXXAN/BN Plastic
MC74FXXXADW/BDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
T/R A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 VCC A5 A6 A7 ODD/ ERROR
EVEN
LOGIC SYMBOL
2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7
1 T/R
PARITY 13
24 OE
11 EVEN/ODD ERROR 12
B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
23 22 21 20 17 16 15 14
FUNCTION TABLE
Number of
Inputs That are High Inputs Input/Output Outputs
OE T/R Even/Odd Parity Error Outputs Mode
L H H H Z Transmit
L H L L Z Transmit
L L H H H Receive
0, 2, 4, 6, 8 L L H L L Receive
L L L H L Receive
L L L L H Receive
Number of
Inputs That are High Inputs Input/Output Outputs
OE T/R Even/Odd Parity Error Outputs Mode
L H H L Z Transmit
L H L H Z Transmit
L L H H L Receive
1, 3, 5, 7 L L H L H Receive
L L L H H Receive
L L L L L Receive
Don’t Care H X X Z Z Z
H = HIGH Voltage Level; L = LOW Voltage Level; X = Don’t Care; Z = HIGH impedance state.
F657A
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 7.0 2.0 7.5
ns
tPHL An to Bn or Bn to An 2.0 7.0 2.0 7.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 6.0 13 5.5 14
ns
tPHL An to PARITY 6.5 13 6.5 14
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 10.5 4.5 11
ns
tPHL EVEN/ODD to PARITY, ERROR 4.5 10.5 4.5 11.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 7.0 18 6.5 19
ns
tPHL Bn to ERROR 7.0 18 6.5 19
tPLH Propagation Delay 8.0 14 7.0 15
ns
tPHL PARITY to ERROR 7.0 14 7.0 15
tPZH Output Enable Time 3.0 8.0 3.0 9.0
ns
tPZL to HIGH or LOW Level 4.0 9.0 4.0 10
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 7.5 2.0 8.0
ns
tPLZ from HIGH or LOW Level 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
F657B
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ± 10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
ns
tPHL An to Bn or Bn to An 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 11.5 4.5 13
ns
tPHL An to PARITY 4.5 11.5 4.5 13
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 7.5 2.0 8.5
ns
tPHL EVEN/ODD to PARITY, ERROR 2.0 7.5 2.0 8.5
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.0 15 3.5 16
ns
tPHL Bn to ERROR 4.0 15 3.5 16
tPLH Propagation Delay 5.0 11 4.0 12
ns
tPHL PARITY to ERROR 5.0 11 4.0 12
tPZH Output Enable Time 2.0 7.0 2.0 8.0
ns
tPZL to HIGH or LOW Level 2.0 7.0 2.0 8.0
tPHZ Output Disable Time 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
ns
tPLZ from HIGH or LOW Level 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.5
LOGIC DIAGRAM
T/R
OE
A0 B0
A1 B1
A2 B2
A3 B3
A4 B4
A5 B5
A6 B6
A7 B7
EVEN/ODD PARITY
ERROR
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 GND I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7 ORDERING INFORMATION
MC74FXXXJ Ceramic
LOGIC SYMBOL MC74FXXXN Plastic
11 10 MC74FXXXD SOIC
S0 S1
14 CET
15 CP TC 12
9 OE
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
GUARANTEED OPERATING RANGES
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit
VCC Supply Voltage 74 4.5 5.0 5.5 V
TA Operating Ambient Temperature Range 74 0 25 70 °C
I/O0–I/O7 –3.0
IOH Output Current — High 74 mA
TC –1.0
I/O0–I/O7 24
IOL Output Current — Low 74 mA
TC 20
FUNCTION TABLE
S1 S0 CET OE CP Operating Mode
X X X H X I/Oa to I/Oh in Hi-Z
X X X L X Flip-flop outputs appear on I/O lines
L L X H ↑ Parallel load all flip-flops
(not LL) H X ↑ Hold (TC held High)
H L L X ↑ Count up
L H L X ↑ Count Down
H = High voltage level
L = Low voltage level
X = Don’t care
↑ = Low-to-High clock transition
(not LL) = S1 and S2 should never be Low voltage level at the same time in the hold mode only.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage –0.73 –1.2 V VCC = 4.5 V, IIN = –18 mA
I/On 1.0 mA VIN = 5.5 V
VCC = 5
5.5
5V
others 100 µA VIN = 7.0 V
IIH Input HIGH Current
I/On 70
µA VCC = 5
5.5
5VV, VIN = 2
2.7
7V
others 20
Except
IIL Input LOW Current –0.6 mA VCC = 5.5 V, VIN = 0.5 V
I/On
OFF-State Current
IOZH 70 VOUT = 2.7 V
High-Level Voltage Applied
I/On µA VCC = 5 5V
5.5
OFF-State Current
IOZL –600 VOUT = 0.5 V
Low-Level Voltage Applied
IOS Output Short Circuit Current (Note 3) –60 –80 –150 mA VCC = MAX, VOUT = 0 V
ICCH 82 116
ICC Total Supply Current (total) ICCL 91 128 mA VCC = MAX
ICCZ 97 136
NOTES:
1. For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under guaranteed operating conditions for the applicable device type.
2. All typical values are at VCC = 5.0 V, TA = 25°C.
3. Not more than one output should be shorted at a time.
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Max Unit
fMAX Maximum Clock Frequency 125 80 MHz
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 10.5 4.5 11 ns
tPHL CP to I/On 5.5 10.5 5.5 11
tPLH Propagation Delay 4.5 9.0 4.5 10 ns
tPHL CP to TC 4.5 9.0 4.5 10
tPLH Propagation Delay 3.0 6.5 2.5 7.5 ns
tPHL CET to TC 3.0 7.5 2.5 8.0
tPZH Enable Time from 2.5 7.0 2.5 8.0 ns
tPZL High or Low Level 4.5 9.0 4.5 9.5
tPHZ Disable Time from 1.0 6.5 1.0 8.0 ns
tPLZ High or Low Level 1.0 7.0 1.0 8.0
AC SETUP REQUIREMENTS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit
ts(H) Set-up time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
ns
ts(L) I/On to CP 5.0 5.0
th(H) Hold time, HIGH or LOW 1.0 2.0
ns
th(L) I/On to CP 1.0 2.0
ts(H) Set-up time, HIGH or LOW 5.0 5.0
ns
ts(L) CET to CP 5.5 6.0
th(H) Hold time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
ns
th(L) CET to CP 0 0
ts(H) Set-up time, HIGH or LOW 8.0 8.5
ns
ts(L) Sn to CP 8.0 8.5
th(H) Hold time, HIGH or LOW 0 0
ns
th(L) Sn to CP 0 0
tw(H) 4.0 4.0
Clock Pulse Width ns
tw(L) 4.0 4.0
LOGIC DIAGRAM
S0 LOAD CONTROL
S1
UP CP
DOWN
OE
DETAIL A
I/O0
DETAIL A
I/O1
DETAIL A
I/O2
DETAIL A
I/O3
DETAIL A
I/O4
DETAIL A
I/O5
DETAIL A
I/O6
DETAIL A
I/O7
CET
TC
TOGGLE CP
DATA
MR
LOAD D Q
CP Q
Q
Q
Detail A
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND NC O0 D0 D1 O1 GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-03
GUARANTEED OPERATION RANGES
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit
VCC Supply Voltage 4.5 5.0 5.5 V
LOGIC SYMBOL
TA Operating Ambient 0 25 70 °C
Temperature Range
4 5 10 11
IOH Output Current — High — — –20 mA
IOL Output Current — Low — — 24 mA D0 D1 D2 D3
8 CP
LOGIC DIAGRAM
O0 O1 O2 O3
D0 D1 D2 D3
CP 3 6 9 12
CP D CP D CP D CP D VCC = PIN 14
Q Q Q Q GND = PINS 1 AND 7
NC = PINS 2 AND 13
O0 O1 O2 O3
11/93
APPLICATION NOTE
The closely matched outputs of the MC74F803 provide an ideal interface for the clock input of Motorola’s high-frequency
microprocessors.
MC68020/MC68030
E1
CLK
VCC
33CLK1 MC68881/MC68882
14 C2
CLK
MC74F803
4 3 VCC
D0 O0
5 6 RU
D1 O1
10 9
D2 O2
74F04 33CLK2 (40 mA OUTPUT DRIVE)
1 2 11 12
D3 O3 RT
1 CP 7
8
33CLK
CLK
66 MHz
J SUFFIX
-A-
CERAMIC PACKAGE
NOTES:
CASE 632-08 1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
Y14.5M, 1982.
14 8 2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
3. DIMENSION L TO CENTER OF LEAD WHEN
-B- FORMED PARALLEL.
4. DIM F MAY NARROW TO 0.76 (0.030) WHERE
1 7
THE LEAD ENTERS THE CERAMIC BODY.
5. 632-01 THRU -07 OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD
C L 632-08.
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 19.05 19.94 0.750 0.785
B 6.23 7.11 0.245 0.280
C 3.94 5.08 0.155 0.200
-T-
SEATING K D 0.39 0.50 0.015 0.020
PLANE F 1.40 1.65 0.055 0.065
G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
F G N M J 0.21 0.38 0.008 0.015
K 3.18 4.31 0.125 0.170
D 14 PL J 14 PL L 7.62 BSC 0.300 BSC
° ° ° °
M 0 15 0 15
0.25 (0.010) M T A S 0.25 (0.010) M T B S
N 0.51 1.01 0.020 0.040
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC PACKAGE
CASE 646-06 NOTES:
1. LEADS WITHIN 0.13 mm (0.005) RADIUS OF TRUE
POSITION AT SEATING PLANE AT MAXIMUM
14 8 MATERIAL CONDITION.
2. DIMENSION “L” TO CENTER OF LEADS WHEN
B FORMED PARALLEL.
3. DIMENSION “B” DOES NOT INCLUDE MOLD
1 7 FLASH.
4. ROUNDED CORNERS OPTIONAL.
5. 646-05 OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD 646-06.
D SUFFIX
NOTES:
SOIC PACKAGE 1. DIMENSIONS “A” AND “B” ARE DATUMS AND
“T” IS A DATUM SURFACE.
CASE 751A-02 2. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
-A- Y14.5M, 1982.
3. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
4. DIMENSION A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
14 8 PROTRUSION.
5. MAXIMUM MOLD PROTRUSION 0.15 (0.006)
PER SIDE.
-B- P 0.25 (0.010) M B M 6. 751A-01 IS OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD
7 PL 751A-02.
1
7
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
R X 45° A 8.55 8.75 0.337 0.344
C B 3.80 4.00 0.150 0.157
G
C 1.35 1.75 0.054 0.068
D 0.35 0.49 0.014 0.019
F 0.40 1.25 0.016 0.049
SEATING
PLANE G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
K M J J 0.19 0.25 0.008 0.009
D 14 PL F K 0.10 0.25 0.004 0.009
° ° ° °
0.25 (0.010) M T B S A S M 0 7 0 7
P 5.80 6.20 0.229 0.244
R 0.25 0.50 0.010 0.019
*MC74F803/D*
MOTOROLA ◊ CODELINE TO BE PLACED HERE MC74F803/D
TIMING SOLUTIONS
301 BR1333 — REV 4
MC74F803
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding
the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit,
and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters can and do vary in different
applications. All operating parameters, including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Motorola does
not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in
systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of
the Motorola product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such
unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless
against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death
associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Motorola and are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
VCC O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9 OE2
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
N SUFFIX
24
PLASTIC
1
CASE 724-03
F827
DW SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 SOIC
24 CASE 751E-03
OE1 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 GND
1
LOGIC SYMBOL
F827
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
OE1 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 GND
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
1 OE1
LOGIC DIAGRAM 13 OE2
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9
D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14
F828
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
OE1
OE2 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
O9 O8 O7 O6 O5 O4 O3 O2 O1 O0 1 OE1
13 OE2
Please note that this diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and should O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9
not be used to estimate propagation delays.
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14
Operating
g Ambient 54 –55 25 125
TA °C
Temperature Range 74 0 25 70
54 — — –12
IOH Output Current — High mA
74 — — –15
54 — — 48
IOL Output Current — Low mA
74 — — 64
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Outputs
On
OE Dn F827 F828 Function
L H H L Transparent
L L L H Transparent
H X Z Z High Z
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
Z = High Impedance
AC CHARACTERISTICS
54/74F 54F 74F
TA = +25
+25°C
C TA = – 55
55°C
C to +125
+125°C
C TA = 0
0°C
C to 70
70°C
C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
F
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pFF CL = 50 pFF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y, 2.0 8.5 2.0 10 2.0 9.0
ns
tPHL Data to Output 2.0 8.5 2.0 10 2.0 9.0
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y, 2.0 9.0 2.0 11 2.0 10
ns
tPHL Data to Output 1.0 8.0 1.0 10 1.0 9.0
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
T/R A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 GND
1 T/R
B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Inputs/Outputs
OE T/R An Bn
L L A=B Inputs
L H Inputs B=A
H X Z Z
H = HIGH voltage level: L = LOW voltage level: X = Don’t care: Z = HIGH impedance “off” state.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
19
OE
1
T/R
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
74F 74F
TA = +25°C TA = 0°C to +70°C
VCC = +5.0 V VCC = +5.0 V ±10%
CL = 50 pF CL = 50 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
tPLH Propagation Delay 2.0 6.5 1.5 7.0 ns
tPHL Transparent Mode An to Bn or Bn to An 2.5 7.5 2.0 8.0
tPZH 3.0 8.0 2.5 9.0 ns
Output Enable Time
tPZL 4.0 10.0 3.5 11.0
tPHZ 2.0 8.0 1.5 9.0 ns
Output Disable Time
tPLZ 1.0 10.0 1.0 11.0
Advance Information
Clock Driver MC74F1803
Quad DĆType FlipĆFlop
With Matched Propagation Delays
The MC74F1803 is a high-speed, low-power, quad D-type flip-flop featur- CLOCK DRIVER QUAD
ing separate D-type inputs and inverting outputs with closely matched prop- D-TYPE FLIP-FLOP WITH
agation delays. With a buffered clock (CP) input that is common to all flip-
flops, the MC74F1803 is useful in high-frequency systems as a clock driver, MATCHED PROPAGATION
providing multiple outputs that are synchronous. Because of the matched DELAYS
propagation delays, the duty cycles of the output waveforms in a clock driver
application are symmetrical within 2.0 nanoseconds.
VCC NC O3 D3 D2 O2 CP
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
LOGIC SYMBOL
GND NC O0 D0 D1 O1 GND
4 5 10 11
D0 D1 D2 D3
LOGIC DIAGRAM
8 CP
D0 D1 D2 D3
O0 O1 O2 O3
CP D CP D CP D CP D
3 6 9 12
Q Q Q Q
CP VCC = PIN 14
GND = PINS 1 AND 7
NC = PINS 2 AND 13
O0 O1 O2 O3
VCC = Pin 14; GND = Pins 1,7; NC = Pins 2, 13
NOTE: This diagram is provided only for the understanding of logic operations and
should not be used to estimate propagation delays
This document contains information on a new product. Specifications and information herein are subject to
change without notice.
11/93
VCC
33 MHz Clock
14
4 3
D0 O0
5 6
D1 O1
MC74F1803
10 9 33 MHz Clock
D2 O2
74F04 (40 mA Output Drive)
11 12
D3 O3
1 2
1 7
33 MHz Clock
CP
8
CLK
66 MHz
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC PACKAGE
CASE 646-06 NOTES:
1. LEADS WITHIN 0.13 mm (0.005) RADIUS OF TRUE
POSITION AT SEATING PLANE AT MAXIMUM
14 8 MATERIAL CONDITION.
2. DIMENSION “L” TO CENTER OF LEADS WHEN
B FORMED PARALLEL.
3. DIMENSION “B” DOES NOT INCLUDE MOLD
1 7 FLASH.
4. ROUNDED CORNERS OPTIONAL.
5. 646-05 OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD 646-06.
D SUFFIX
NOTES:
SOIC PACKAGE 1. DIMENSIONS “A” AND “B” ARE DATUMS AND
“T” IS A DATUM SURFACE.
CASE 751A-02 2. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
-A- Y14.5M, 1982.
3. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
4. DIMENSION A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
14 8 PROTRUSION.
5. MAXIMUM MOLD PROTRUSION 0.15 (0.006)
PER SIDE.
-B- P 0.25 (0.010) M B M 6. 751A-01 IS OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD
7 PL 751A-02.
1
7
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
R X 45° A 8.55 8.75 0.337 0.344
C B 3.80 4.00 0.150 0.157
G C 0.054 0.068
1.35 1.75
D 0.35 0.49 0.014 0.019
F 0.40 1.25 0.016 0.049
SEATING
PLANE G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
K M J J 0.19 0.25 0.008 0.009
D 14 PL F K 0.10 0.25 0.004 0.009
° ° ° °
0.25 (0.010) M T B S A S M 0 7 0 7
P 5.80 6.20 0.229 0.244
R 0.25 0.50 0.010 0.019
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding
the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit,
and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters can and do vary in different
applications. All operating parameters, including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Motorola does
not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in
systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of
the Motorola product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such
unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless
against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death
associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Motorola and are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
*MC74F1803/D*
MOTOROLA ◊ CODELINE TO BE PLACED HERE MC74F1803/D
TIMING SOLUTIONS
313 BR1333 — REV 4
MC74F1803
Literature Distribution Centers:
USA: Motorola Literature Distribution; P.O. Box 20912; Phoenix, Arizona 85036.
EUROPE: Motorola Ltd.; European Literature Centre; 88 Tanners Drive, Blakelands, Milton Keynes, MK14 5BP, England.
JAPAN: Nippon Motorola Ltd.; 4-32-1, Nishi-Gotanda, Shinagawa-ku, Tokyo 141 Japan.
ASIA-PACIFIC: Motorola Semiconductors H.K. Ltd.; Silicon Harbour Center, No. 2 Dai King Street, Tai Po Industrial Estate,
ASIA-PACIFIC: Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong.
18 17 16 15 14
BUS BUS
19 13
GND GND
BG
20 12 RE
GND
VCC 1 11 DE
D0 2 10 R3
R0 3 9 D3
4 5 6 7 8
D1 R1 LOGIC D2 R2
GND
LOGIC DIAGRAM
2
D0 18
I/O0
3
R0
4
D1 17
I/O1
5
R1
12
RE
7
D2 15
I/O2
8
R2
9
D3 14
I/O3
10
R3
11
DE
FUNCTION TABLE
Inputs Input/Output Outputs
DE RE Dn I/On Rn Operating Mode
H L L H L Transmit to Bus
H L H L H
H H L Dn Z Receiver 3-State,
L H H H Z Transmit to Bus
L L X H L Receive, I/On = Inputs
L L X L H
H = HIGH voltage level:
L = LOW voltage level:
X = Don’t care:
Z = HIGH impedance “Off” state.
DC CHARACTERISTICS (Over Recommended Operating Free-Air Temperature Range Unless otherwise specified)
Limits
Test Conditions
Symbol Parameter Min Typ (2) Max Unit (Note 1)
VCC = MIN: VIL = 1.3 V; RE = 0.8 V:
VOH High-Level Output Voltage Rn 2.5 — — V
IOH = MAX
VCC = MAX: DN = DE = 0.8 V:
VOHB High-Level Output Bus Voltage I/On 1.9 — — V VT = 2.0 V: RT = 10Ω: RE = 2.0 V
IOH = MAX
VCC = MIN: VIN = 1.8 V; RE = 0.8 V: IOL =
VOL Output LOW Voltage Rn — 0.35 0.5 V
6.0 mA
0.75 1.0 1.2 Dn = DE = VIH: IOL = 100 mA
VOLB Low Level Output Bus Voltage I/On V
0.75 1.0 1.1 Dn = DE = VIH: IOL = 80 mA
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage — –0.73 –1.2 V VCC = MIN, II = IIK
II Input Current at Maximum Input Voltage — — 100 µA VCC = MAX: VI = 7.0 V: DE = RE = Dn = VCC
IIH High Level Input Current Dn, RE, DE — — 20 µA VCC = MAX: DE = RE = Dn = 2.5 V
High-Level I/O Bus Current VCC = 0 V: DN = DE = 0.8 V:
IIHB I/On — — 100 µA
(Power Off) I/On = 1.2 V: RE = 0 V:
RE — — –100
VCC = MAX: DE = 4
4.5
5V
IIL Low-Level Input Current Dn — — –200 µA
DE — — –500 VI = 0.5V: Dn = 4.5 V
Low-Level I/O Bus Current VCC = MAX: Dn = DE = 0.8 V:
IILB I/On –250 — 100 µA
(Power On) I/On = 0.75 V : RE = 0 V:
Off-State Output Current, High- VO = 2.5V:
IOZH — — 20
Level Voltage Applied µA RE = 2.0 V
LS Data Sheets 5
LS Data Sheets 5
SN54/74LS00
QUAD 2-INPUT NAND GATE
• ESD > 3500 Volts
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
VCC
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
* *
* *
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
* *
J SUFFIX
* * CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
HEX INVERTER
VCC
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
HEX INVERTER
VCC
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
* * *
* * * J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
* *
* * J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
* *
*
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
SN54 / 74LS13
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 D SUFFIX
SOIC
GND 14
1 CASE 751A-02
SN54 / 74LS14
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
3V
VIN 1.6 V
0.8 V
0V
tPHL tPLH
Figure 1. AC Waveforms
5
VCC = 5 V
TA = 25°C
0
0 0.4 0.95 1.2 1.8 2
VIN, INPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
2
TA = 25°C
V T , THRESHOLD VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
VT+
∆ V T, HYSTERESIS (VOLTS)
1.6
1.2
VT–
0.8
∆ VT
0.4
0
4.5 4.75 5 5.25 5.5
VCC, POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
1.9
V T , THRESHOLD VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
1.7 VT+
∆ V T, HYSTERESIS (VOLTS)
1.5
1.3
1.1
0.9 VT–
∆ VT
0.7
– 55° 0° 25° 75° 125°
TA, AMBIENT TEMPERATURE (°C)
* *
*
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
*
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
* *
J SUFFIX
* * CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54, 74 1000 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
IOH Output HIGH Current
54, 74 50 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = 12 V
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
* *
* * J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 250 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
* *
* * J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
GND 1
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 250 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
GND 14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. ORDERING INFORMATION
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
Temperature Ranges.
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A0 A1 A2 A3 LOGIC SYMBOL
15 14 13 12
15 14 13 12
A0 A1 A2 A3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 10 11
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS42 decoder accepts four active HIGH BCD inputs to the inputs.
and provides ten mutually exclusive active LOW outputs, as The most significant input A3 produces a useful inhibit func-
shown by logic symbol or diagram. The active LOW outputs tion when the LS42 is used as a one-of-eight decoder. The A3
facilitate addressing other MSI units with LOW input enables. input can also be used as the Data input in an 8-output
The logic design of the LS42 ensures that all outputs demultiplexer application.
are HIGH when binary codes greater than nine are applied
TRUTH TABLE
A0 A1 A2 A3 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
L L L L L H H H H H H H H H
H L L L H L H H H H H H H H
L H L L H H L H H H H H H H
H H L L H H H L H H H H H H
L L H L H H H H L H H H H H
H L H L H H H H H L H H H H
L H H L H H H H H H L H H H
H H H L H H H H H H H L H H
L L L H H H H H H H H H L H
H L L H H H H H H H H H H L
L H L H H H H H H H H H H H
H H L H H H H H H H H H H H
L L H H H H H H H H H H H H
H L H H H H H H H H H H H H
L H H H H H H H H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H H H H H H H
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
LOGIC SYMBOL
7 1 2 6 3 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A B C D LT RBI
B C LT BI / RBO RBI D A GND
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW BI/
a b c d e f g RBO
A, B, C, D BCD Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
RBI Ripple-Blanking Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
LT Lamp-Test Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 13 12 11 10 9 15 14 4
BI / RBO Blanking Input or 0.5 U.L. 0.75 U.L.
Ripple-Blanking Output 1.2 U.L. 2.0 U.L. VCC = PIN 16
a, to g Outputs Open-Collector 15 (7.5) U.L. GND = PIN 8
NOTES:
a) 1 Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH, 1.6 mA LOW.
b) Output current measured at VOUT = 0.5 V
The Output LOW drive factor is 7.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 15 U.L. for Commercial (74) Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
a a
b b
B
INPUT
C c c
D
OUTPUT
d d
BLANKING INPUT OR
RIPPLE-BLANKING
OUTPUT e e
f f
LAMP-TEST
INPUT
RIPPLE-BLANKING
INPUT g g
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
DECIMAL
OR LT RBI D C B A BI/RBO a b c d e f g NOTE
FUNCTION
0 H H L L L L H L L L L L L H A
1 H X L L L H H H L L H H H H A
2 H X L L H L H L L H L L H L
3 H X L L H H H L L L L H H L
4 H X L H L L H H L L H H L L
5 H X L H L H H L H L L H L L
6 H X L H H L H H H L L L L L
7 H X L H H H H L L L H H H H
8 H X H L L L H L L L L L L L
9 H X H L L H H L L L H H L L
10 H X H L H L H H H H L L H L
11 H X H L H H H H H L L H H L
12 H X H H L L H H L H H H L L
13 H X H H L H H L H H L H L L
14 H X H H H L H H H H L L L L
15 H X H H H H H H H H H H H H
BI X X X X X X L H H H H H H H B
RBI H L L L L L L H H H H H H H C
LT L X X X X X H L L L L L L L D
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
NOTES:
(A) BI/RBO is wire-AND logic serving as blanking Input (BI) and/or ripple-blanking output (RBO). The blanking out (BI) must be open or held
at a HIGH level when output functions 0 through 15 are desired, and ripple-blanking input (RBI) must be open or at a HIGH level if blanking
of a decimal 0 is not desired. X = input may be HIGH or LOW.
(B) When a LOW level is applied to the blanking input (forced condition) all segment outputs go to a LOW level regardless of the state of
any other input condition.
(C) When ripple-blanking input (RBI) and inputs A, B, C, and D are at LOW level, with the lamp test input at HIGH level, all segment outputs
go to a HIGH level and the ripple-blanking output (RBO) goes to a LOW level (response condition).
(D) When the blanking input/ripple-blanking output (BI/RBO) is open or held at a HIGH level, and a LOW level is applied to lamp test input,
all segment outputs go to a LOW level.
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 ORDERING INFORMATION
B C LT BI / RBO RBI D A GND SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
LOGIC DIAGRAM SN74LSXXD SOIC
A LOGIC SYMBOL
b 7 1 2 6 3 5
B
INPUT
A B C D LT RBI
C c
D SN54 / 74LS48
OUTPUT BI/
d a b c d e f g RBO
BLANKING INPUT OR
RIPPLE-BLANKING
OUTPUT e 13 12 11 10 9 15 14 4
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
f
RIPPLE-BLANKING
INPUT
LAMP-TEST
INPUT g
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
TRUTH TABLE
SN54 / 74LS48
INPUTS OUTPUTS
DECIMAL
OR LT RBI D C B A BI / RBO a b c d e f g NOTE
FUNCTION
0 H H L L L L H H H H H H H L 1
1 H X L L L H H L H H L L L L 1
2 H X L L H L H H H L H H L H NOTES:
3 H X L L H H H H H H H L L H (1) BI/RBO is wired-AND logic serving as blanking input (BI) and/or
4 H X L H L L H L H H L L H H ripple-blanking output (RBO). The blanking out (BI) must be open
or held at a HIGH level when output functions 0 through 15 are
5 H X L H L H H H L H H L H H
desired, and ripple-blanking input (RBI) must be open or at a HIGH
6 H X L H H L H L L H H H H H
level if blanking of a decimal 0 is not desired. X=input may be HIGH
7 H X L H H H H H H H L L L L or LOW.
8 H X H L L L H H H H H H H H (2) When a LOW level is applied to the blanking input (forced condition)
9 H X H L L H H H H H L L H H
all segment outputs go to a LOW level, regardless of the state of any
other input condition.
10 H X H L H L H L L L H H L H
(3) When ripple-blanking input (RBI) and inputs A, B, C, and D are at
11 H X H L H H H L L H H L L H LOW level, with the lamp test input at HIGH level, all segment
12 H X H H L L H L H L L L H H outputs go to a HIGH level and the ripple-blanking output (RBO)
13 H X H H L H H H L L H L H H goes to a LOW level (response condition).
(4) When the blanking input/ripple-blanking output (BI/RBO) is open or
14 H X H H H L H L L L H H H H
held at a HIGH level, and a LOW level is applied to lamp-test input,
15 H X H H H H H L L L L L L L all segment outputs go to a LOW level.
BI X X X X X X L L L L L L L L 2
RBI H L L L L L L L L L L L L L 3
LT L X X X X X H H H H H H H H 4
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
3-2-2-3-INPUT
AND-OR-INVERT GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
2-WIDE 4-INPUT
AND-OR-INVERT GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
N SUFFIX
CLEAR PLASTIC
2 (6)
K 14 CASE 646-06
J
3 (10) 14 (7) 1
1 (15)
CLOCK (CP)
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
OPERATING MODE
CD J K Q Q
LOGIC SYMBOL
Reset (Clear) L X X L H
Toggle H h h q q
Load “0” (Reset) H l h L H
Load “1” (Set) H h l H L 14 J Q 12 7 J Q 9
Hold H l l q q
1 CP 5 CP
H, h = HIGH Voltage Level
L, I = LOW Voltage Level
3 K C Q 13 10 K C Q 8
X = Don’t Care D D
l, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) one set-up time
l, h (q) = prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition. 2 6
VCC = PIN 4
GND = PIN 11
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J, K 20
Clear 60 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
Clock 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
J, K 0.1
Clear 0.3 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
Clock 0.4
J, K – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
Clear, Clock – 0.8
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 –100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 6.0 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC WAVEFORMS
J or K * 1.3 V
th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
ts(L) ts(H)
tW(L)
CP
1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW(H)
1
tPHL fMAX tPLH
Q
1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
1.3 V 1.3 V
Q
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
tW
SET
1.3 V 1.3 V
tW
CLEAR
1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
1.3 V 1.3 V
Q
tPHL tPLH
Q
1.3 V 1.3 V
J SUFFIX
LOGIC DIAGRAM (Each Flip-Flop) CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
SET (SD)
4 (10)
Q
5 (9)
CLEAR (CD)
1 (13) N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CLOCK 14 CASE 646-06
3 (11)
Q 1
6 (8)
D
2 (12)
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
INPUTS OUTPUTS
OPERATING MODE
SD SD D Q Q
Set L H X H L
LOGIC SYMBOL
Reset (Clear) H L X L H
*Undetermined L L X H H 4 10
Load “1” (Set) H H h H L
Load “0” (Reset) H H l L H
2 D SD Q 5 12 D SD Q 9
* Both outputs will be HIGH while both SD and CD are LOW, but the output states are unpredictable
if SD and CD go HIGH simultaneously. If the levels at the set and clear are near VIL maximum then 3 11
CP CP
we cannot guarantee to meet the minimum level for VOH.
H, h = HIGH Voltage Level 6 8
L, I = LOW Voltage Level
CD Q CD Q
X = Don’t Care
i, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) one set-up time 1 13
i, h (q) = prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition.
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
D* 1.3 V 1.3 V
th(H)
th(L)
ts(L) tW(H) ts(H)
tW(L)
1.3 V 1.3 V
CP
1
fMAX
tPHL tPLH
Q
1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL
tPLH
1.3 V 1.3 V
Q
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
tW
SET
1.3 V 1.3 V
tW
CLEAR
1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
1.3 V 1.3 V
Q
tPHL tPLH
Q
1.3 V 1.3 V
SN54 / 74LS75
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Q0 D0 D1 E2–3 VCC D2 D3 Q3 1
Q0 Q1 E0–1 GND NC Q2 Q3
D SUFFIX
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
SN54 / 74LS77
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 632-08
14
D0 D1 E2–3 VCC D2 D3 NC 1
TRUTH TABLE
(Each latch)
ORDERING INFORMATION
tn tn + 1 NOTES:
tn = bit time before enable SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
D Q negative-going transition SN74LSXXN Plastic
H H tn+1 = bit time after enable SN74LSXXD SOIC
negative-going transition
L L
LOGIC SYMBOLS
SN54/74LS75 SN54/74LS77
2 3 6 7 1 2 5 6
D0 D1 D2 D3 D0 D1 D2 D3
13 E0–1 12 E0–1 VCC = PIN 4
VCC = PIN 5
E2–3 E2–3 GND = PIN 11
4 GND = PIN 12 3
NC = PIN 7, 10
Q0 Q0 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q2 Q3 Q3 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
16 1 15 14 10 11 9 8 14 13 9 8
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
D Input – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
E Input –1.6
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 –100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 12 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
tPLH 12 20
Propagation Delay, Data to Q ns
tPHL 7.0 15 VCC = 5.0 V
tPLH 15 27 CL = 15 pF
Propagation Delay, Enable to Q ns
tPHL 14 25
tPLH 16 30
Propagation Delay, Enable to Q ns
tPHL 7.0 15
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
D Input – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
E Input –1.6
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 –100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 13 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
DATA
Q (SN54/74LS75 ONLY)
Q
ENABLE
TO OTHER LATCH
AC WAVEFORMS
D 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts th
tPHL tPLH
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to the
clock transition from HIGH-to-LOW in order to be recognized and transferred to the outputs.
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following the clock transition from HIGH-to-LOW that the logic level must be
maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic level may
be released prior to the clock transition from HIGH-to-LOW and still be recognized.
J SUFFIX
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
INPUTS OUTPUTS 16
OPERATING MODE 1
SD CD J K Q Q
Set L H X X H L
Reset (Clear) H L X X L H
*Undetermined L L X X H H
N SUFFIX
Toggle H H h h q q
PLASTIC
Load “0” (Reset) H H l h L H
16 CASE 648-08
Load “1” (Set) H H h l H L
Hold H H l l q q 1
*Both outputs will be HIGH while both SD and CD are LOW, but the output states are unpredictable
if SD and CD go HIGH simultaneously.
H,h = HIGH Voltage Level D SUFFIX
L,l = LOW Voltage Level
SOIC
X = Immaterial 16
1 CASE 751B-03
l, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) one setup time prior
to the HIGH-to-LOW clock transition
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM
LOGIC SYMBOL
Q 2 7
Q
SD 15 SD 11
16 K Q 12 K Q
1 CP 6 CP
CLEAR (CD) SET (SD)
K 4 J C Q 14 9 J C Q 10
J D D
3 8
CLOCK (CP) VCC = PIN 5
GND = PIN 13
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J, K 20
Clear 60 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
Clock 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
J, K 0.1
Clear 0.3 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
Clock 0.4
J, K – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
Clear, Clock – 0.8
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 –100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 6.0 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 N SUFFIX
A4 Σ3 A3 B3 VCC Σ2 B2 A2 PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
1
HIGH LOW
A1 – A4 Operand A Inputs 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
B1 – B4 Operand B Inputs 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
C0 Carry Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. D SUFFIX
Σ1 – Σ4 Sum Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. SOIC
16
C4 Carry Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. 1 CASE 751B-03
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74) ORDERING INFORMATION
Temperature Ranges.
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
LOGIC DIAGRAM SN74LSXXD SOIC
C0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4 VCC = PIN 5
13 10 11 8 7 3 4 1 16 GND = PIN 12
= PIN NUMBERS
LOGIC SYMBOL
10 11 8 7 3 4 1 16
B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4
13 C0 C4 14
∑1∑2 ∑3 ∑4 C4
9 6 2 15 14
C1 C2 C3
9 6 2 15 14
∑1 ∑2 ∑3 ∑4 C4
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS83A adds two 4-bit binary words (A plus B) plus the incoming carry. The binary sum appears on the sum outputs (∑1 – ∑4)
and outgoing carry (C4) outputs.
C0 + (A1+B1)+2(A2+B2)+4(A3+B3)+8(A4+B4) = ∑1+2∑2+4∑3+8∑4+16C4
Where: (+) = plus
Due to the symmetry of the binary add function the LS83A can be used with either all inputs and outputs active HIGH (positive
logic) or with all inputs and outputs active LOW (negative logic). Note that with active HIGH Inputs, Carry Input can not be left open,
but must be held LOW when no carry in is intended.
Example:
C0 A1 A2 A3 A4 B1 B2 B3 B4 ∑1 ∑2 ∑3 ∑4 C4
Logic Levels L L H L H H L L H H H L L H
Active HIGH 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 (10+9 = 19)
Active LOW 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 (carry+5+6 = 12)
Interchanging inputs of equal weight does not affect the operation, thus C0, A1, B1, can be arbitrarily assigned to pins 10, 11,
13, etc.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
NOTE:
The Flatpak version has the ORDERING INFORMATION
same pinouts (Connection
Diagram) as the Dual In-Line SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
Package. SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B3 IA<B IA=B IA>B OA>B OA=B OA<B GND
LOGIC SYMBOL
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A3 (15)
B3
(1)
(5)
OA>B
(13)
A2
B2
(14)
(2)
A<B (6)
(3) OA=B
A=B (4)
A>B
(12)
A1
B1
(11)
(7)
OA<B
(10)
A0
B0
(9)
TRUTH TABLE
CASCADING
COMPARING INPUTS OUTPUTS
INPUTS
A3,B3 A2,B2 A1,B1 A0,B0 IA>B IA<B IA=B OA>B OA<B OA=B
A3>B3 X X X X X X H L L
A3<B3 X X X X X X L H L
A3=B3 A2>B2 X X X X X H L L
A3=B3 A2<B2 X X X X X L H L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1>B1 X X X X H L L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1<B1 X X X X L H L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0>B0 X X X H L L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0<B0 X X X L H L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0=B0 H L L H L L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0=B0 L H L L H L
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0=B0 X X H L L H
H = HIGH Level
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0=B0 H H L L L L
L = LOW Level
A3=B3 A2=B2 A1=B1 A0=B0 L L L H H L
X = IMMATERIAL
A n3
A n2
A n1
B n3
B n2
B n1
An
Bn
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3 A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3
L IA > B OA > B IA > B OA > B A>B
L IA < B SN54/74LS85 OA < B IA < B SN54/74LS85 OA < B A<B
H IA = B OA = B IA = B OA = B A=B
L = LOW LEVEL
H = HIGH LEVEL
APPLICATIONS
Figure 2 shows a high speed method of comparing two 24-bit words with only two levels of device delay. With the technique
shown in Figure 1, six levels of device delay result when comparing two 24-bit words. The parallel technique can be expanded
to any number of bits, see Table 1.
Table 1
WORD LENGTH NUMBER OF PKGS. NOTE:
1 – 4 Bits 1 The SN54/74LS85 can be used as a 5-bit comparator
only when the outputs are used to drive the A0–A3 and
5 – 24 Bits 2–6
B0–B3 inputs of another SN54/74LS85 as shown in
25 – 120 Bits 8 – 31 Figure 2 in positions #1, 2, 3, and 4.
INPUTS
(LSB) (MSB)
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3 A20 A21 A22 A23 B20 B21 B22 B23
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3 A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3
L IA > B OA > B A19 IA > B OA > B
L IA < B #5 OA < B B19 IA < B #1 OA < B
H IA = B OA = B L IA = B OA = B NC
INPUTS
A5 A6 A7 A8 B5 B6 B7 B8 A10 A11 A12 A13 B10 B11 B12 B13 A15 A16 A17 A18 B15 B16 B17 B18
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3 A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3 A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3
A4 IA > B OA > B A9 IA > B OA > B A14 IA > B OA > B
B4 IA < B #4 OA < B B9 IA < B #3 OA < B B14 IA < B #2 OA < B
L IA = B OA = B NC L IA = B OA = B NC L IA = B OA = B NC
A0 A1 A2 A3 B0 B1 B2 B3
IA > B OA > B
IA < B #6 OA < B OUTPUTS
IA = B OA = B
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH Any A or B to A = B 27 45 ns
tPHL 23 45
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 3 Figure 4
QUAD 2-INPUT
EXCLUSIVE OR GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
TRUTH TABLE
IN OUT
A B Z D SUFFIX
L L L SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
L H H
H L H
H H L
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
LOGIC SYMBOL
1 2
MS
14 CP0 14 CP0 14 CP0
1 CP1 1 CP1 1 CP1
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
1 2 1 2 1 2
2 3 12 9 8 11 6 7 12 11 9 8 2 3 12 9 8 11
VCC = PIN 5 VCC = PIN 5 VCC = PIN 5
GND = PIN 10 GND = PIN 10 GND = PIN 10
NC = PINS 4, 13 NC = PINS 2, 3, 4, 13 NC = PIN 4, 6, 7, 13
NC 2 13 NC
J Q J Q J Q J Q
14
CP0 NC 3 12 Q0
CP CP CP CP
KC Q KC Q KC Q KC Q NC 4 11 Q1
D D D D
VCC 5 10 GND
1
CP1 MR1 6 9 Q2
6
MR1 12 11 9 8 MR2 7 8 Q3
MR2
7 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
NC = NO INTERNAL CONNECTION
= PIN NUMBERS NOTE:
VCC = PIN 5 The Flatpak version has the same
GND = PIN 10 pinouts (Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS90, LS92, and LS93 are 4-bit ripple type Decade, C. Divide-By-Two and Divide-By-Five Counter — No external
Divide-By-Twelve, and Binary Counters respectively. Each interconnections are required. The first flip-flop is used as a
device consists of four master/slave flip-flops which are binary element for the divide-by-two function (CP0 as the
internally connected to provide a divide-by-two section and a input and Q0 as the output). The CP1 input is used to obtain
divide-by-five (LS90), divide-by-six (LS92), or divide-by-eight binary divide-by-five operation at the Q3 output.
(LS93) section. Each section has a separate clock input which
initiates state changes of the counter on the HIGH-to-LOW
LS92
clock transition. State changes of the Q outputs do not occur
simultaneously because of internal ripple delays. Therefore, A. Modulo 12, Divide-By-Twelve Counter — The CP1 input
decoded output signals are subject to decoding spikes and must be externally connected to the Q0 output. The CP0 in-
should not be used for clocks or strobes. The Q0 output of put receives the incoming count and Q3 produces a sym-
each device is designed and specified to drive the rated metrical divide-by-twelve square wave output.
fan-out plus the CP1 input of the device. B. Divide-By-Two and Divide-By-Six Counter —No external
A gated AND asynchronous Master Reset (MR1 • MR2) is interconnections are required. The first flip-flop is used as a
provided on all counters which overrides and clocks and binary element for the divide-by-two function. The CP1 in-
resets (clears) all the flip-flops. A gated AND asynchronous put is used to obtain divide-by-three operation at the Q1
Master Set (MS1 • MS2) is provided on the LS90 which and Q2 outputs and divide-by-six operation at the Q3 out-
overrides the clocks and the MR inputs and sets the outputs to put.
nine (HLLH).
Since the output from the divide-by-two section is not
internally connected to the succeeding stages, the devices LS93
may be operated in various counting modes. A. 4-Bit Ripple Counter — The output Q0 must be externally
connected to input CP1. The input count pulses are applied
LS90 to input CP0. Simultaneous divisions of 2, 4, 8, and 16 are
A. BCD Decade (8421) Counter — The CP1 input must be ex- performed at the Q0, Q1, Q2, and Q3 outputs as shown in
ternally connected to the Q0 output. The CP0 input receives the truth table.
the incoming count and a BCD count sequence is pro-
B. 3-Bit Ripple Counter— The input count pulses are applied
duced.
to input CP1. Simultaneous frequency divisions of 2, 4, and
B. Symmetrical Bi-quinary Divide-By-Ten Counter — The Q3 8 are available at the Q1, Q2, and Q3 outputs. Independent
output must be externally connected to the CP0 input. The use of the first flip-flop is available if the reset function coin-
input count is then applied to the CP1 input and a divide-by- cides with reset of the 3-bit ripple-through counter.
ten square wave is obtained at output Q0.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1
*The number of Clock Pulses required between the tPHL and tPLH measurements can be determined from the appropriate Truth Tables.
CP 1.3 V CP 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH
Q0 • Q3
Q 1.3 V (LS90) 1.3 V
Figure 2 Figure 3
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
6 2 3 4 5
S
1
DS
9
CP1
8
CP2 R R R R
S Q S Q S Q S Q
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7 13 12 11 10
= PIN NUMBERS Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS95B is a 4-Bit Shift Register with serial and parallel HIGH to LOW transition on enabled CP1 transfers the data
synchronous operating modes. It has a Serial (DS) and four from Serial input (DS) to Q0 and shifts the data in Q0 to Q1, Q1
Parallel (P0 – P3) Data inputs and four Parallel Data outputs to Q2, and Q2 to Q3 respectively (right-shift). A left-shift is ac-
(Q0 – Q3). The serial or parallel mode of operation is controlled complished by externally connecting Q3 to P2, Q2 to P1, and
by a Mode Control input (S) and two Clock Inputs (CP1) and Q1 to P0, and operating the LS95B in the parallel mode (S =
(CP2). The serial (right-shift) or parallel data transfers occur HIGH).
synchronous with the HIGH to LOW transition of the selected For normal operation, S should only change states when
clock input. both Clock inputs are LOW. However, changing S from LOW
When the Mode Control input (S) is HIGH, CP2 is enabled. A to HIGH while CP2 is HIGH, or changing S from HIGH to LOW
HIGH to LOW transition on enabled CP2 transfers parallel while CP1 is HIGH and CP2 is LOW will not cause any changes
data from the P0 – P3 inputs to the Q0 – Q3 outputs. on the register outputs.
When the Mode Control input (S) is LOW, CP1 is enabled. A
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DESCRIPTION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME(ts) —is defined as the minimum time required the clock transition from HIGH to LOW that the logic level must
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog-
the clock transition from HIGH to LOW in order to be recog- nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
nized and transferred to the outputs. level may be released prior to the clock transition from HIGH to
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following LOW and still be recognized.
AC WAVEFORMS
The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
th(L) th(H)
ts(L) ts(H)
*The Data Input is
CP1 or CP2 (DS for CP1) or (Pn for CP2).
1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW
l/fmax
tPHL tPLH
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1
tW ts(L) ts(H)
th(H)
tW
Figure 2
J1 Q1 Q1 K1 Q2 Q2 GND 1
D SUFFIX
LOGIC SYMBOL SOIC
1 2 14
1 CASE 751A-02
1 J Q 3 8 J Q 5
ORDERING INFORMATION
12 CP 9 CP
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
4 K Q 2 K Q SN74LSXXXD SOIC
11 6
CD CD
13 10
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J, K 20
Clear 60 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
Clock 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
J, K 0.1
Clear 0.3 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
Clock 0.4
J, K – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
Clear and Clock – 0.8
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 –100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 6.0 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
SET (SD)
5(11)
Q
CLEAR (CD) 6(10) J SUFFIX
1(15) CERAMIC
CLOCK CASE 620-09
4(12) 16
1
Q
7(9)
J
2(14)
K N SUFFIX
3(13) PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
OPERATING MODE ORDERING INFORMATION
SD CD J K Q Q
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
Set L H X X H L
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
Reset (Clear) H L X X L H
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
*Undetermined L L X X H H
Load “1” (Set) H H h h H L
Hold H H l h q q
Toggle H H h l q q
Load “0” (Reset) H H l l L H LOGIC SYMBOL
* Both outputs will be HIGH while both SD and CD are LOW, but the output states
are unpredictable if SD and CD go HIGH simultaneously. 5 11
H, h = HIGH Voltage Level
L, I = LOW Voltage Level J SD Q 6 14 J SD
2 Q 10
X = Don’t Care
l, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) CP 12 CP
4
l, h (q) = one set-up time prior to the LOW to HIGH clock transition.
7 13
3 K C Q K C Q 9
D D
1 15
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V MIN IOH = MAX,
VCC = MIN, MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
Q Q
5(9) 6(7)
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CLEAR (CD) SET (SD) CASE 648-08
16
15(14) 4(10)
J K 1
3(11) 2(12)
1(13)
CLOCK (CP) D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
INPUTS OUTPUTS
OPERATING MODE
SD CD J K Q Q
Set L H X X H L
LOGIC SYMBOL
Reset (Clear) H L X X L H
*Undetermined L L X X H H 4 10
Toggle H H h h q q
Load “0” (Reset) H H l h L H SD SD
11
Load “1” (Set) H H h l H L 3 J Q 5 J Q 9
Hold H H l l q q
1 CP 13 CP
* Both outputs will be HIGH while both SD and CD are LOW, but the output states
are unpredictable if SD and CD go HIGH simultaneously. 2 K CD Q 6 12 K C Q 7
D
H, h = HIGH Voltage Level
L, I = LOW Voltage Level
15 14
X = Don’t Care
l, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output)
l, h (q) = one set-up time prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition. VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V MIN IOH = MAX,
VCC = MIN, MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J, K 20
Set, Clear 60 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
Clock 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
J, K 0.1
Set, Clear 0.3 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
Clock 0.4
Input LOW Current J, K – 0.4
IIL mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
Clear, Set, Clk – 0.8
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 – 100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 6.0 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
Q Q
5(9) 6(8)
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 646-06
SET (SD) 14
4(10)
K 1
J
3(11) 2(12)
1(13)
CLOCK (CP) D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
J, K 20
Set 60 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
Clock 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
J, K 0.1
Set 0.3 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
Clock 0.4
J, K – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
Set, Clock – 0.8
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 – 100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 6.0 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
INPUTS OUTPUTS SN74LSXXXN Plastic
OPERATING MODE SN74LSXXXD SOIC
SD CD J K Q Q
Set L H X X H L
Reset (Clear) H L X X L H
*Undetermined L L X X H H LOGIC SYMBOL
Toggle H H h h q q
Load “0” (Reset) H H l h L H
4 10
Load “1” (Set) H H h l H L
Hold H H l l q q
SD 11 SD
* Both outputs will be HIGH while both SD and CD are LOW, but the output states 3 J Q 5 J Q 9
are unpredictable if SD and CD go HIGH simultaneously.
13 CP CP
H, h = HIGH Voltage Level
L, I = LOW Voltage Level 2 K CD Q 6 12 K C Q 8
X = Don’t Care D
l, h (q) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output)
l, h (q) = one set-up time prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition. 1
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
Q CLR
Q D SUFFIX
SOIC
CLR Q 16
Q 1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1A 1B 1 1Q 2Q 2 2 GND
CLR Cext Rext/ J SUFFIX
Cext CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
SN54 / 74LS122 (TOP VIEW) 14
1
(SEE NOTES 1 THRU 4)
Rext/
VCC Cext NC Cext NC Rint Q
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
Rint CASE 646-06
14
Q
1
CLR Q
D SUFFIX
SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1 CASE 751A-02
A1 A2 B1 B2 CLR Q GND
NC — NO INTERNAL CONNECTION.
LS122 LS123
FUNCTIONAL TABLE FUNCTIONAL TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS INPUTS OUTPUTS
CLEAR A1 A2 B1 B2 Q Q CLEAR A B Q Q
L X X X X L H L X X L H
X H H X X L H X H X L H
X X X L X L H X X L L H
X X X X L L H H L ↑
H L X ↑ H H ↓ H
H L X H ↑ ↑ L H
H X L ↑ H
H X L H ↑
H H ↓ H H
H ↓ ↓ H H
H ↓ H H H
↑ L X H H
↑ X L H H
WAVEFORMS
RETRIGGER
PULSE (See Application Data)
B INPUT
Q OUTPUT
B INPUT
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y A to Q 23 33
ns
tPHL Propagation Delay, A to Q 32 45 Cext = 0
23 44 CL = 15 pF
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y B to Q
ns
tPHL Propagation Delay, B to Q 34 56 Rext = 5.0 kΩ
28 45 RL = 2.0 kΩ
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y Clear to Q
ns
tPHL Propagation Delay, Clear to Q 20 27
tW min A or B to Q 116 200 ns Cext = 1000 pF, Rext = 10 kΩ,
tWQ A to B to Q 4.0 4.5 5.0 µs CL = 15 pF, RL = 2.0 kΩ
Figure 1 Figure 2
Pin
Pout tW
RETRIGGER
Figure 3
10
5K ≤ Rext ≤ 260K
EXTERNAL CAPACITANCE, Cext ( µF)
0.1
0.01
0.001
0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 0.55
K
Figure 4
Figure 5. K versus VCC Figure 6. K versus VRC Figure 7. K versus VCC and VRC
100000
Rext = 260 kΩ
Rext = 160 kΩ
10000
t W , OUTPUT PULSE WIDTH (ns)
1000
100
Rext = 80 kΩ
Rext = 40 kΩ
Rext = 20 kΩ
Rext = 10 kΩ
Rext = 5 kΩ
10
1 10 100 1000
Cext, EXTERNAL TIMING CAPACITANCE (pF)
Figure 8
0.65
Cext = 200 pF
– 55°C
0.6 0°C
25°C
70°C
K 0.55
125°C
0.5
Figure 9
VCC
Rext
Rext REMOTE
PIN 7
OR 15
Cext
PIN 6
OR 14
VCC
PIN 9 OPEN
Rext
Rext REMOTE
PIN 13
Cext
PIN 11
VCC
Rext
REMOTE
PIN 9
PIN 13
PIN 11
VCC E D O E D O
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
QUAD 3-STATE BUFFERS
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
E D O E D O GND
LS125A J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
VCC E D O E D O 14
1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
E D O E D O GND
D SUFFIX
LS126A SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
TRUTH TABLES
LS125A LS126A
ORDERING INFORMATION
INPUTS INPUTS
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
E D OUTPUT E D OUTPUT
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
L L L H L L SN74LSXXXD SOIC
L H H H H H
H X (Z) L X (Z)
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 V or VIL per Truth Table
VIN VIN
1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
VOUT
1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
VOUT
Figure 1 Figure 2
VE VE
Figure 3 Figure 4
VCC
RL
SW1
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST
5 kΩ
CL SW2
Figure 5
SWITCH POSITIONS
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
tPZH Open Closed
tPZL Closed Open
tPLZ Closed Closed
tPHZ Closed Closed
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
5
VCC = 5 V
TA = 25°C
V O , OUTPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
0
0 0.4 0.95 1.2 1.8 2
VIN, INPUT VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
3V
VIN 1.6 V
0.8 V
0V
tPHL tPLH
Figure 2. AC Waveforms
2
TA = 25°C
∆ V T, HYSTERESIS (VOLTS)
1.6
1.2
VT–
0.8
∆ VT
0.4
0
4.5 4.75 5 5.25 5.5
VCC, POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
1.9
V T , THRESHOLD VOLTAGE (VOLTS)
1.7 VT+
∆ V T, HYSTERESIS (VOLTS)
1.5
1.3
1.1
0.9 VT–
∆ VT
0.7
– 55° 0° 25° 75° 125°
TA, AMBIENT TEMPERATURE (°C)
J SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
GND 16
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
QUAD 2-INPUT
EXCLUSIVE OR GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
* *
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
* *
CASE 632-08
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1
GND
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
TRUTH TABLE
1
IN OUT
A B Z
D SUFFIX
L L L
SOIC
L H H 14
1 CASE 751A-02
H L H
H H L
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
DATA OUTPUTS
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
A Y6 CASE 620-09
B C GL G2 G1 Y7 16
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A B C GL G2 G1 Y7 GND
OUTPUT
SELECT ENABLE N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS
OUTPUTS
ENABLE SELECT
GL G1 G2 C B A Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7
X X H X X X H H H H H H H H
X L X X X X H H H H H H H H
L H L L L L L H H H H H H H
L H L L L H H L H H H H H H
L H L L H L H H L H H H H H
L H L L H H H H H L H H H H
L H L H L L H H H H L H H H
L H L H L H H H H H H L H H
L H L H H L H H H H H H L H
L H L H H H H H H H H H H L
Output corresponding to stored
H H L X X X
address, L; all others, H
H = high level, L = low level, X = irrelevant
(1) (15)
A Y0
(14)
Y1
(13)
(2) Y2
SELECT
B
INPUTS
(12)
Y3
DATA
(11) OUTPUTS
Y4
(3)
C
(10)
Y5
(9)
(4) Y6
GL
ENABLE (7)
(5) Y7
INPUTS G2
(6)
G1
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V MIN IOH = MAX,
VCC = MIN, MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
NOTE:
The Flatpak version N SUFFIX
has the same pinouts PLASTIC
(Connection Diagram) as CASE 648-08
the Dual In-Line Package. 16
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A0 A1 A2 E1 E2 E3 O7 GND
D SUFFIX
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
SOIC
HIGH LOW 16
1 CASE 751B-03
A0 – A2 Address Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
E1, E2 Enable (Active LOW) Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
E3 Enable (Active HIGH) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
O0 – O7 Active LOW Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
NOTES:
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
LOGIC SYMBOL
A2 A1 A0 E1 E2 E3
3 2 1 4 5 6 VCC = PIN 16 1 2 3 456
GND = PIN 8
12 3
= PIN NUMBERS
A0 A1 A2 E
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 7
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
7 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
O7 O6 O5 O4 O3 O2 O1 O0
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS138 is a high speed 1-of-8 Decoder/Demultiplexer pansion of the device to a 1-of-32 (5 lines to 32 lines) decoder
fabricated with the low power Schottky barrier diode process. with just four LS138s and one inverter. (See Figure a.)
The decoder accepts three binary weighted inputs (A0, A1, A2) The LS138 can be used as an 8-output demultiplexer by
and when enabled provides eight mutually exclusive active using one of the active LOW Enable inputs as the data input
LOW Outputs (O0 – O7). The LS138 features three Enable in- and the other Enable inputs as strobes. The Enable inputs
puts, two active LOW (E1, E2) and one active HIGH (E3). All which are not used must be permanently tied to their appropri-
outputs will be HIGH unless E1 and E2 are LOW and E3 is ate active HIGH or active LOW state.
HIGH. This multiple enable function allows easy parallel ex-
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
E1 E2 E3 A0 A1 A2 O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
H X X X X X H H H H H H H H
X H X X X X H H H H H H H H
X X L X X X H H H H H H H H
L L H L L L L H H H H H H H
L L H H L L H L H H H H H H
L L H L H L H H L H H H H H
L L H H H L H H H L H H H H
L L H L L H H H H H L H H H
L L H H L H H H H H H L H H
L L H L H H H H H H H H L H
L L H H H H H H H H H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
A0
A1
A2
LS04
A3
A4
H
A0 A1 A2 E A0 A1 A2 E A0 A1 A2 E A0 A1 A2 E
O0 O31
Figure a
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX,
MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 D SUFFIX
Ea A0a A1a O0a O1a O2a O3a GND SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
A0, A1 Address Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
E Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
O0 – O3 Active LOW Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. SN74LSXXXN Plastic
NOTES: SN74LSXXXD SOIC
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC SYMBOL
LOGIC DIAGRAM
1 2 3 15 14 13
Ea A0a A1a Eb A0b A1b
1 2 3 15 14 13
E A0 A1 E A0 A1
DECODER a DECODER b
O0 O1 O2 O3 O0 O1 O2 O3
VCC = PIN 16 4 5 6 7 12 11 10 9
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
4 5 6 7 12 11 10 9
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS139 is a high speed dual 1-of-4 decoder/demultiplex- demultiplexer application.
er fabricated with the Schottky barrier diode process. The Each half of the LS139 generates all four minterms of two
device has two independent decoders, each of which accept variables. These four minterms are useful in some applica-
two binary weighted inputs (A0, A1) and provide four mutually tions, replacing multiple gate functions as shown in Fig. a, and
exclusive active LOW outputs (O0 – O3). Each decoder has an thereby reducing the number of packages required in a logic
active LOW Enable (E). When E is HIGH all outputs are forced network.
HIGH. The enable can be used as the data input for a 4-output
E E
A0 O0 A0 O0
A1 A1
TRUTH TABLE
E E
INPUTS OUTPUTS A0 O1 A0 O1
E A0 A1 O0 O1 O2 O3 A1 A1
E E
H X X H H H H
A0 O2 A0 O2
L L L L H H H A1 A1
L H L H L H H
L L H H H L H E E
A0 O3 A0 O3
L H H H H H L
A1 A1
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care Figure a
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 25
2.5 35
3.5 V MIN IOH = MAX,
VCC = MIN, MAX VIN = VIH
VOH Output
Out ut HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) CERAMIC
VCC P0 P1 P2 P3 Q9 Q8 Q7 CASE 620-09
16
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 GND
D SUFFIX
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
SOIC
16
HIGH LOW CASE 751B-03
1
P0, P1, P2, P3 BCD Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Q0 to Q9 Outputs (Note b) Open Collector 15 (7.5) U.L.
ORDERING INFORMATION
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 15 U.L. for Commercial (74) SN74LSXXXN Plastic
Temperature Ranges.
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
15 14 13 12
INPUT
INVERTERS
P0 P1 P2 P3
0 0 1 1 2 2 3 3
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 10 11
DECODE/DRIVER
GATES
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9
OUTPUTS
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
P3 P2 P1 P0 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9
L L L L L H H H H H H H H H
L L L H H L H H H H H H H H
L L H L H H L H H H H H H H
L L H H H H H L H H H H H H
L H L L H H H H L H H H H H
L H L H H H H H H L H H H H
L H H L H H H H H H L H H H
L H H H H H H H H H H L H H
H L L L H H H H H H H H L H
H L L H H H H H H H H H H L
H L H L H H H H H H H H H H
H L H H H H H H H H H H H H
H H L L H H H H H H H H H H
H H L H H H H H H H H H H H
H H H L H H H H H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H H H H H H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 250 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
54, 74 0.25 0.4 V IOL = 12 mA
VCC = VCC MIN,
VOL Output LOW Voltage 74 0.35 0.5 V IOL = 24 mA VIN = VIL or VIH
per Truth
T hT Table
bl
54, 74 2.3 3.0 V IOL = 80 mA
20 µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
IIH Input HIGH Current
0.1 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
IIL Input LOW Current – 0.4 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
ICC Power Supply Current 13 mA VCC = MAX, VIN = GND
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VCC NC D 3 2 1 9 A D SUFFIX
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
D 3 2 1 9
4 A ORDERING INFORMATION
5 6 7 8 C B
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SN74LSXXXD SOIC
4 5 6 7 8 C B GND
INPUTS OUTPUTS
SN54 / 74LS148
SN54 / 74LS748
(TOP VIEW)
OUTPUTS INPUTS OUTPUT
VCC EO GS 3 2 1 0 A0
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
EO GS 3 2 1 0
4 A0
5 6 7 EI A2 A1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 7 E1 A2 A1 GND
INPUTS OUTPUTS
SN54 / 74LS148
SN54 / 74LS147 SN54 / 74LS748
FUNCTION TABLE FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS INPUTS OUTPUTS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 D C B A EI 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 A2 A1 A0 GS EO
H H H H H H H H H H H H H H X X X X X X X X H H H H H
X X X X X X X X L L H H L L H H H H H H H H H H H H L
X X X X X X X L H L H H H L X X X X X X X L L L L L H
X X X X X X L H H H L L L L X X X X X X L H L L H L H
X X X X X L H H H H L L H L X X X X X L H H L H L L H
X X X X L H H H H H L H L L X X X X L H H H L H H L H
X X X L H H H H H H L H H L X X X L H H H H H L L L H
X X L H H H H H H H H L L L X X L H H H H H H L H L H
X L H H H H H H H H H L H L X L H H H H H H H H L L H
L H H H H H H H H H H H L L L H H H H H H H H H H L H
H = HIGH Logic Level, L = LOW Logic Level, X = Irrelevant
(11) (10)
1 0 (15)
EO
(12) (11) (14)
2 (9) 1
A GS
(13) (12)
3 2
(8)
A0
(1) (13)
4 3
(7)
(2) B (1)
5 4
(7)
(3) (2) A1
6 5
(5) (4)
8 7 (6)
A2
G31
(10)
0 G13 (15)
EO
(11) (14)
1 GS
G2 G29
(12) G9
2
G3 (9)
A0
(13) G18
3
G4
4 (1) G10
G5
G11 (7)
(2) A1
5
G23
G6
(3) G12
6
G7
(4) (6)
7 A2
G8
G28
(5)
EI
G1
SN54 / 74LS748
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
SN54 / 74LS148
SN54 / 74LS748
From To Limits
Symbol (Input) (Output) Waveform Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions
tPLH In-phase 14 18
1 thru 7 A0 A1
A0, A1, or A2 ns
tPHL output 15 25
tPLH Out-of-phase 20 36
1 thru 7 A0 A1
A0, A1, or A2 ns
tPHL output 16 29
tPLH Out-of-phase 7.0 18
0 thru 7 EO ns
tPHL output 25 40
CL = 15 pF,
F
tPLH In-phase 35 55
0 thru 7 GS ns RL = 2.0 kΩ
tPHL output 9.0 21
tPLH In-phase 16 25
EI A0 A1
A0, A1, or A2 ns
tPHL output 12 25
tPLH In-phase 12 17
EI GS ns
tPHL output 14 36
tPLH 12 21
In-phase
In phase
tPHL EI EO 28 40 ns (LS148)
output
30 45 (LS748)
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 16
1
VCC I4 I5 I6 I7 S0 S1 S2
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I3 I2 I1 I0 Z Z E GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) SN74LSXXXD SOIC
HIGH LOW
S0 – S2 Select Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
E Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
I0 – I7 Multiplexer Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Z Multiplexer Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
Z Complementary Multiplexer Output 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. 7 4 3 2 1 15 14 13 12
(Note b)
NOTES: E I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. 11 S0
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74) 10 S1
Temperature Ranges. 9 S2
Z Z
6 5
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7
9 4 3 2 1 15 14 13 12
S2
10
S1
11
S0
7
E
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8 6 5
= PIN NUMBERS
Z Z
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS151 is a logical implementation of a single pole, Z = E ⋅ (I0 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + ⋅ I1 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I2 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2
8-position switch with the switch position controlled by the + I3 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I4 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I5 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I6 ⋅ S0
state of three Select inputs, S0, S1, S2. Both assertion and ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I7 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2).
negation outputs are provided. The Enable input (E) is active The LS151 provides the ability, in one package, to select
LOW. When it is not activated, the negation output is HIGH from eight sources of data or control information. By proper
and the assertion output is LOW regardless of all other inputs. manipulation of the inputs, the LS151 can provide any logic
The logic function provided at the output is: function of four variables and its negation.
TRUTH TABLE
E S2 S1 S0 I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 Z Z
H X X X X X X X X X X X H L
L L L L L X X X X X X X H L
L L L L H X X X X X X X L H
L L L H X L X X X X X X H L
L L L H X H X X X X X X L H
L L H L X X L X X X X X H L
L L H L X X H X X X X X L H
L L H H X X X L X X X X H L
L L H H X X X H X X X X L H
L H L L X X X X L X X X H L
L H L L X X X X H X X X L H
L H L H X X X X X L X X H L
L H L H X X X X X H X X L H
L H H L X X X X X X L X H L
L H H L X X X X X X H X L H
L H H H X X X X X X X L H L
L H H H X X X X X X X H L H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
1 6 5 4 3 10 11 12 13 15
7 9
VCC = PIN 16
VCC = PIN 16 GND = PIN 8
GND = PIN 8
7 9
= PIN NUMBERS
Za Zb
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS153 is a Dual 4-input Multiplexer fabricated with Low Za = Ea ⋅ (I0a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I1a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I2a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 +
Power, Schottky barrier diode process for high speed. It can I3a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0)
select two bits of data from up to four sources under the control
of the common Select Inputs (S0, S1). The two 4-input multi- Zb = Eb ⋅ (I0b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I1b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I2b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 +
plexer circuits have individual active LOW Enables (Ea, Eb) I3b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0)
which can be used to strobe the outputs independently. When
the Enables (Ea, Eb) are HIGH, the corresponding outputs (Za, The LS153 can be used to move data from a group of regis-
Zb) are forced LOW. ters to a common output bus. The particular register from
The LS153 is the logic implementation of a 2-pole, 4-posi- which the data came would be determined by the state of the
tion switch, where the position of the switch is determined by Select Inputs. A less obvious application is a function genera-
the logic levels supplied to the two Select Inputs. The logic tor. The LS153 can generate two functions of three variables.
equations for the outputs are shown below. This is useful for implementing highly irregular random logic.
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT INPUTS INPUTS (a or b) OUTPUT
S0 S1 E I0 I1 I2 I3 Z
X X H X X X X L
L L L L X X X L
L L L H X X X H
H L L X L X X L
H L L X H X X H
L H L X X L X L
L H L X X H X H
H H L X X X L L
H H L X X X H H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 1
VCC Eb Eb A0 O3b O2b O1b O0b
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE: D SUFFIX
The Flatpak version SOIC
16
has the same pinouts 1 CASE 751B-03
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
ORDERING INFORMATION
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
Ea Ea A1 O3a O2a O1a O0a GND SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
LOGIC SYMBOL
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Ea Ea A0 A1 Eb Eb
1 2 13 3 14 15
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8 7 6 5 4 9 10 11 12
= PIN NUMBERS
O0a O1a O2a O3a O0b O1b O2b O3b
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS155 and LS156 are Dual 1-of-4 Decoder/Demulti- AND the minterm functions by tying outputs together. Any
plexers with common Address inputs and separate gated number of terms can be wired-AND as shown below.
Enable inputs. When enabled, each decoder section accepts
the binary weighted Address inputs (A0, A1) and provides four f = (E + A0 + A1) ⋅ (E + A0 + A1) ⋅ (E + A0 + A1) ⋅
mutually exclusive active LOW outputs (O0 – O3). If the Enable (E + A0 + A1)
requirements of each decoder are not met, all outputs of that where E = Ea + Ea; E = Eb + Eb
decoder are HIGH.
Each decoder section has a 2-input enable gate. The E E
enable gate for Decoder “a” requires one active HIGH input A0 O0 A0 O0
A1 A1
and one active LOW input (Ea•Ea). In demultiplexing applica-
tions, Decoder “a” can accept either true or complemented E E
data by using the Ea or Ea inputs respectively. The enable gate A0 O1 A0 O1
for Decoder “b” requires two active LOW inputs (Eb•Eb). The A1 A1
LS155 or LS156 can be used as a 1-of-8 Decoder/Demulti- E E
plexer by tying Ea to Eb and relabeling the common connection A0 O2 A0 O2
A1 A1
as (A2). The other Eb and Ea are connected together to form
the common enable. E E
The LS155 and LS156 can be used to generate all four A0 O3 A0 O3
minterms of two variables. These four minterms are useful in A1 A1
some applications replacing multiple gate functions as shown
in Fig. a. The LS156 has the further advantage of being able to Figure a
TRUTH TABLE
ADDRESS ENABLE “a” OUTPUT “a” ENABLE “b” OUTPUT “b”
A0 A1 Ea Ea O0 O1 O2 O3 Eb Eb O0 O1 O2 O3
X X L X H H H H H X H H H H
X X X H H H H H X H H H H H
L L H L L H H H L L L H H H
H L H L H L H H L L H L H H
L H H L H H L H L L H H L H
H H H L H H H L L L H H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
LOGIC DIAGRAM
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d E S LOGIC SYMBOL
2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10 15 1
15 2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10
1 S
Za Zb Zc Zd
4 7 12 9
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS157 is a Quad 2-Input Multiplexer fabricated with the Za = E ⋅ (I1a ⋅ S + I0a ⋅ S) Zb = E ⋅ (I1b ⋅ S + I0b ⋅ S)
Schottky barrier diode process for high speed. It selects four Zc = E ⋅ (I1c ⋅ S + I0c ⋅ S) Zd = E ⋅ (I1d ⋅ S + I0d ⋅ S)
bits of data from two sources under the control of a common
Select Input (S). The Enable Input (E) is active LOW. When E A common use of the LS157 is the moving of data from two
is HIGH, all of the outputs (Z) are forced LOW regardless of all groups of registers to four common output busses. The partic-
other inputs. ular register from which the data comes is determined by the
The LS157 is the logic implementation of a 4-pole, state of the Select Input. A less obvious use is as a function
2-position switch where the position of the switch is deter- generator. The LS157 can generate any four of the 16 different
mined by the logic levels supplied to the Select Input. The logic functions of two variables with one variable common. This is
equations for the outputs are: useful for implementing highly irregular logic.
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT
ENABLE INPUT INPUTS OUTPUT
E S I0 I1 Z
H X X X L
L H X L L
L H X H H
L L L X L
L L H X H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
LOGIC DIAGRAM
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d E S LOGIC SYMBOL
2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10 15 1
15 2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10
1 S
Za Zb Zc Zd
4 7 12 9
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS158 is a Quad 2-input Multiplexer fabricated with the mined by the logic levels supplied to the Select Input.
Schottky barrier diode process for high speed. It selects four A common use of the LS158 is the moving of data from two
bits of data from two sources under the control of a common groups of registers to four common output busses. The
Select Input (S) and presents the data in inverted form at the particular register from which the data comes is determined by
four outputs. The Enable Input (E) is active LOW. When E is the state of the Select Input. A less obvious use is as a function
HIGH, all of the outputs (Z) are forced HIGH regardless of all generator. The LS158 can generate four functions of two
other inputs. variables with one variable common. This is useful for
The LS158 is the logic implementation of a 4-pole, implementing gating functions.
2-position switch where the position of the switch is deter-
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT
ENABLE INPUT INPUTS OUTPUT
E S I0 I1 Z
H X X X H
L L L X H
L L H X L
L H X L H
L H X H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VCC TC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 CET PE
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 D SUFFIX
NOTE: SOIC
16
The Flatpak version
1 CASE 751B-03
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
ORDERING INFORMATION
*MR for LS160A and LS161A
*SR for LS162A and LS163A SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SN74LSXXXN Plastic
*R CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP GND SN74LSXXXD SOIC
STATE DIAGRAM
LS160A • LS162A LS161A • LS163A
LOGIC EQUATIONS
0 1 2 3 4 0 1 2 3 4
Count Enable = CEP • CET • PE
TC for LS160A & LS162A = CET • Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3
TC for LS161A & LS163A = CET • Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3
15 5 15 5 Preset = PE • CP + (rising clock edge)
Reset = MR (LS160A & LS161A)
Reset = SR • CP + (rising clock edge)
14 6 14 6 Reset = (LS162A & LS163A)
13 7 13 7 NOTE:
The LS160A and LS162A can be preset to any state,
but will not count beyond 9. If preset to state 10, 11,
12 11 10 9 8 12 11 10 9 8 12, 13, 14, or 15, it will return to its normal sequence
within two clock pulses.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS160A / 161A / 162A / 163A are 4-bit synchronous the Binary counters). Note that TC is fully decoded and will,
counters with a synchronous Parallel Enable (Load) feature. therefore, be HIGH only for one count state.
The counters consist of four edge-triggered D flip-flops with The LS160A and LS162A count modulo 10 following a
the appropriate data routing networks feeding the D inputs. All binary coded decimal (BCD) sequence. They generate a TC
changes of the Q outputs (except due to the asynchronous output when the CET input is HIGH while the counter is in state
Master Reset in the LS160A and LS161A) occur as a result of, 9 (HLLH). From this state they increment to state 0 (LLLL). If
and synchronous with, the LOW to HIGH transition of the loaded with a code in excess of 9 they return to their legitimate
Clock input (CP). As long as the set-up time requirements are sequence within two counts, as explained in the state
met, there are no special timing or activity constraints on any diagram. States 10 through 15 do not generate a TC output.
of the mode control or data inputs. The LS161A and LS163A count modulo 16 following a
Three control inputs — Parallel Enable (PE), Count Enable binary sequence. They generate a TC when the CET input is
Parallel (CEP) and Count Enable Trickle (CET) — select the HIGH while the counter is in state 15 (HHHH). From this state
mode of operation as shown in the tables below. The Count they increment to state 0 (LLLL).
Mode is enabled when the CEP, CET, and PE inputs are HIGH. The Master Reset (MR) of the LS160A and LS161A is
When the PE is LOW, the counters will synchronously load the asynchronous. When the MR is LOW, it overrides all other
data from the parallel inputs into the flip-flops on the LOW to input conditions and sets the outputs LOW. The MR pin should
HIGH transition of the clock. Either the CEP or CET can be never be left open. If not used, the MR pin should be tied
used to inhibit the count sequence. With the PE held HIGH, a through a resistor to VCC, or to a gate output which is
LOW on either the CEP or CET inputs at least one set-up time permanently set to a HIGH logic level.
prior to the LOW to HIGH clock transition will cause the The active LOW Synchronous Reset (SR) input of the
existing output states to be retained. The AND feature of the LS162A and LS163A acts as an edge-triggered control input,
two Count Enable inputs (CET • CEP) allows synchronous overriding CET, CEP and PE, and resetting the four counter
cascading without external gating and without delay accu- flip-flops on the LOW to HIGH transition of the clock. This
mulation over any practical number of bits or digits. simplifies the design from race-free logic controlled reset
The Terminal Count (TC) output is HIGH when the Count circuits, e.g., to reset the counter synchronously after
Enable Trickle (CET) input is HIGH while the counter is in its reaching a predetermined value.
maximum count state (HLLH for the BCD counters, HHHH for
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to level may be released prior to the clock transition from LOW to
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be recog- HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time re-
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following quired between the end of the reset pulse and the clock transi-
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must tion from LOW to HIGH in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog- HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
tW
tW(H) tW(L) MR 1.3 V
1.3 V OTHER CONDITIONS: trec OTHER CONDITIONS:
CP 1.3 V
PE = MR (SR) = H PE = L
1.3 V
tPHL tPLH CEP = CET = H CP P0 = P1 = P2 = P3 = H
tPHL
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Q0 ⋅ Q1 ⋅ Q2 ⋅ Q3 1.3 V
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays, Count Figure 2. Master Reset to Output Delay, Master Reset
Frequency, and Clock Pulse Width Pulse Width, and Master Reset Recovery Time
AC WAVEFORMS (continued)
The positive TC pulse is coincident with the output state tPLH tPHL
(Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3) state for the LS161 and LS163 and
(Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3) for the LS161 and LS163. TC 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to P0 • P1 • P2 • P3 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
change for predictable output performance.
Q0 • Q1 • Q2 • Q3
Q RESPONSE TO SR Q
OTHER CONDITIONS: PE = H, MR = H
Figure 6 Figure 7
VCC Q7 Q6 Q5 Q4 MR CP N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 CASE 646-06
14
NOTE: 1
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package. D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A B Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
LOGIC DIAGRAM
A
1
D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q
2
B
CD CD CD CD CD CD CD CD
8
CP
MR
9
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
VCC = PIN 14 3 4 5 6 10 11 12 13
GND = PIN 7
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS164 is an edge-triggered 8-bit shift register with seri- Each LOW-to-HIGH transition on the Clock (CP) input shifts
al data entry and an output from each of the eight stages. Data data one place to the right and enters into Q0 the logical AND
is entered serially through one of two inputs (A or B); either of of the two data inputs (A•B) that existed before the rising clock
these inputs can be used as an active HIGH Enable for data edge. A LOW level on the Master Reset (MR) input overrides
entry through the other input. An unused input must be tied all other inputs and clears the register asynchronously, forcing
HIGH, or both inputs connected together. all Q outputs LOW.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage V
74 2.7 3.5 or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
I/fmax MR
tW 1.3 V 1.3 V
1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP tW trec
tPHL tPLH
1.3 V
Q CP
1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL
CONDITIONS: MR = H
Q
1.3 V
1/fmax
tW
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) th(L)
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 N SUFFIX
PL CP1 P4 P5 P6 P7 Q7 GND PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
11 12 13 14 3 4 5 6
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7
10 DS
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54/74LS165 contains eight clocked master/slave applying a HIGH signal. To avoid double clocking, however,
RS flip-flops connected as a shift register, with auxiliary gating the inhibit signal should only go HIGH while the clock is HIGH.
to provide overriding asynchronous parallel entry. Parallel Otherwise, the rising inhibit signal will cause the same
data enters when the PL signal is LOW. The parallel data can response as a rising clock edge. The flip-flops are
change while PL is LOW, provided that the recommended set- edge-triggered for serial operations. The serial input data can
up and hold times are observed. change at any time, provided only that the recommended
For clock operation, PL must be HIGH. The two clock inputs setup and hold times are observed, with respect to the rising
perform identically; one can be used as a clock inhibit by edge of the clock.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DEFINITION OF TERMS:
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required recognition. A negative hold time indicates that the correct
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
to the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the PL pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to recognize and
must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued transfer loaded Data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
CP1
tW
ts 1/fmax PL 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW
CP2 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
tPLH
tPHL Q7 OR Q7 1.3 V 1.3 V
Q7 OR Q7 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1 Figure 2
Figure 3 Figure 4
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS INTERNAL
OUTPUTS OUTPUT
SHIFT/ CLOCK PARALLEL
CLEAR CLOCK SERIAL QH
LOAD INHIBIT A...H QA QB
L X X X X X L L L
H X L L X X QA0 QB0 QH0
H L L ↑ X a...h a b h
H H L ↑ H X H QAn QGn
H H L ↑ L X L QAn QGn
H X H ↑ X X QA0 QB0 QH0
CLOCK
CLOCK INIHIBIT
CLEAR
SERIAL INPUT
SHIFT/LOAD
A H
B L
C H
PARALLEL D L
INPUTS
E H
L
F
G H
H H
OUTPUT QH H H L H L H L H
INHIBIT
SERIAL SHIFT SERIAL SHIFT
CLEAR LOAD
(9)
CLEAR
(1)
SERIAL INPUT
(15)
SHIFT/LOAD
(2)
A
R S
CK
QA
(3)
B
R S
CK
QB
(4)
C
R S
CK
QC
(5)
D
R S
CK
QD
(10)
E
R S
CK
QE
(11)
F
R S
CK
QF
(12)
G
R S
CK
QG
(14)
H
(7) R S
CLOCK CK
(6) (13) Q
CLOCK INHIBIT H
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
tw(clear)
3V
CLEAR INPUT Vref Vref
0V
tn + 1 (SEE NOTE 1) tn + 1
tn tn
3V
CLOCK INPUT Vref Vref Vref Vref
th 0V
tsu
tw(clock) th tsu
3V
DATA Vref Vref Vref
INPUT
(SEE TEST 0V
TABLE)
tPHL tPHL
(clear-Q) tPLH (CLK-Q)
(CLK-Q) VOH
Vref Vref Vref
OUTPUT Q
VOL
N SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
VCC TC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 CET PE
1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
The Flatpak version D SUFFIX
has the same pinouts SOIC
(Connection Diagram) as 16
1 CASE 751B-03
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
U/D CP P0 P1 P2 P3 CEP GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) SN74LSXXXD SOIC
HIGH LOW
CEP Count Enable Parallel (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
CET Count Enable Trickle (Active LOW) Input 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
CP Clock Pulse (Active positive going edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 9 3 4 5 6
PE Parallel Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
U/D Up-Down Count Control Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
P0–P3 Parallel Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. PE P0 P1 P2 P3
1 U/D
Q0–Q3 Flip-Flop Outputs 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
7 CEP
TC Terminal Count (Active LOW) Output 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. TC 15
10 CET
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
2 CP
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges.
14 13 12 11
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
STATE DIAGRAMS
0 1 2 3 4 0 1 2 3 4
15 5 15 5
Count Up
14 6 14 6
Count Down
13 7 13 7
12 11 10 9 8 12 11 10 9 8
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
SN54 / 74LS168
P0 P1 P2 P3
PE
CEP
CET
U/D
TC
CP
CP D
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
SN54 / 74LS169
P0 P1 P2 P3
PE
CEP
CET
U/D
TC
CP
CP D
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54/74LS168 and SN54/74LS169 use edge- The Terminal Count (TC) output is normally HIGH and goes
triggered D-type flip-flops that have no constraints on LOW, provided that CET is LOW, when a counter reaches zero
changing the control or data input signals in either state of the in the COUNT DOWN mode or reaches 15 (9 for the
Clock. The only requirement is that the various inputs attain SN54/74LS168) in the COUNT UP mode. The TC output state
the desired state at least a set-up time before the rising edge of is not a function of the Count Enable Parallel (CEP) input level.
the clock and remain valid for the recommended hold time The TC output of the SN54/74LS168 decade counter can also
thereafter. be LOW in the illegal states 11, 13 and 15, which can occur
The parallel load operation takes precedence over the other when power is turned on or via parallel loading. If illegal state
operations, as indicated in the Mode Select Table. When PE is occurs, the SN54/74LS168 will return to the legitimate
LOW, the data on the P0 – P3 inputs enters the flip-flops on the sequence within two counts. Since the TC signal is derived by
next rising edge of the Clock. In order for counting to occur, decoding the flip-flop states, there exists the possibility of
both CEP and CET must be LOW and PE must be HIGH. The decoding spikes on TC. For this reason the use of TC as a
U/D input then determines the direction of counting. clock signal is not recommended.
Setup Time
ts 25 ns
PE VCC = 5.0 V
Setup Time
ts 30 ns
U/D
Hold Time
th 0 ns
Any Input
AC WAVEFORMS
1/fmax
tW 1.3 V 1.3 V
CET
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V tPLH tPHL
tPLH 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL TC
Q OR TC 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) = 0 th(L) = 0
Figure 3. Clock to Terminal Delays Figure 4. Setup Time (ts) and Hold (th)
for Parallel Data Inputs
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts(L) ts(H)
th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
tPLH tPHL
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V TC 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) = 0 th(L) = 0
Figure 6. Up-Down Input to
CEP 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
Terminal Count Output Delays
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) = 0 th(L) = 0
N SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
VCC D1 WA WB EW ER Q1 Q2
1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
The Flatpak version D SUFFIX
has the same pinouts SOIC
16
(Connection Diagram) as 1 CASE 751B-03
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ORDERING INFORMATION
D2 D3 D4 RB RA Q4 Q3 GND
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D4 D3 D2 D1
3 2 1 15
12
EW
13
WB
WA
14
WORD
0
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
1
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
2
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
3
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
4
RB
11
ER
5
RA
6 7 9 10
Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
WRITE FUNCTION TABLE (SEE NOTES A, B, AND C) READ FUNCTION TABLE (SEE NOTES A AND D)
WRITE INPUTS WORD READ INPUTS OUTPUTS
WB WA EW 0 1 2 3 RB RA ER Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
L L L Q=D Q0 Q0 Q0 L L L W0B1 W0B2 W0B3 W0B4
L H L Q0 Q=D Q0 Q0 L H L W1B1 W1B2 W1B3 W1B4
H L L Q0 Q0 Q=D Q0 H L L W2B1 W2B2 W2B3 W2B4
H H L Q0 Q0 Q0 Q=D H H L W3B1 W3B2 W3B3 W3B4
X X H Q0 Q0 Q0 Q0 X X H H H H H
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS
3V 3V
WRITE-SELECT Vref Vref DATA INPUT Vref
INPUT WA or WB 0V D1, D2, D3 or D4
tsu(W) 0V
th(W)
DATA INPUT 3V 3V
WRITE-ENABLE
D1, D2, D3 or D4 Vref Vref Vref
0V INPUT EW
th(D) 0V
WRITE-ENABLE tsu(D) tPLH tPHL
tw 3V VOH
INPUT EW OUTPUT
Vref Vref Vref Vref
Q1, Q2, Q3 or Q4
0V VOL
tlatch
3V 3V
READ-SELECT Vref Vref DATA INPUT
INPUT RA or RB 0V D1, D2, D3 or D4 Vref
tW 0V
READ-ENABLE 3V 3V
INPUT ER Vref Vref WRITE-ENABLE
0V INPUT EW Vref
tPLH 0V
OUTPUT tPHL VOH tPHL tPLH
Q1, Q2, Q3 or Q4 3V
Vref Vref OUTPUT
VOL Q1, Q2, Q3 or Q4 Vref Vref
tPHL 0V
tPLH
Figure 1 Figure 2
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
D0 – D 3 Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
IE1 – IE2 Input Enable (Active LOW) 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 9 10 14 13 12 11
OE1 – OE2 Output Enable (Active LOW) Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
CP Clock Pulse (Active HIGH Going Edge) 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
1 2
Input
MR Master Reset Input (Active HIGH) 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Q0 – Q3 Outputs (Note b) 65 (25) U.L. 15 (7.5) U.L. IE D0 D1 D2 D3
7 CP
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. 1 1
OE
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74) 2 2 MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
b. Temperature Ranges.
15 3 4 5 6
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D0 D1 D2 D3
14 13 12 11
IE1 9
IE2 10
CP
7
CP D D D D
Q Q
MR 15
OE1 1
3 4 5 6
OE2 2
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
TRUTH TABLE
MR CP IE1 IE2 Dn Qn
H x x x x L
L L x x x Qn
L H x x Qn
L x H x Qn H = HIGH Voltage Level
L L L L L L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
L L L H H
When either OE1, or OE2 are HIGH, the output is in the off state (High Impedance);
however this does not affect the contents or sequential operation of the register.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
1 / fmax
CP tW
MR
1.3 V 1.3 V
tW trec
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) th(L) 1.3 V
CP
D or E 1.3 V 1.3 V tPHL
Q
1.3 V
Q tPLH 1.3 V tPHL 1.3 V
Figure 1 Figure 2
Figure 3 Figure 4
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
RL SWITCH POSITIONS
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
SW1 tPZH Open Closed
tPZL Closed Open
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPLZ Closed Closed
tPHZ Closed Closed
5 kΩ
CL*
SW2
Figure 5
J SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) CERAMIC
VCC Q5 D5 D4 Q4 D3 Q3 CP CASE 620-09
16
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 1
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as N SUFFIX
the Dual In-Line Package. PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1
MR Q0 D0 D1 Q1 D2 Q2 GND
D SUFFIX
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) SOIC
16
HIGH LOW 1 CASE 751B-03
LOGIC SYMBOL
LOGIC DIAGRAM
3 4 6 11 13 14
MR CP D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
1 9 14 13 11 6 4 3
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5
9 CP
1 MR
D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q D Q Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5
CP CP CP CP CP CP
CD CD CD CD CD CD
2 5 7 10 12 15
15 12 10 7 5 2
VCC = PIN 16 Q5 Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1 Q0
GND = PIN 8 VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS174 consists of six edge-triggered D flip-flops with A LOW input to the Master Reset (MR) will force all outputs
individual D inputs and Q outputs. The Clock (CP) and Master LOW independent of Clock or Data inputs. The LS174 is
Reset (MR) are common to all flip-flops. useful for applications where the true output only is required
Each D input’s state is transferred to the corresponding flip- and the Clock and Master Reset are common to all storage
flop’s output following the LOW to HIGH Clock (CP) transition. elements.
TRUTH TABLE
Inputs (t = n, MR = H) Outputs (t = n+1) Note 1
D Q
H H
L L
Note 1: t = n + 1 indicates conditions after next clock.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
1/fmax
tw
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW
ts(H) t
th(H)s(L) th(L) MR 1.3 V 1.3 V
trec
D * 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL 1.3 V
CP
1.3 V 1.3 V tPHL
Q Q
1.3 V 1.3 V
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to
*change for predictable output performance.
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays, Clock Pulse Width, Figure 2. Master Reset to Output Delay, Master Reset
Frequency, Setup and Hold Times Data to Clock Pulse Width, and Master Reset Recovery Time
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to level may be released prior to the clock transition from LOW to
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be recog- HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must transition from LOW to HIGH in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog- HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
N SUFFIX
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts PLASTIC
(Connection Diagram) as 16 CASE 648-08
the Dual In-Line Package.
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MR Q0 Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q1 GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) 16
1 CASE 751B-03
HIGH LOW
D0 – D 3 Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
CP Clock (Active HIGH Going Edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
MR Master Reset (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Q0 – Q3 True Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
Q0 – Q3 Complemented Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC SYMBOL
LOGIC DIAGRAM 4 5 12 13
MR CP D3 D2 D1 D0
1 9 13 12 5 4
D0 D1 D2 D3
9 CP
D Q D Q D Q D Q 1 MR
Q0 Q0 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q2 Q3 Q3
CP Q CP Q CP Q CP Q
CD CD CD CD
3 2 6 7 11 10 14 15
14 15 11 10 6 7 3 2
VCC = PIN 16 VCC = PIN 16
Q3 Q3 Q2 Q2 Q1Q1 Q0 Q0
GND = PIN 8 GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS175 consists of four edge-triggered D flip-flops with LOW input on the Master Reset (MR) will force all Q outputs
individual D inputs and Q and Q outputs. The Clock and LOW and Q outputs HIGH independent of Clock or Data
Master Reset are common. The four flip-flops will store the inputs.
state of their individual D inputs on the LOW to HIGH Clock The LS175 is useful for general logic applications where a
(CP) transition, causing individual Q and Q outputs to follow. A common Master Reset and Clock are acceptable.
TRUTH TABLE
Inputs (t = n, MR = H) Outputs (t = n+1) Note 1
D Q Q
L L H
H H L
Note 1: t = n + 1 indicates conditions after next clock.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
1/fmax
tw
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V tW
ts(H) t MR 1.3 V 1.3 V
th(H) s(L) th(L)
trec
D * 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP
tPLH tPHL tPHL
Q
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH tPLH
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays, Clock Pulse Width, Figure 2. Master Reset to Output Delay, Master Reset
Frequency, Setup and Hold Times Data to Clock Pulse Width, and Master Reset Recovery Time
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to level may be released prior to the clock transition from LOW to
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be recog- HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must transition from LOW to HIGH in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog- HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 24 CASE 623-05
VCC A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 G Cn+4 P A=B F3 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 649-03
24
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
B0 A0 S3 S2 S1 S0 Cn M F0 F1 F2 GND ORDERING INFORMATION
NOTE: SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
The Flatpak version SN74LSXXXN Plastic
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
LOGIC SYMBOL
2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
7 Cn Cn+4 16
A0 – A3, B0 – B3 Operand (Active LOW) Inputs 1.5 U.L. 0.75 U.L.
S0 – S3 Function — Select Inputs 2.0 U.L. 1.0 U.L. 8 M A=B 14
M Mode Control Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 6 S0 G 17
Cn Carry Input 2.5 U.L. 1.25 U.L. 5 S1
4 S2 P 15
F0 – F3 Function (Active LOW) Outputs 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
A=B Comparator Output Open Collector 5 (2.5) U.L. 3 S3 F0 F1 F2 F3
G Carry Generator (Active LOW) 10 U.L. 10 U.L.
Output
9 10 11 13
P Carry Propagate (Active LOW) 10 U.L. 5 U.L.
Output VCC = PIN 24
Cn+4 Carry Output 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. GND = PIN 12
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
7 8 2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18
Cn M A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
S0 6 5
S1 4
S2
S3 3
VCC = PIN 24
GND = PIN 12
= PIN NUMBERS
F0 F1 A=B F2 F3 P Cn+4 G
9 10 14 11 13 15 16 17
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS181 is a 4-bit high speed parallel Arithmetic over extremely long word lengths.
Logic Unit (ALU). Controlled by the four Function Select Inputs The A = B output from the LS181 goes HIGH when all four F
(S0 . . . S3) and the Mode Control Input (M), it can perform all outputs are HIGH and can be used to indicate logic
the 16 possible logic operations or 16 different arithmetic equivalence over four bits when the unit is in the subtract
operations on active HIGH or active LOW operands. The mode. The A = B output is open collector and can be
Function Table lists these operations. wired-AND with other A = B outputs to give a comparison for
When the Mode Control Input (M) is HIGH, all internal more then four bits. The A = B signal can also be used with the
carries are inhibited and the device performs logic operations Cn+4 signal to indicate A>B and A<B.
on the individual bits as listed. When the Mode Control Input is The Function Table lists the arithmetic operations that are
LOW, the carries are enabled and the device performs performed without a carry in. An incoming carry adds a one to
arithmetic operations on the two 4-bit words. The device each operation. Thus, select code LHHL generates A minus B
incorporates full internal carry lookahead and provides for minus 1 (2s complement notation) without a carry in and
either ripple carry between devices using the Cn+4 output, or generates A minus B when a carry is applied. Because
for carry lookahead between packages using the signals P subtraction is actually performed by complementary addition
(Carry Propagate) and G (Carry Generate), P and G are not (1s complement), a carry out means borrow; thus a carry is
affected by carry in. When speed requirements are not generated when there is no underflow and no carry is
stringent, the LS181 can be used in a simple ripple carry mode generated when there is underflow.
by connecting the Carry Output (Cn+4) signal to the Carry Input As indicated, the LS181 can be used with either active LOW
(Cn) of the next unit. For high speed operation the LS181 is inputs producing active LOW outputs or with active HIGH
used in conjunction with the 9342 or 93S42 carry lookahead inputs producing active HIGH outputs. For either case the
circuit. One carry lookahead package is required for each table lists the operations that are performed to the operands
group of the four LS181 devices. Carry lookahead can be labeled inside the logic symbol.
provided at various levels and offers high speed capability
FUNCTION TABLE
MODE SELECT ACTIVE LOW INPUTS ACTIVE HIGH INPUTS
INPUTS & OUTPUTS & OUTPUTS
LOGIC ARITHMETIC** LOGIC ARITHMETIC**
S3 S2 S1 S0 (M = H) (M = L) (Cn = L) (M = H) (M = L) (Cn = H)
L L L L A A minus 1 A A
L L L H AB AB minus 1 A+B A+B
L L H L A+B AB minus 1 AB A+B
L L H H Logical 1 minus 1 Logical 0 minus 1
L H L L A+B A plus (A + B) AB A plus AB
L H L H B AB plus (A + B) B (A + B) plus AB
L H H L A⊕B A minus B minus 1 A⊕B A minus B minus 1
L H H H A+B A+B AB AB minus 1
H L L L AB A plus (A + B) A+B A plus AB
H L L H A⊕B A plus B A⊕B A plus B
H L H L B AB plus (A + B) B (A + B) plus AB
H L H H A+B A+B AB AB minus 1
H H L L Logical 0 A plus A* Logical 1 A plus A*
H H L H AB AB plus A A+B (A + B) plus A
H H H L AB AB plus A A+B (A + B) Plus A
H H H H A A A A minus 1
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level
**Each bit is shifted to the next more significant position
**Arithmetic operations expressed in 2s complement notation
LOGIC SYMBOLS
2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 2 1 23 22 21 20 19 18
A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3
7 Cn Cn+4 16 7 Cn Cn+4 16
8 M A=B 14 8 M A=B 14
LS181 LS181
6 S0 4 BIT ARITHMETIC G 17 6 S0 4 BIT ARITHMETIC G 17
5 S1 LOGIC UNIT 5 S1 LOGIC UNIT
4 S2 P 15 P 15
4 S2
3 S3 F0 F1 F2 F3 3 S3 F0 F1 F2 F3
9 10 11 13 9 10 11 13
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 4
Figure 5 Figure 6
VCC P0 CP RC TC PL P2 P3
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
NOTE:
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts SN74LSXXXD SOIC
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 LOGIC SYMBOL
P1 Q1 Q0 CE U/D Q2 Q3 GND
11 15 1 10 9
STATE DIAGRAMS
0 1 2 3 4 0 1 2 3 4
LS190
UP: TC = Q0 ⋅ Q3 ⋅ (U/D)
15 5 DOWN: TC = Q0 ⋅ Q1 ⋅ Q2 ⋅ Q3 ⋅ (U/D) 15 5
14 6 LS191 14 6
UP: TC = Q0 ⋅ Q1 ⋅ Q2 ⋅ Q3 ⋅ (U/D)
DOWN: TC = Q0 ⋅ Q1 ⋅ Q2 ⋅ Q3 ⋅ (U/D)
13 7 13 7
COUNT UP
COUNT DOWN
12 11 10 9 8 12 11 10 9 8
LS190 LS191
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
CP U/D P0 CE P1 P2 P3 PL
14 5 15 4 1 10 9 11
13 12 3 2 6 7
RC TC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
CP U/D P0 CE P1 P2 P3 PL
14 5 15 4 1 10 9 11
13 12 3 2 6 7
RC TC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
VCC = PIN 16
BINARY COUNTER
GND = PIN 8
LS191
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS190 is a synchronous Up / Down BCD Decade Clock (RC) output. The RC output is normally HIGH. When CE
Counter and the LS191 is a synchronous Up / Down 4-Bit is LOW and TC is HIGH, the RC output will go LOW when the
Binary Counter. The operating modes of the LS190 decade clock next goes LOW and will stay LOW until the clock goes
counter and the LS191 binary counter are identical, with the HIGH again. This feature simplifies the design of multi-stage
only difference being the count sequences as noted in the counters, as indicated in Figures a and b. In Figure a, each RC
state diagrams. Each circuit contains four master / slave output is used as the clock input for the next higher stage. This
flip-flops, with internal gating and steering logic to provide configuration is particularly advantageous when the clock
individual preset, count-up and count-down operations. source has a limited drive capability, since it drives only the
Each circuit has an asynchronous parallel load capability first stage. To prevent counting in all stages it is only necessary
permitting the counter to be preset to any desired number. to inhibit the first stage, since a HIGH signal on CE inhibits the
When the Parallel Load (PL) input is LOW, information present RC output pulse, as indicated in the RC Truth Table. A
on the Parallel Data inputs (P0 – P3) is loaded into the counter disadvantage of this configuration, in some applications, is the
and appears on the Q outputs. This operation overrides the timing skew between state changes in the first and last stages.
counting functions, as indicated in the Mode Select Table. This represents the cumulative delay of the clock as it ripples
A HIGH signal on the CE input inhibits counting. When CE is through the preceding stages.
LOW, internal state change are initiated synchronously by the A method of causing state changes to occur simultaneously
LOW-to-HIGH transition of the clock input. The direction of in all stages is shown in Figure b. All clock inputs are driven in
counting is determined by the U/D input signal, as indicated in parallel and the RC outputs propagate the carry / borrow
the Mode Select Table. When counting is to be enabled, the signals in ripple fashion. In this configuration the LOW state
CE signal can be made LOW when the clock is in either state. duration of the clock must be long enough to allow the
However, when counting is to be inhibited, the LOW-to-HIGH negative-going edge of the carry / borrow signal to ripple
CE transition must occur only while the clock is HIGH. through to the last stop before the clock goes HIGH. There is
Similarly, the U / D signal should only be changed when either no such restriction on the HIGH state duration of the clock,
CE or the clock is HIGH. since the RC output of any package goes HIGH shortly after its
Two types of outputs are provided as overflow/underflow CP input goes HIGH.
indicators. The Terminal Count (TC) output is normally LOW The configuration shown in Figure c avoids ripple delays
and goes HIGH when a circuit reaches zero in the count-down and their associated restrictions. The CE input signal for a
mode or reaches maximum (9 for the LS190, 15 for the LS191) given stage is formed by combining the TC signals from all the
in the count-up mode. The TC output will then remain HIGH preceding stages. Note that in order to inhibit counting an
until a state change occurs, whether by counting or presetting enable signal must be included in each carry gate. The simple
or until U / D is changed. The TC output should not be used as inhibit scheme of Figures a and b doesn’t apply, because the
a clock signal because it is subject to decoding spikes. TC output of a given stage is not affected by its own CE.
The TC signal is also used internally to enable the Ripple
H L L Count Up L H
H L H Count Down H X X H
L X X X Preset (Asyn.) X L X H
H H X X No Change (Hold) * TC is generated internally
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH 20 32
Data to Output Q ns
tPHL 27 40
tPLH 13 20
Clock to RC ns
tPHL 16 24
tPLH 16 24
Clock to Output Q ns VCC = 5.0 V
tPHL 24 36
CL = 15 pF
F
tPLH 28 42
Clock to TC ns
tPHL 37 52
tPLH 30 45
U / D to RC ns
tPHL 30 45
tPLH 21 33
U / D to TC ns
tPHL 22 33
tPLH 21 33
CE to RC ns
tPHL 22 33
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) is defined as the minimum time required for tion. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to the level may be released prior to the clock transition from LOW-
clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recognized to-HIGH and still be recognized.
and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) is defined as the minimum time following the required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level must be transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to recognize and
maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recogni- transfer HIGH data to the Q outputs.
DIRECTION
CONTROL
DIRECTION
CONTROL
CLOCK
DIRECTION
CONTROL
ENABLE
CLOCK
AC WAVEFORMS
1/f MAX
tW
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V CP OR CE 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1 Figure 2
Pn 1.3 V 1.3 V Pn
tPHL tPLH tW
Qn 1.3 V PL 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
Qn 1.3 V
NOTE: PL = LOW
Figure 3 Figure 4
Pn 1.3 V 1.3 V
PL 1.3 V th(H) th(L)
ts(H) ts(L)
tW trec
PL 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP 1.3 V
Qn Q=P Q=P
Q
* The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted
* to change for predictable output performance
Figure 5 Figure 6
th(L) th(H)
U/D 1.3 V
Figure 7 Figure 8
D SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) SOIC
16
VCC P0 MR TCD TCU PL P2 P3 1 CASE 751B-03
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
ORDERING INFORMATION
NOTE:
The Flatpak version SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
has the same pinouts SN74LSXXXN Plastic
(Connection Diagram) as SN74LSXXXD SOIC
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
P1 Q1 Q0 CPD CPU Q2 Q3 GND LOGIC SYMBOL
11 15 1 10 9
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
PL P0 P1 P2 P3
CPU Count Up Clock Pulse Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 5 CPU TCU 12
CPD Count Down Clock Pulse Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
MR Asynchronous Master Reset (Clear) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
4 CPD TCD 13
PL Asynchronous Parallel Load (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
Pn Parallel Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Qn Flip-Flop Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
TCD Terminal Count Down (Borrow) Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. 14 3 2 6 7
TCU Terminal Count Up (Carry) Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
VCC = PIN 16
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. GND = PIN 8
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges.
STATE DIAGRAMS
14 6 14 6
LS193 LOGIC EQUATIONS
FOR TERMINAL COUNT
13 7 13 7
TCU = Q0 ⋅ Q1⋅ Q2⋅ Q3 ⋅ CPU
TCD = Q0 ⋅ Q1 ⋅ Q2 ⋅ Q3 ⋅ CPD
12 11 10 9 8 12 11 10 9 8
COUNT UP
COUNT DOWN
LS192 LS193
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
P0 P1 P2 P3
PL 11 15 1 10 9
(LOAD)
5
CPU 12 TCU
(UP COUNT) (CARRY
OUTPUT)
SD SD SD SD
Q Q Q Q
T T T T
CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q
13 TCD
CPD 4
(BORROW
(DOWN OUTPUT)
COUNT) 14
MR
(CLEAR) 3 2 6 7
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
P0 P1 P2 P3
PL 11 15 1 10 9
(LOAD)
5
CPU TCU
12
(UP COUNT) (CARRY
OUTPUT)
SD SD SD SD
Q Q Q Q
T T T T
CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q
13 TCD
CPD 4
(BORROW
(DOWN OUTPUT)
COUNT) 14
MR
(CLEAR) 3 2 6 7
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
LS193
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS192 and LS193 are Asynchronously Presettable The Terminal Count Up (TCU) and Terminal Count Down
Decade and 4-Bit Binary Synchronous UP / DOWN (Revers- (TCD) outputs are normally HIGH. When a circuit has reached
able) Counters. The operating modes of the LS192 decade the maximum count state (9 for the LS192, 15 for the LS193),
counter and the LS193 binary counter are identical, with the the next HIGH-to-LOW transition of the Count Up Clock will
only difference being the count sequences as noted in the cause TCU to go LOW. TCU will stay LOW until CPU goes
State Diagrams. Each circuit contains four master/slave HIGH again, thus effectively repeating the Count Up Clock,
flip-flops, with internal gating and steering logic to provide but delayed by two gate delays. Similarly, the TCD output will
master reset, individual preset, count up and count down go LOW when the circuit is in the zero state and the Count
operations. Down Clock goes LOW. Since the TC outputs repeat the clock
Each flip-flop contains JK feedback from slave to master waveforms, they can be used as the clock input signals to the
such that a LOW-to-HIGH transition on its T input causes the next higher order circuit in a multistage counter.
slave, and thus the Q output to change state. Synchronous Each circuit has an asynchronous parallel load capability
switching, as opposed to ripple counting, is achieved by permitting the counter to be preset. When the Parallel Load
driving the steering gates of all stages from a common Count (PL) and the Master Reset (MR) inputs are LOW, information
Up line and a common Count Down line, thereby causing all present on the Parallel Data inputs (P0, P3) is loaded into the
state changes to be initiated simultaneously. A LOW-to-HIGH counter and appears on the outputs regardless of the
transition on the Count Up input will advance the count by one; conditions of the clock inputs. A HIGH signal on the Master
a similar transition on the Count Down input will decrease the Reset input will disable the preset gates, override both Clock
count by one. While counting with one clock input, the other inputs, and latch each Q output in the LOW state. If one of the
should be held HIGH. Otherwise, the circuit will either count by Clock inputs is LOW during and after a reset or load operation,
twos or not at all, depending on the state of the first flip-flop, the next LOW-to-HIGH transition of that Clock will be
which cannot toggle as long as either Clock input is LOW. interpreted as a legitimate signal and will be counted.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH 24 40
PL to Q ns
tPHL 25 40
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) is defined as the minimum time required for tion. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to the level may be released prior to the PL transition from
PL transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recognized and LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) is defined as the minimum time following the required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
PL transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level must be transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to recognize and
maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recogni- transfer HIGH data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
tW
CPU or CPD 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH
tPHL
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1
NOTE: PL = LOW
Figure 2 Figure 3
Pn 1.3 V
PL 1.3 V
tw
tW trec
PL 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL CPU or CPD 1.3 V
tPHL
1.3 V
Qn
Q 1.3 V
Figure 4 Figure 5
Pn 1.3 V 1.3 V
th(H) th(L)
ts(H) ts(L) MR 1.3 V
PL 1.3 V
tW trec
Figure 6 Figure 7
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MR DSR P0 P1 P2 P3 DSL GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
S0, S1 Mode Control Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
P0 – P3 Parallel Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
DSR Serial (Shift Right) Data Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
DSL Serial (Shift Left) Data Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
CP Clock (Active HIGH Going Edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
MR Master Reset (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Q0 – Q3 Parallel Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
NOTES:
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
10 3 4 5 6
S1
9
S0
2 7
DSR DSL
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS S Q0 S Q1 S Q2 S Q3
CP CP CP CP
R R R R
CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR CLEAR
11
CP
1
MR
15 14 13 12
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The Logic Diagram and Truth Table indicate the functional Q3 outputs respectively following the next LOW to HIGH
characteristics of the LS194A 4-Bit Bidirectional Shift Regis- transition of the clock.
ter. The LS194A is similar in operation to the Motorola LS195A The asynchronous Master Reset (MR), when LOW, over-
Universal Shift Register when used in serial or parallel data rides all other input conditions and forces the Q outputs LOW.
register transfers. Some of the common features of the two Special logic features of the LS194A design which increase
devices are described below: the range of application are described below:
All data and mode control inputs are edge-triggered, Two mode control inputs (S0, S1) determine the synchro-
responding only to the LOW to HIGH transition of the Clock nous operation of the device. As shown in the Mode Selection
(CP). The only timing restriction, therefore, is that the mode Table, data can be entered and shifted from left to right (shift
control and selected data inputs must be stable one set-up right, Q0 → Q1, etc.) or right to left (shift left, Q3 → Q2, etc.), or
time prior to the positive transition of the clock pulse. parallel data can be entered loading all four bits of the register
The register is fully synchronous, with all operations taking simultaneously. When both S0 and S1,are LOW, the existing
place in less than 15 ns (typical) making the device especially data is retained in a “do nothing” mode without restricting the
useful for implementing very high speed CPUs, or the memory HIGH to LOW clock transition.
buffer registers. D-type serial data inputs (DSR, DSL) are provided on both
The four parallel data inputs (P0, P1, P2, P3) are D-type the first and last stages to allow multistage shift right or shift left
inputs. When both S0 and S1 are HIGH, the data appearing on data transfers without interfering with parallel load operation.
P0, P1, P2, and P3 inputs is transferred to the Q0, Q1, Q2, and
MODE SELECT — TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
OPERATING MODE
MR S1 S0 DSR DSL Pn Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
Reset L X X X X X L L L L
Hold H I I X X X q0 q1 q2 q3
Shift Left H h I X I X q1 q2 q3 L
H h I X h X q1 q2 q3 H
Shift Right H I h I X X L q0 q1 q2
H I h h X X H q0 q1 q2
Parallel Load H h h X X Pn P0 P1 P2 P3
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
I = LOW voltage level one set-up time prior to the LOW to HIGH clock transition
h = HIGH voltage level one set-up time prior to the LOW to HIGH clock transition
pn (qn) = Lower case letters indicate the state of the referenced input (or output) one set-up time prior to the LOW to HIGH clock transition.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME(ts) —is defined as the minimum time required recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
to the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be LOW to HIGH and still be recognized.
recognized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must transition from LOW to HIGH in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
1/fmax
S0
1.3 V 1.3 V (––– IS SHIFT LEFT)
CLOCK
tW S1
tPHL tPLH
OUTPUT
1.3 V 1.3 V DSR DSL 1.3 V
ts(L) ts(H)
OTHER CONDITIONS: S1 = L, MR = H, S0 = H th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
P0 P1 P2 P3
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays Clock Pulse ts(L) ts(H)
Width and fmax th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
1.3 V 1.3 V
CLOCK
OUTPUT*
MR OTHER CONDITIONS: MR = H
1.3 V
OTHER CONDITIONS: *DSR SET-UP TIME AFFECTS Q0 ONLY
OTHER CONDITIONS: DSL SET-UP TIME AFFECTS Q3 ONLY
tW trec
1.3 V Figure 3. Setup (ts) and Hold (th) Time for Serial Data
CLOCK (DSR, DSL) and Parallel Data (P0, P1, P2, P3)
tPHL
OUTPUT
1.3 V (STABLE TIME)
S0 S1 1.3 V
OTHER CONDITIONS: S0, S1 = H ts ts
OTHER CONDITIONS: PO = P1 = P2 = P3 = H
th = 0 th = 0
Figure 2. Master Reset Pulse Width, Master Reset CLOCK 1.3 V 1.3 V
to Output Delay and Master Reset to Clock
Recovery Time OTHER CONDITIONS: MR = H
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 16
1
VCC Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q3 CP PE
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
The Flatpak version N SUFFIX
has the same pinouts PLASTIC
(Connection Diagram) as CASE 648-08
16
the Dual In-Line Package.
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MR J K P0 P1 P2 P3 GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
PE Parallel Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
P0 – P3 Parallel Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
J First Stage J (Active HIGH) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. SN74LSXXXN Plastic
K First Stage K (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. SN74LSXXXD SOIC
CP Clock (Active HIGH Going Edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
MR Master Reset (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Q 0 – Q3 Parallel Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
Q3 Complementary Last Stage Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
NOTES: 9 4 5 6 7
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b. The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74)
b. Temperature Ranges. PE P0 P1 P2 P3
2 J
10 CP Q3 11
3 K
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
1 15 14 13 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
PE J K P0 P1 P2 P3 MR CP
9 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 10
R CD Q0 R CD R CD R CD Q3
CP CP CP CP
S Q0 S Q0 S Q2 S Q3
VCC = PIN 16 15 14 13 12 11
GND = PIN 8
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q3
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The Logic Diagram and Truth Table indicate the functional pins together. When the PE input is LOW, the LS195A appears
characteristics of the LS195A 4-Bit Shift Register. The device as four common clocked D flip-flops. The data on the parallel
is useful in a wide variety of shifting, counting and storage inputs P0, P1, P2, P3 is transferred to the respective Q0, Q1,
applications. It performs serial, parallel, serial to parallel, or Q2, Q3 outputs following the LOW to HIGH clock transition.
parallel to serial data transfers at very high speeds. Shift left operations (Q3 → Q2) can be achieved by tying the Qn
The LS195A has two primary modes of operation, shift right Outputs to the Pn–1 inputs and holding the PE input LOW.
(Q0 → Q1) and parallel load which are controlled by the state of All serial and parallel data transfers are synchronous,
the Parallel Enable (PE) input. When the PE input is HIGH, occurring after each LOW to HIGH clock transition. Since the
serial data enters the first flip-flop Q0 via the J and K inputs and LS195A utilizes edge-triggering, there is no restriction on the
is shifted one bit in the direction Q0 → Q1 → Q2 → Q3 following activity of the J, K, Pn and PE inputs for logic operation —
each LOW to HIGH clock transition. The JK inputs provide the except for the set-up and release time requirements.
flexibility of the JK type input for special applications, and the A LOW on the asynchronous Master Reset (MR) input sets
simple D type input for general applications by tying the two all Q outputs LOW, independent of any other input condition.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME(ts) —is defined as the minimum time required recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
to the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be LOW to HIGH and still be recognized.
recognized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must transition from LOW to HIGH in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
tW
PE
1.3 V 1.3 V
CLOCK J&K 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH ts(L) ts(H)
OUTPUT th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
1.3 V 1.3 V P0 P1 P2 P3
ts(L) ts(H)
CONDITIONS: J = PE = MR = H th(L) = 0 th(H) = 0
K=L 1.3 V 1.3 V
CLOCK
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays and OUTPUT*
Clock Pulse Width
CONDITIONS: MR = H
*J AND K SET–UP TIME AFFECTS Q0 ONLY
Figure 3. Setup (ts) and Hold (th) Time for Serial Data
(J & K) and Parallel Data (P0, P1, P2, P3)
tW
MR
1.3 V 1.3 V
trec
1.3 V
CLOCK LOAD PARALLEL DATA LOAD SERIAL DATA
tPHL SHIFT RIGHT
OUTPUT 1.3 V
PE 1.3 V
1.3 V
ts(L) ts(H)
trel trel
CONDITIONS: PE = L
PO = P1 = P2 = P3 = H CLOCK 1.3 V 1.3 V
CONDITIONS: MR = H
*Q0 STATE WILL BE DETERMINED BY J AND K INPUTS .
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts ORDERING INFORMATION
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SN74LSXXXD SOIC
PL Q2 P2 P0 Q0 CP1 GND
LOGIC DIAGRAM
P0 P1 P2 P3
13 4 10 3 11
MR
PL
1
J SD Q J SD Q J SD Q J SD Q
8
CP0
K CD Q K CD Q K CD Q K CD Q
6
CP1
5 9 2 12
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
LS196
P0 P1 P2 P3
13 4 10 3 11
MR
PL
1
J SD Q J SD Q J SD Q J SD Q
8
CP0
K CD Q K CD Q K CD Q K CD Q
6
CP1
5 9 2 12
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
LS197
VCC = PIN 14
GND = PIN 7
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS196 and LS197 are asynchronously presettable de- significant output.
cade and binary ripple counters. The LS196 Decade Counter The LS196 Decade Counter can be connected up to oper-
is partitioned into divide-by-two and divide-by-five sections ate in two different count sequences, as indicated in the tables
while the LS197 is partitioned into divide-by-two and divide- of Figure 2. With the input frequency connected to CP0 and
by-eight sections, with all sections having a separate Clock in- with Q0 driving CP1, the circuit counts in the BCD (8, 4, 2, 1)
put. In the counting modes, state changes are initiated by the sequence. With the input frequency connected to CP1 and Q3
HIGH to LOW transition of the clock signals. State changes of driving CP0, Q0 becomes the low frequency output and has a
the Q outputs, however, do not occur simultaneously because 50% duty cycle waveform. Note that the maximum counting
of the internal ripple delays. When using external logic to de- rate is reduced in the latter (bi-quinary) configuration because
code the Q outputs, designers should bear in mind that the un- of the interstage gating delay within the divide-by-five section.
equal delays can lead to decoding spikes and thus a decoded The LS196 and LS197 have an asynchronous active LOW
signal should not be used as a clock or strobe. The CP0 input Master Reset input (MR) which overrides all other inputs and
serves the Q0 flip-flop in both circuit types while the CP1 input forces all outputs LOW. The counters are also asynchronously
serves the divide-by-five or divide-by-eight section. The Q0 presettable. A LOW on the Parallel Load input (PL) overrides
output is designed and specified to drive the rated fan-out plus the clock inputs and loads the data from Parallel Data (P0 – P3)
the CP1 input. With the input frequency connected to CP0 and inputs into the flip-flops. While PL is LOW, the counters act as
Q0 driving CP1, the LS197 forms a straightforward module-16 transparent latches and any change in the Pn inputs will be re-
counter, with Q0 the least significant output and Q3 the most flected in the outputs.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH 20 30 18 27
Data to Output ns
tPHL 29 44 29 44
tPLH PL Input to 27 41 26 39
ns
tPHL Any Output 30 45 30 45
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to level may be released prior to the clock transition from HIGH to
the clock transition from HIGH to LOW in order to be recog- LOW and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from HIGH to LOW that the logic level must transition from HIGH to LOW in order to recognize and transfer
be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog- LOW Data to the Q outputs.
AC WAVEFORMS
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW(H)
tPLH
tPHL
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1
Pn 1.3 V 1.3 V Pn
tPHL tPLH tW
1.3 V PL 1.3 V
Qn
tPLH tPHL
Qn 1.3 V
NOTE: PL = LOW
Figure 2 Figure 3
CP 1.3 V
tPHL Qn* Q=P Q=P
Q 1.3 V
* The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted
* to change for predictable output performance
Figure 4 Figure 5
FUNCTION TABLE
(TOP VIEW)
(EACH MONOSTABLE)
1 Rext/ 1 2
INPUTS OUTPUTS
VCC Cext Cext 1Q 2Q CLR 2B 2A
CLEAR A B Q Q
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
L X X L H
Q VCC X H X L H
Q X X L L H
CLR Rext H L °
CLR
Q + H ± H
Q
*° L H
Cext R/C *See operational notes — Pulse Trigger Modes
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1A 1B 1 1Q 2Q 2 2 Rext/ GND TYPICAL MAXIMUM
CLR Cext Cext TYPE POWER OUTPUT PULSE
positive logic: Low input to clear resets Q low and DISSIPATION LENGTH
positive logic: Q high regardless of dc levels at A SN54LS221 23 mW 49 s
positive logic: or B inputs. SN74LS221 23 mW 70 s
OPERATIONAL NOTES
Once in the pulse trigger mode, the output pulse width is Clear Mode: If the clear input is held low, irregardless of
determined by tW = RextCextIn2, as long as Rext and Cext are the previous output state and other input
within their minimum and maximum valves and the duty cycle states, the Q output is low.
is less than 50%. This pulse width is essentially independent
of VCC and temperature variations. Output pulse widths varies Inhibit Mode: If either the A input is high or the B input is
typically no more than ±0.5% from device to device. low, once the Q output goes low, it cannot be
retriggered by other inputs.
If the duty cycle, defined as being 100 • tW where T is the
input T Pulse Trigger
period of the input pulse, rises above 50%, the output pulse
Mode: A transition of the A or B inputs as indicated
width will become shorter. If the duty cycle varies between
in the functional truth table will trigger the Q
low and high valves, this causes the output pulse width to
output to go high for a duration determined
vary in length, or jitter. To reduce jitter to a minimum, Rext
by the tW equation described above; Q will
should be as large as possible. (Jitter is independent of Cext).
go low for a corresponding length of time.
With Rext = 100K, jitter is not appreciable until the duty cycle
approaches 90%. The Clear input may also be used to trigger
Although the LS221 is pin-for-pin compatible with the an output pulse, but special logic precondi-
LS123, it should be remembered that they are not functionally tioning on the A or B inputs must be done as
identical. The LS123 is retriggerable so that the output is follows:
dependent upon the input transitions once it is high. This is not
Following any output triggering action
the case for the LS221. Also note that it is recommended to
using the A or B inputs, the A input must
externally ground the LS123 Cext pin. However, this cannot be
be set high OR the B input must be set
done on the LS221.
low to allow Clear to be used as a trigger.
The SN54LS/74LS221 is a dual, monolithic, non-retrigger-
Inputs should then be set up per the truth
able, high-stability one shot. The output pulse width, tW can be
table (without triggering the output) to
varied over 9 decades of timing by proper selection of the
allow Clear to be used a trigger for the
external timing components, Rext and Cext.
output pulse.
Pulse triggering occurs at a voltage level and is, therefore,
independent of the input slew rate. Although all three inputs If the Clear pin is routinely being used to
have this Schmitt-trigger effect, only the B input should be trigger the output pulse, the A or B inputs
used for very long transition triggers (≥1.0 µV/s). High must be toggled as described above
immunity to VCC noise (typically 1.5 V) is achieved by internal before and between each Clear trigger
latching circuitry. However, standard VCC bypassing is event.
strongly recommended.
The LS221 has four basic modes of operation. Once triggered, as long as the output
remains high, all input transitions (except
overriding Clear) are ignored.
Overriding
Clear Mode: If the Q output is high, it may be forced low
by bringing the clear input low.
Negative-Going
g g Threshold 54 0.7 0.8 V
VT
T– VCC = MIN
Voltage at C Input 74 0.7 0.8 V
Positive-Going Threshold
VT+ 1.0 2.0 V VCC = MIN
Voltage at B Input
Negative-Going
g g Threshold 54 0.7 0.9 V
VT
T– VCC = MIN
Voltage at B Input 74 0.8 0.9 V
Guaranteed Input HIGH Voltage for
VIH Input HIGH Voltage 2.0 V
A Input
54 0.7 Guaranteed Input LOW Voltage
g for
VIL Input LOW Voltage V
74 0.8 A Input
AC WAVEFORMS
tW(in)
B INPUT 3V
1.3 V
0V
≥60 ns
3V
CLEAR
0V
tPLH tPHL
VOH
Q OUTPUT
VOL
tPHL tPLH
VOH
Q OUTPUT
VOL
A INPUT IS LOW.
TRIGGER FROM B, THEN CLEAR — CONDITION 1
3V
B INPUT
0V
≥ 60 ns
3V
1.3 V
CLEAR 0V
VOH
Q OUTPUT
VOL
A INPUT IS LOW.
TRIGGER FROM B, THEN CLEAR — CONDITION 2
3V
B INPUT
ts 0V
≥ 50 ns ≥0
3V
CLEAR
0V
TRIGGERED
VOH
Q OUTPUT
VOL
NOT TRIGGERED tW(out)
A INPUT IS LOW.
CLEAR OVERRIDING B, THEN TRIGGER FROM B
3V
B INPUT
0V
≥ 50 ns ≥ 50 ns
3V
CLEAR 1.3 V
0V
VOH
Q OUTPUT
VOL
A INPUT IS LOW.
TRIGGERING FROM POSITIVE TRANSITION OF CLEAR
Figure 1
J SUFFIX
SN54 / 74LS240 CERAMIC
VCC 2G 1Y1 2A4 1Y2 2A3 1Y3 2A2 1Y4 2A1 CASE 732-03
20
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1G 1A1 2Y4 1A2 2Y3 1A3 2Y2 1A4 2Y1 GND
DW SUFFIX
SN54 / 74LS241 SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
VCC 2G 1Y1 2A4 1Y2 2A3 1Y3 2A2 1Y4 2A1 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1G 1A1 2Y4 1A2 2Y3 1A3 2Y2 1A4 2Y1 GND
SN54 / 74LS244
VCC 2G 1Y1 2A4 1Y2 2A3 1Y3 2A2 1Y4 2A1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1G 1A1 2Y4 1A2 2Y3 1A3 2Y2 1A4 2Y1 GND
TRUTH TABLES
SN54 / 74LS241
INPUTS INPUTS
OUTPUT OUTPUT
1G D 2G D
L L L H L L
L H H H H H
H X (Z) L X (Z)
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
Z = HIGH Impedance
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 SW1
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST
Figure 2
VE
1.3 V 1.3 V SWITCH POSITIONS
VE
tPZL tPLZ SYMBOL SW1 SW2
VOUT 1.3 V ≈ 1.3 V tPZH Open Closed
VOL
0.5 V tPZL Closed Open
Figure 5
VE
1.3 V 1.3 V
VE
tPZH tPHZ
≥VOH
VOUT 1.3 V ≈ 1.3 V
0.5 V
Figure 4
SN54 / 74LS242
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CASE 646-06
14
GBA NC 1A 2A 3A 4A GND NOTE:
1
The Flatpak version
SN54 / 74LS243 has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
VCC GBA NC 1B 2B 3B 4B the Dual In-Line Package. D SUFFIX
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
GBA NC 1A 2A 3A 4A GND
TRUTH TABLES
SN54 / 74LS242 SN54/74LS243
INPUTS INPUTS INPUTS INPUTS
OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT
GAB D GAB D GAB D GAB D
L L H L X (Z) L L L L X (Z)
L H L H L H L H H H L H
H X (Z) H H L H X (Z) H H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
Z = HIGH Impedance
AC WAVEFORMS
tPLH tPHL
RL
VOUT 1.3 V 1.3 V
SW1
Figure 1
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST
Figure 2
VE
1.3 V 1.3 V
VE
tPZL tPLZ SWITCH POSITIONS
Figure 4
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1
DIR A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 GND
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
TRUTH TABLE 20
CASE 751D-03
1
INPUTS
OUTPUT
E DIR
L L Bus B Data to Bus A
ORDERING INFORMATION
L H Bus A Data to Bus B
H X Isolation SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
H = HIGH Voltage Level
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
L = LOW Voltage Level SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
X = Immaterial
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
a
f g b
e c
d
SEGMENT
IDENTIFICATION
SN54 / 74LS248
SN54 / 74LS247 SN54 / 74LS259
(TOP VIEW) (TOP VIEW)
OUTPUTS OUTPUTS
VCC f g a b c d e VCC f g a b c d e
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
f g a b c d e f g a b c d e
BI/ BI/
B C LT RBORBI D A B C LT RBORBI D A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B C LAMP RB RB D A GND B C LAMP RB RB D A GND
TEST OUT IN TEST OUT IN
INPUTS PUT PUT INPUTS INPUTS PUT PUT INPUTS
LOGIC DIAGRAM
(13)
OUTPUT (13)
a OUTPUT
INPUT (7) a
INPUT (7)
A
A
(12)
INPUT (1) OUTPUT (12)
b INPUT (1) OUTPUT
B b
B
INPUT (2) (11)
OUTPUT INPUT (2) (11)
C OUTPUT
c C c
INPUT (6)
(10) INPUT (6)
D OUTPUT (10)
D OUTPUT
d
d
BI/RBO
BLANKING (4) (9)
OUTPUT BLANKING (4) (9)
INPUT OR e INPUT OR OUTPUT
RIPPLE-BLANKING RIPPLE-BLANKING e
OUTPUT OUTPUT
(15)
OUTPUT (15)
OUTPUT
(3) f
LAMP TEST (3) f
INPUT LAMP TEST
(14) INPUT
RBI (5) OUTPUT (14)
OUTPUT
RIPPLE-BLANKING g RIPPLE-BLANKING (5) g
INPUT INPUT
LS247
FUNCTION TABLE
DECIMAL INPUTS OUTPUTS
OR BI/RBO NOTE
FUNCTION LT RBI D C B A a b c d e f g
0 H H L L L L H ON ON ON ON ON ON OFF
1 H X L L L H H OFF ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF
2 H X L L H L H ON ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
3 H X L L H H H ON ON ON ON OFF OFF ON
4 H X L H L L H OFF ON ON OFF OFF ON ON
5 H X L H L H H ON OFF ON ON OFF ON ON
6 H X L H H L H ON OFF ON ON ON ON ON
7 H X L H H H H ON ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF 1
8 H X H L L L H ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
9 H X H L L H H ON ON ON ON OFF ON ON
10 H X H L H L H OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF ON
11 H X H L H H H OFF OFF ON ON OFF OFF ON
12 H X H H L L H OFF ON OFF OFF OFF ON ON
13 H X H H L H H ON OFF OFF ON OFF ON ON
14 H X H H H L H OFF OFF OFF ON ON ON ON
15 H X H H H H H OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
BI X X X X X X L OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 2
RBI H L L L L L L OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 3
LT L X X X X X H ON ON ON ON ON ON ON 4
LS248, LS249
FUNCTION TABLE
DECIMAL INPUTS OUTPUTS
OR BI/RBO NOTE
FUNCTION LT RBI D C B A a b c d e f g
0 H H L L L L H H H H H H H L 1
1 H X L L L H H L H H L L L L 1
2 H X L L H L H H H L H H L H
3 H X L L H H H H H H H L L H
4 H X L H L L H L H H L L H H
5 H X L H L H H H L H H L H H
6 H X L H H L H H L H H H H H
7 H X L H H H H H H H L L L L 1
8 H X H L L L H H H H H H H H
9 H X H L L H H H H H H L H H
10 H X H L H L H L L L H H L H
11 H X H L H H H L L H H L L H
12 H X H H L L H L H L L L H H
13 H X H H L H H H L L H L H H
14 H X H H H L H L L L H H H H
15 H X H H H H H L L L L L L L
BI X X X X X X L L L L L L L L 2
RBI H L L L L L L L L L L L L L 3
LT L X X X X X H H H H H H H H 4
H = HIGH Level, L = LOW Level, X = Irrelevant
NOTES: 1. The blanking input (BI) must be open or held at a high logic level when output functions 0 through 15 are desired. The ripple-blanking input (RBI) must
NOTES: 1. be open or high if blanking of a decimal zero is not desired.
2. When a low logic level is applied directly to the blanking input (BI), all segment outputs are off regardless of the level of any other input.
3. When ripple-blanking input (RBI) and inputs A, B, C, and D are at a low level with the lamp test input high, all segment outputs go off and the
NOTES: 1. ripple-blanking output (RBO) goes to a low level (response condition).
4. When the blanking input/ripple blanking output (BI/RBO) is open or held high and a low is applied to the lamp-test input, all segment outputs are on.
BI/RBO is wire-AND logic serving as blanking input (BI) and/or ripple-blanking output (RBO).
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
I3 I2 I1 I0 Z Z E0 GND
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) CASE 751B-03
1
HIGH LOW
S0–S2 Select Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
E0 Output Enable (Active LOW) Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
I0–I7 Multiplexer Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
ORDERING INFORMATION
Z Multiplexer Output 65 U.L. 15 U.L.
Z Complementary Multiplexer Output 65 U.L. 15 U.L. SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
NOTES: SN74LSXXXN Plastic
a. 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAM I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7
9 4 3 2 1 15 14 13 12
S2
10
S1
11
S0
7
E1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS 5 6
Z Z
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS251 is a logical implementation of a single pole, When the Output Enable is HIGH, both outputs are in the
8-position switch with the switch position controlled by the high impedance (high Z) state. This feature allows multiplexer
state of three Select inputs, S0, S1, S2. Both assertion and expansion by tying the outputs of up to 128 devices together.
negation outputs are provided. The Output Enable input (EO) When the outputs of the 3-state devices are tied together, all
is active LOW. When it is activated, the logic function provided but one device must be in the high impedance state to avoid
at the output is: high currents that would exceed the maximum ratings. The
Z = EO ⋅ (I0 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I1 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I2 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ Output Enable signals should be designed to ensure there is
Z = EO ⋅ S2 + I3 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1⋅ S2 + I4 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I5 ⋅ S0 ⋅ no overlap in the active LOW portion of the enable voltage.
Z = EO ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I6 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2 + I7 ⋅ S0 ⋅ S1 ⋅ S2).
TRUTH TABLE
E0 S2 S1 S0 I0 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 Z Z
H X X X X X X X X X X X (Z) (Z)
L L L L L X X X X X X X H L
L L L L H X X X X X X X L H
L L L H X L X X X X X X H L
L L L H X H X X X X X X L H
L L H L X X L X X X X X H L
L L H L X X H X X X X X L H
L L H H X X X L X X X X H L
L L H H X X X H X X X X L H
L H L L X X X X L X X X H L
L H L L X X X X H X X X L H
L H L H X X X X X L X X H L
L H L H X X X X X H X X L H
L H H L X X X X X X L X H L
L H H L X X X X X X H X L H
L H H H X X X X X X X L H L
L H H H X X X X X X X H L H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
(Z) = High impedance (Off)
3-STATE AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VE
1.3 V 1.3 V VE 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPZL tPLZ tPZH tPHZ
≥ VOH
VOUT
1.3 V ≈ 1.3 V VOUT 1.3 V ≈ 1.3 V
VOL 0.5 V
0.5 V
Figure 3 Figure 4
0.5 V
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
SWITCH POSITIONS
RL
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
tPZH Open Closed
SW1
tPZL Closed Open
tPLZ Closed Closed
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPHZ Closed Closed
5 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 D SUFFIX
SOIC
E0a S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND 16
1 CASE 751B-03
7 9
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
E0b I3b I2b I1b I0b S0 S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a E0a
15 13 12 11 10 14 2 3 4 5 6 1
VCC = PIN 16
Zb 9 GND = PIN 8 Za 7
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS253 contains two identical 4-Input Multiplexers with If the outputs of 3-state devices are tied together, all but one
3-state outputs. They select two bits from four sources device must be in the high impedance state to avoid high
selected by common select inputs (S0, S1). The 4-input currents that would exceed the maximum ratings. Designers
multiplexers have individual Output Enable (E0a, E0b) inputs should ensure that Output Enable signals to 3-state devices
which when HIGH, forces the outputs to a high impedance whose outputs are tied together are designed so that there is
(high Z) state. no overlap.
The LS253 is the logic implementation of a 2-pole,
4-position switch, where the position of the switch is deter-
mined by the logic levels supplied to the two select inputs. The
logic equations for the outputs are shown below:
Za = E0a ⋅ (I0a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I1a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 ⋅ I2a ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I3a ⋅ S1
⋅ S0)
Zb = E0b ⋅ (I0b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I1b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 ⋅ I2b ⋅ S1 ⋅ S0 + I3b ⋅ S1
⋅ S0)
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT OUTPUT
DATA INPUTS OUTPUT
INPUTS ENABLE
S0 S1 I0 I1 I2 I3 E0 Z
X X X X X X H (Z)
L L L X X X L L
L L H X X X L H
H L X L X X L L
H L X H X X L H
L H X X L X L L
L H X X H X L H
H H X X X L L L
H H X X X H L H
H = HIGH Level
L = LOW Level
X = Irrelevant
(Z) = High Impedance (off)
Address inputs S0 and S1 are common to both sections.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
E Da A0 A1 CL Db
14 3 1 2 15 13
4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12
Q0a Q1a Q2a Q3a Q0b Q1b Q2b Q3b
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
TRUTH TABLE
CL E D A0 A1 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 MODE
L H X X X L L L L Clear
L L L L L L L L L Demultiplex
L L H L L H L L L
L L L H L L L L L
L L H H L L H L L
L L L L H L L L L
L L H L H L L H L
L L L H H L L L L
L L H H H L L L H
H H X X X QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 Memory
H L L L L L QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 Addressable
H L H L L H QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 Latch
H L L H L QN–1 L QN–1 QN–1
H L H H L QN–1 H QN–1 QN–1
H L L L H QN–1 QN–1 L QN–1
H L H L H QN–1 QN–1 H QN–1
H L L H H QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 L
H L H H H QN–1 QN–1 QN–1 H
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
MODE SELECTION
E CL MODE
L H Addressable Latch
H H Memory
L L Dual 4-Channel Demultiplexer
H L Clear
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 2.4 3.5 V
or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
D 1.3 V 1.3 V
D
tpw tpw tPHL tPLH
E 1.3 V Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH
Q 1.3 V OTHER CONDITIONS: E = L, CL = H, A = STABLE
A1 1.3 V 1.3 V D
th(H) th(L)
ts(H) ts(L)
1.3 V 1.3 V E 1.3 V
A1
tPHL tPLH
Q1 1.3 V 1.3 V Q=D Q=D
Q
Figure 3. Turn-on and Turn-off Delays, Figure 4. Setup and Hold Time, Data to Enable
Address to Output
tPHL ts
th
Q 1.3 V E 1.3 V
OTHER CONDITIONS: E = H
OTHER CONDITIONS: CL = H
Figure 5. Turn-on Delay, Clear to Output
Figure 6. Setup Time, Address to Enable
(See Notes 1 and 2)
NOTES:
1. The Address to Enable Setup Time is the time before the HIGH-to-LOW Enable transition that the Address must be stable so that the correct latch is
addressed and the other latches are not affected.
2. The shaded areas indicate when the inputs are permitted to change for predictable output performance.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
VCC E0 I0c I1c Zc I0d I1d Zd
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
SN54/74LS258B
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S I0a I1a Za I0b I1b Zb GND
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
SN54 / 74LS257B
E0 I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d S
15 2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10 1
4 7 12 9
Za Zb Zc Zd
SN54 / 74LS258B
E0 I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d S
15 2 3 5 6 14 13 11 10 1
VCC = PIN 16 4 7 12 9
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS Za Zb Zc Zd
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS257B and LS258B are Quad 2-Input Multiplexers When the Output Enable Input (E0) is HIGH, the outputs are
with 3-state outputs. They select four bits of data from two forced to a high impedance “off” state. If the outputs are tied
sources each under control of a Common Data Select Input. together, all but one device must be in the high impedance
When the Select Input is LOW, the I0 inputs are selected and state to avoid high currents that would exceed the maximum
when Select is HIGH, the I1 inputs are selected. The data on ratings. Designers should ensure that Output Enable signals
the selected inputs appears at the outputs in true (non- to 3-state devices whose outputs are tied together are
inverted) form for the LS257B and in the inverted form for the designed so there is no overlap.
LS258B.
The LS257B and LS258B are the logic implementation of a
4-pole, 2-position switch where the position of the switch is
determined by the logic levels supplied to the Select Input. The
logic equations for the outputs are shown below:
LS257B LS258B
Za = E0 • (I1a • S + I0a • S) Zb = E0 • (I1b • S + I0b • S) Za = E0 • (I1a • S + I0a • S) Zb = E0 • (I1b • S + I0b • S)
Zc = E0 • (I1c • S + I0c • S) Zd = E0 • (I1d • S + I0d • S) Zc = E0 • (I1c • S + I0c • S) Zd = E0 • (I1d • S + I0d • S)
TRUTH TABLE
OUTPUT SELECT DATA OUTPUTS OUTPUTS
ENABLE INPUT INPUTS LS257B LS258B
EO S I0 I1 Z Z
H X X X (Z) (Z)
L H X L L H
L H X H H L
L L L X L H
L L H X H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
(Z) = High Impedance (off)
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
LS257B 19
Total, Output 3-State mA
LS258B 16
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 D SUFFIX
Ao A1 A2 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial
(74) Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
E D A0 A1 A2 C VCC = PIN 16
14 13 1 2 3 15 GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS259 has four modes of operation as shown addressed output will follow the state of the D input with all
in the mode selection table. In the addressable latch mode, other inputs in the LOW state. In the clear mode all outputs are
data on the Data line (D) is written into the addressed LOW and unaffected by the address and data inputs.
latch.The addressed latch will follow the data input with all When operating the SN54 / 74LS259 as an addressable
non-addressed latches remaining in their previous states. In latch, changing more then one bit of the address could impose
the memory mode, all latches remain in their previous state a transient wrong address. Therefore, this should only be
and are unaffected by the Data or Address inputs. done while in the memory mode.
In the one-of-eight decoding or demultiplexing mode, the The truth table below summarizes the operations.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
D 1.3 V 1.3 V
D
tw tw tPHL tPLH
E 1.3 V Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH
Q 1.3 V OTHER CONDITIONS: E = L, C = H, A = STABLE
A1 1.3 V 1.3 V D
th(H) th(L)
ts(H) ts(L)
1.3 V 1.3 V E 1.3 V
A1
tPHL tPLH
Q1 1.3 V 1.3 V Q=D Q=D
Q
Figure 3. Turn-on and Turn-off Delays, Figure 4. Setup and Hold Time, Data to Enable
Address to Output
tPHL ts
Q 1.3 V E
OTHER CONDITIONS: E = H
NOTES:
1. The Address to Enable Setup Time is the time before the HIGH-to-LOW Enable transition that the Address must be stable so that the correct latch is
addressed and the other latches are not affected.
2. The shaded areas indicate when the inputs are permitted to change for predictable output performance.
VCC
DUAL 5-INPUT NOR GATE
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
J SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 CERAMIC
GND CASE 632-08
14
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
QUAD 2-INPUT
EXCLUSIVE NOR GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
* * J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
* * 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
* OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUTS N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
TRUTH TABLE
1
IN OUT
A B Z
L L H D SUFFIX
L H L SOIC
14
H L L 1 CASE 751A-02
H H H
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
VOH Output HIGH Voltage 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 N SUFFIX
MR Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q2 D2 D3 Q3 GND PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
1
HIGH LOW
CP Clock (Active HIGH Going Edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
D0 – D 7 Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. DW SUFFIX
MR Master Reset (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
Q0 – Q7 Register Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. 1
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial
(74) Temperature Ranges.
ORDERING INFORMATION
TRUTH TABLE SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
MR CP Dx Qx
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
L X X L
H H H
H L L
H = HIGH Logic Level
L = LOW Logic Level
X = Immaterial
LOGIC DIAGRAM 3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
11 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
1 CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q
MR
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
= PIN NUMBERS Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS273 is an 8-Bit Parallel Register with a independent of the other inputs. Information meeting the setup
common Clock and common Master Reset. and hold time requirements of the D inputs is transferred to the
When the MR input is LOW, the Q outputs are LOW, Q outputs on the LOW-to-HIGH transition of the clock input.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
1/f max tW
tW MR 1.3 V
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V trec
tPHL tPLH
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays, Clock Pulse Width, Figure 2. Master Reset to Output Delay, Master Reset
Frequency, Setup and Hold Times Data to Clock Pulse Width, and Master Reset Recovery Time
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to recognize and
must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued transfer HIGH data to the Q outputs.
VCC S1 R Q S1 S2 R Q
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 QUAD SET-RESET LATCH
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
R S1 S2 Q R S1 Q GND J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
TRUTH TABLE 16
1
INPUT OUTPUT
S1 S2 R (Q)
N SUFFIX
L L L h PLASTIC
L X H H 16 CASE 648-08
X L H H
1
H H L L
H H H No Change
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level D SUFFIX
X = Don’t Care SOIC
16
h = The output is HIGH as long as 1 CASE 751B-03
h = S1 or S2 is LOW. If all inputs go
h = HIGH simultaneously, the output
h = state is indeterminate; otherwise,
h = it follows the Truth Table
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
VCC F E D C B A
N SUFFIX
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
F E D C B
1
G A
∑ ∑
H I EVEN ODD
D SUFFIX
SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14
1 CASE 751A-02
G H NC I ∑ ∑ GND
INPUT EVEN ODD
INPUTS
OUTPUTS
ORDERING INFORMATION
FUNCTION TABLE SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
NUMBER OF INPUTS A OUTPUTS
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
THRU 1 THAT ARE HIGH ∑EVEN ∑ODD
0, 2, 4, 6, 8 H L
1, 3, 5, 7, 9 L H
H = HIGH Level, L = LOW Level
A (8)
(9)
B
C (10) (5) ∑
EVEN
(11)
D
(12)
E
(13)
F
(6) ∑
ODD
(1)
G
(2)
H
I (4)
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) 1 CASE 751B-03
HIGH LOW
A1 – A4 Operand A Inputs 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
B1–B4 Operand B Inputs 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
C0 Carry Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
∑1 – ∑4 Sum Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
C4 Carry Output (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
NOTES: SN74LSXXXD SOIC
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial
(74) Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC SYMBOL
5 3 14 12 6 2 15 11
A1 A2 A3 A4 B1 B2 B3 B4
7 C0 C4 9
∑1 ∑2 ∑3 ∑4
4 1 13 10
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
C0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4
7 5 6 3 2 14 15 12 11
C1 C2 C3
4 1 13 10 9
VCC = PIN 16 ∑1 ∑2 ∑3 ∑4 C4
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS283 adds two 4-bit binary words (A plus B) plus the Due to the symmetry of the binary add function the LS283
incoming carry. The binary sum appears on the sum outputs can be used with either all inputs and outputs active HIGH
(∑1 – ∑4) and outgoing carry (C4) outputs. (positive logic) or with all inputs and outputs active LOW
C0 + (A1 + B1) + 2(A2 + B2) + 4(A3 + B3) + 8(A4 + B4) = ∑1 + 2 ∑2 (negative logic). Note that with active HIGH inputs, Carry Input
+ 4 ∑3 + 8 ∑4 + 16C4 can not be left open, but must be held LOW when no carry in is
intended.
Where: (+) = plus
Example:
C0 A1 A2 A3 A4 B1 B2 B3 B4 ∑1 ∑2 ∑3 ∑4 C4
logic levels L L H L H H L L H H H L L H
Active HIGH 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 (10+9=19)
Active LOW 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 (carry+5+6=12)
Interchanging inputs of equal weight does not affect the operation, thus C0, A1, B1, can be arbitrarily assigned to pins 7, 5 or 3.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
C0 20 µA
MAX VIN = 2
VCC = MAX, 2.7
7V
Any A or B 40 µA
IIH Input HIGH Current
C0 0.1 mA
VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 7
7.0
0V
Any A or B 0.2 mA
C0 – 0.4 mA
IIL Input LOW Current VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 0
0.4
4V
Any A or B – 0.8 mA
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 – 100 mA VCC = MAX
Power Supply Current
ICC Total, Output HIGH 34 mA VCC = MAX
Total, Output LOW 39
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
AC WAVEFORMS
1.3 V 1.3 V
VIN VIN
tPHL tPLH tPLH tPHL
VOUT 1.3 V 1.3 V
VOUT
Figure 1 Figure 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
NC NC NC Q2 Q1 NC GND
LOGIC SYMBOL
LS290 LS293
1 3
1 2
MS
10 CP0 10 CP0
11 CP1 11 CP1
MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
1 2 1 2
12 13 9 5 4 8 12 13 9 5 4 8
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
1 LS290
MS1
MS2
3
SD SD
J Q J Q J Q R Q
10
CP0 CP CP CP CP
CD Q KC Q
D
KC Q
D
SC Q
D
11
CP1 VCC = PIN 14
12 GND = PIN 7
MR1 9 5 4 8 = PIN NUMBERS
MR2
13 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
LS293
J Q J Q J Q J Q
10
CP0 CP CP CP CP
K Q K Q K Q K Q
CD CD CD CD
11
CP1 VCC = PIN 14
12 GND = PIN 7
MR1 9 5 4 8 = PIN NUMBERS
MR2 13 Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS290 and LS293 are 4-bit ripple type Decade, and externally connected to the Q0 output. The CP0 input
4-Bit Binary counters respectively. Each device consists of receives the incoming count and a BCD count sequence is
four master / slave flip-flops which are internally connected to produced.
provide a divide-by-two section and a divide-by-five (LS290) B. Symmetrical Bi-quinary Divide-By-Ten Counter — The Q3
or divide-by-eight (LS293) section. Each section has a output must be externally connected to the CP0 input. The
separate clock input which initiates state changes of the input count is then applied to the CP1 input and a
counter on the HIGH-to-LOW clock transition. State changes divide-by-ten square wave is obtained at output Q0.
of the Q outputs do not occur simultaneously because of C. Divide-By-Two and Divide-By-Five Counter — No external
internal ripple delays. Therefore, decoded output signals are interconnections are required. The first flip-flop is used as a
subject to decoding spikes and should not be used for clocks binary element for the divide-by-two function (CP0 as the
or strobes. The Q0 output of each device is designed and input and Q0 as the output). The CP1 input is used to obtain
specified to drive the rated fan-out plus the CP1 input of the binary divide-by-five operation at the Q3 output.
device.
A gated AND asynchronous Master Reset (MR1 ⋅ MR2) is LS293
provided on both counters which overrides the clocks and
resets (clears) all the flip-flops. A gated AND asynchronous A. 4-Bit Ripple Counter — The output Q0 must be externally
Master Set (MS1 ⋅ MS2) is provided on the LS290 which connected to input CP1. The input count pulses are applied
overrides the clocks and the MR inputs and sets the outputs to to input CP0. Simultaneous division of 2, 4, 8, and 16 are
nine (HLLH). performed at the Q0, Q1, Q2, and Q3 outputs as shown in
Since the output from the divide-by-two section is not the truth table.
internally connected to the succeeding stages, the devices B. 3-Bit Ripple Counter — The input count pulses are applied
may be operated in various counting modes: to input CP1. Simultaneous frequency divisions of 2, 4, and
8 are available at the Q1, Q2, and Q3 outputs. Independent
LS290 use of the first flip-flop is available if the reset function
A. BCD Decade (8421) Counter — the CP1 input must be coincides with reset of the 3-bit ripple-through counter.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1
*The number of Clock Pulses required between the tPHL and tPLH measurements can be determined from the appropriate Truth Tables.
tW trec tW trec
CP 1.3 V CP 1.3 V
tPHL tPLH
Q0 ⋅ Q3
Q 1.3 V (LS290) 1.3 V
Figure 2 Figure 3
ORDERING INFORMATION
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
HIGH LOW SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
S Common Select Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
CP Clock (Active LOW Going Edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
I0a – I0d Data Inputs From Source 0 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
I1a – I1d Data Inputs From Source 1 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Qa – Qd Register Outputs (Note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. 3 2 4 1 9 5 7 6
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial
(74) Temperature Ranges.
I0a I1a I0b I1b I0c I1c I0d I1d
10 S
11 CP
Qa Qb Qc Qd
15 14 13 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
CP
11
R R R R
CP CP CP CP
S Qa S Qb S Qc S Qd
15 14 13 12
Qa Qb Qc Qd
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The LS298 is a high speed Quad 2-Port Register. It selects transition of the Clock input (CP). The 4-bit output register is
four bits of data from two sources (ports)under the control of a fully edge-triggered. The Data inputs (I) and Select input (S)
Common Select Input (S). The selected data is transferred to must be stable only one setup time prior to the HIGH to LOW
the 4-bit output register synchronous with the HIGH to LOW transition of the clock for predictable operation.
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUT
S I0 I1 Q
I I X L
I h X H
h X I L
h X h H
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level
X = Don’t Care
I = LOW Voltage Level one setup time prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition.
h = HIGH Voltage Level one setup time prior to the HIGH to LOW clock transition.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH Propagation
g Delay,
y 18 27 ns VCC = 5.0 V,
tPHL Clock to Output 21 32 ns CL = 15 pF
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required the clock transition from LOW to HIGH that the logic level must
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued recog-
the clock transition from LOW to HIGH in order to be recog- nition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct logic
nized and transferred to the outputs. level may be released prior to the clock transition from LOW to
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following HIGH and still be recognized.
AC WAVEFORMS
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V Q Q = I0 Q = I1
Figure 1 Figure 2
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
CONNECTION DIAGRAM DIP (TOP VIEW) 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
S0 OE1 OE2 I/O6 I/O4 I/O2 I/O0 Q0 MR GND
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial (74) Temperature Ranges.
c) The Output LOW drive factor is 7.5 U.L for Military (54) and 15 U.L. for Commercial (74). The Output HIGH drive factor is 25 U.L. for Military (54) and 65 U.L. for
Commercial (74) Temperature Ranges.
LOGIC DIAGRAM
S1 19 S0 1
18
DS7
DS0
11
12
CLOCK
D CK D CK D CK D CK D CK D CK D CK D CK
CLR CLR CLR CLR CLR CLR CLR CLR 17
8 Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
Q0
Q7
MR
9
2
OE1 VCC = PIN 20
OE2 GND = PIN 10
3 7 13 6 14 5 15 4 16
= PIN NUMBERS
I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS RESPONSE
MR S1 S0 OE1 OE2 CP DS0 DS7
L X X H X X X X
Asynchronous Reset;
Reset Q0 = Q7 = LOW
L X X X H X X X
I/O Voltage Undetermined
L H H X X X X X
L L X L L X X X Asynchronous Reset; Q0 = Q7 = LOW
L X L L L X X X I/O Voltage LOW
H L H X X D X Shift Right; D→Q0; Q0→Q1; etc.
H L H L L D X Shift Right; D→Q0 & I/O0; Q0→O1 & I/O1; etc.
H H L X X X D Shift Left; D→Q7; Q7→Q6; etc.
H H L L L X D Shift Left; D→Q7 & I/O7; Q7→Q6 & I/O6; etc.
H H H X X X X Parallel Load; I/On→Qn
H L L H X X X X
Hold: I/O Voltage undetermined
H L L X H X X X
H L L L L X X X Hold: I/On = Qn
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
tPHZ 10 15
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 10 15
3-STATE WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VE VE
1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V
VE VE
tPZL tPLZ tPZH tPHZ
≥ VOH
VOUT 1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V 1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V
VOL 0.5 V
VOUT
0.5 V
Figure 3 Figure 4
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
SWITCH POSITIONS
RL
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
5 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 5
G CK
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
BLOCK DIAGRAM
REGISTER
ENABLE (1)
G
(2)
S/P
SIGN
EXTEND (18)
SE
(17)
DATA D1
(19)
SELECT
DS (3)
D0
FOUR
IDENTICAL
CHANNELS
NOT (12)
Q Q SHOWN Q Q QH
CK CK CK CK
D Q D Q D Q D Q
CLR CLR CLR CLR
(11)
CLOCK
(9)
CLEAR
OUTPUT
ENABLE (8)
OE
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS INPUTS/OUTPUTS
OUTPUT
OPERATION REGISTER SIGN DATA OUTPUT
CLEAR S/P CLOCK A/QA B/QB C/QC … H/QH Q H′
ENABLE EXTEND SELECT ENABLE
Clear L H X X X L X L L L L L
L X H X X L X L L L L L
Hold H H X X X L X QA0 QB0 QC0 QH0 QH0
H L H H L L ↑ D0 QAn QBn QGn QGn
Shift Right
H L H H H L ↑ D1 QAn QBn QGn QGn
Sign Extend H L H L X L ↑ QAn QAn QBn QGn QGn
Load H L L X X X ↑ a b c h h
When the output enable is high, the eight input/output terminals are disabled to the high-impedance state; however, sequential operation or
clearing of the register is not affected. If both the register enable input and the S/P input are low while the clear input is low, the register is
cleared while the eight input/output terminals are disabled to the high-impedance state.
H = HIGH Level (steady state)
L = LOW Level (steady state)
X = Irrelevant (any input, including transitions)
↑ = Transition from LOW to HIGH level
QA0…QH0 = the level of QA through QH, respectively, before the indicated steady-state conditions were established
QAn…QHn = the level of QA through QH, respectively, before the most recent ↑ transition of the clock
D0, D1 = the level of steady-state inputs at inputs D0 and D1 respectively
a…h = the level of steady-state inputs at inputs A through H respectively
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
tPHZ 15 25
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 15 25
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
nized and transferred to the outputs.
RECOVERY TIME (trec) — is defined as the minimum time
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following required between the end of the reset pulse and the clock
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to recognize and
must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued transfer HIGH Data to the Q outputs.
S1 19 S0 1 LOGIC DIAGRAM
18
DS7
DS0 11
9
SR
12
CP
D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP
17
8 Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
Q0 Q7
2
OE1
OE2
3 7 13 6 14 5 15 4 16
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The logic diagram and truth table indicate the functional 2. When S0 = S1 = 1, I/O0–I/O7 are parallel inputs to flip-flops
characteristics of the SN54/74LS323 Universal Shift/Storage Q0–Q7 respectively, and the outputs of Q0–Q7 are in the
Register. This device is similar in operation to the high impedance state regardless of the state of OE1 or
SN54/74LS299 except for synchronous reset. A partial list of OE2.
the common features are described below:
An important unique feature of the SN54/74LS323 is a fully
1. They use eight D-type edge-triggered flip-flops that re- Synchronous Reset that requires only to be stable at least one
spond only to the LOW-to-HIGH transition of the Clock setup time prior to the positive transition of the Clock Pulse.
(CP). The only timing restriction, therefore, is that the mode
control (S0, S1) and data inputs (DS0, DS7, I/O0–I/O7) may
be stable at least a setup time prior to the positive transition
of the Clock Pulse.
TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS RESPONSE
SR S1 S0 OE1 OE2 CP DS0 DS7
L X X H X X X
Synchronous Reset;
Reset Q0 = Q7 = LOW
L X X X H X X
I/O voltage undetermined
L H H X X X X
L L X L L X X Synchronous Reset; Q0 = Q7 = LOW
L X L L L X X I/O voltage LOW
H L H X X D X Shift Right; D→Q0; Q0→Q1; etc.
H L H L L D X Shift Right; D→Q0 & I/O0; Q0→Q1 & I/O1; etc.
H H L X X X D Shift Left; D→Q7; Q7→Q6; etc.
H H L L L X D Shift Left; D→Q7 & I/O7; Q7→Q6 & I/O6; etc.
H H H X X X X Parallel Load I/On→Qn
H L L H X X X X
Hold; I/O Voltage Undetermined
Hold
H L L X H X X X
H L L L L X X X Hold; I/On = Qn
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
tPHZ 10 15
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 10 15
3-STATE WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VE VE
1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V
VE VE
tPZL tPLZ tPZH tPHZ
VOUT ≥ VOH
1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V 1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V
VOL 0.5 V
0.5 V VOUT
Figure 3 Figure 4
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
RL
SWITCH POSITIONS
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
SW1
tPZH Open Closed
5 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 5
EO GS 3 2 1 0
ORDERING INFORMATION
4 A0
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
5 6 7 EI A2 A1
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 7 EI A2 A1 GND
INPUTS OUTPUTS
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
EI 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 A2 A1 A0 GS EO
H X X X X X X X X Z Z Z H H
L H H H H H H H H Z Z Z H L H = HIGH Logic Level
L X X X X X X X L L L L L H L = LOW Logic Level
L X X X X X X L H L L H L H X = Irrelevant
Z = High Impedance State
L X X X X X L H H L H L L H
L X X X X L H H H L H H L H
L X X X L H H H H H L L L H
L X X L H H H H H H L H L H
L X L H H H H H H H H L L H
L L H H H H H H H H H H L H
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
(5) G1″
EI
(10)
(5) 0 G13 (15)
EI EO
(10) G29 (14)
0 (15) GS
EO G31 G30
(14)GS (11) G2′
(11) 1
1
G14
(12) (12) G3′ (9)
2 2 G15 A0
(9) G9′ G18
A0 G16
(13) (13) G4′
3 G17
3
(1)
4 (1) G5′ G10′ G19
4
(7) (7)
(2) A1 G20 A1
5 G6′ G11′
(2) G23
5 G21
(3) G22
6
(3) G7′ G12′
(4) 6
7 (6) G24
A2
(4) G8′ (6)
7 G25 A2
G26 G28
G27
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
Output HIGH Voltage
A0, A1, A2 54, 74 2.4 3.1 V
VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH
EO, GS 54 2.5 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
EO, GS 74 2.7 3.5 V
tPZH 25 39 25 39
EI A0 A1 or A2
A0, ns
tPZL 24 41 24 41
tPLH Out-of-Phase 11 18 11 18
0 thru 7 E0 ns
tPHL output 26 40 26 40
tPLH In-Phase 38 55 38 55
0 thru 7 GS ns
tPHL output 9.0 21 9.0 21 CL = 15 pF
tPLH In-Phase 11 17 11 17 RL = 2.0 Ω
EI GS ns
tPHL output 14 36 14 36
tPLH In-Phase 17 21 17 21
EI EO ns
tPHL output 25 40 30 45
tPHZ 18 27 18 27 CL = 5.0 pF
EI A0 A1 or A2
A0, ns
tPLZ 23 35 23 35 RL = 667 Ω
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 N SUFFIX
Ea S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a)
HIGH LOW
D SUFFIX
S0, S1 Common Select Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
SOIC
E Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. 16
1 CASE 751B-03
I0 – I1 Multiplexer Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
Z Multiplexer Outputs (note b) 10 U.L. 5 (2.5) U.L.
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 2.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 5 U.L. for Commercial ORDERING INFORMATION
(74) Temperature Ranges.
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
LOGIC DIAGRAM SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
Ea I0a I1a I2a I3a S1 S0 I0b I1b I2b I3b Eb
1 6 5 4 3 2 14 10 11 12 13 15
LOGIC SYMBOL
1 6 5 4 3 10 11 12 13 15
2 S1
Za Zb
7 9
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS352 is a Dual 4-Input Multiplexer. It selects can be used to strobe the outputs independently. When the
two bits of data from up to four sources under the control of the Enables (Ea, Eb) are HIGH, the corresponding outputs (Za, Zb)
common Select Inputs (S0, S1). The two 4-input multiplexer are forced HIGH.
circuits have individual active LOW Enables (Ea, Eb) which The logic equations for the outputs are shown below.
The SN54 / 74LS352 can be used to move data from a group erator. The SN54 / 74LS352 can generate two functions of
of registers to a common output bus. The particular register three variables. This is useful for implementing highly irregular
from which the data came would be determined by the state of random logic.
the Select Inputs. A less obvious application is a function gen-
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT INPUTS INPUTS (a or b) OUTPUT
S0 S1 E I0 I1 I2 I3 Z
X X H X X X X H
L L L L X X X H
L L L H X X X L
H L L X L X X H
H L L X H X X L
L H L X X L X H
L H L X X H X L
H H L X X X L H
H H L X X X H L
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
D SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SOIC
E0a S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a Za GND 16
1 CASE 751B-03
NOTES: E0a I0a I1a I2a I3a I0b I1b I2b I3b E0b
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW. 14 S0
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 7.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 15 U.L. for Commercial
2 S1
(74) Temperature Ranges. The Output HIGH drive factor is 25 U.L. for Military and 65 U.L. Za Zb
for Commercial Temperature Ranges.
7 9
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
E0b I3b I2b I1b I0b S0 S1 I3a I2a I1a I0a E0a
15 13 12 11 10 14 2 3 4 5 6 1
VCC = PIN 16
9 GND = PIN 8 7
Zb = PIN NUMBERS Za
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS353 contains two identical 4-input Multi- inputs which when HIGH, forces the outputs to a high
plexers with 3-state outputs. They select two bits from four impedance (high Z) state.
sources selected by common select inputs (S0, S1). The The logic equations for the outputs are shown below:
4-input multiplexers have individual Output Enable (E0a, E0b)
If the outputs of 3-state devices are tied together, all but one should ensure that Output Enable signals to 3-state devices
device must be in the high impedance state to avoid high whose outputs are tied together are designed so that there is
currents that would exceed the maximum ratings. Designers no overlap.
TRUTH TABLE
SELECT OUTPUT
DATA INPUTS OUTPUT
INPUTS ENABLE
S0 S1 I0 I1 I2 I3 E0 Z
X X X X X X H (Z)
L L L X X X L H
L L H X X X L L
H L X L X X L H
H L X H X X L L
L H X X L X L H
L H X X H X L L
H H X X X L L H
H H X X X H L L
H = HIGH Level
L = LOW Level
X = Immaterial
(Z) = High Impedance (off)
Address inputs S0 and S1 are common to both sections.
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
3-STATE WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
VE VE
1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V 1.5 V
VE VE
tPZL tPLZ tPZH tPHZ
≥ VOH
VOUT 1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V 1.5 V ≈ 1.5 V
VOL 0.5 V
0.5 V VOUT
Figure 3 Figure 4
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
SWITCH POSITIONS
RL
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
tPZH Open Closed
SW1
tPZL Closed Open
tPLZ Closed Closed
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPHZ Closed Closed
5.0 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 5
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 620-09
16
1
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
E1 GND E1 GND
TRUTH TABLE TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS INPUTS
OUTPUT OUTPUT
E1 E2 D E1 E2 D
L L L L L L L H
L L H H L L H L
H X X (Z) H X X (Z)
X H X (Z) X H X (Z)
VCC E VCC E
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
E GND E GND
TRUTH TABLE TRUTH TABLE
INPUTS INPUTS
OUTPUT OUTPUT
E D E D
L L L L L H
L H H L H L
H X (Z) H X (Z)
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPHZ 30 32
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 35 35
DW SUFFIX
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) SOIC
20
HIGH LOW CASE 751D-03
1
D0 – D 7 Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
LE Latch Enable (Active HIGH) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
CP Clock (Active HIGH going edge) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
OE Output Enable (Active LOW) Input 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. ORDERING INFORMATION
O0 – O7 Outputs (Note b) 65 (25) U.L. 15 (7.5) U.L.
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
NOTES:
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
a) 1 TTL Units Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 7.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 25 U.L. for Commercial
(74) Temperature Ranges. The Output HIGH drive factor is 25 U.L. for Military (54) and
65 U.L. for Commercial (74) Temperature Ranges.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 NOTE: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND The Flatpak version OE O0 D0 D1 O1 O2 D2 D3 O3 GND
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
TRUTH TABLE
LS373 LS374
Dn LE OE On Dn LE OE On
H H L H H L H
L H L L L L L
X L L Q0 X X H Z*
X X H Z*
H = HIGH Voltage Level
L = LOW Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
Z = High Impedance
* Note: Contents of flip-flops unaffected by the state of the Output Enable input (OE).
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
SN54LS / 74LS373 3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
VCC = PIN 20
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 GND = PIN 10
= PIN NUMBERS
D D D D D D D D
LATCH Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
ENABLE G G G G G G G G
11
LE
OE
1
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
SN54LS / 74LS374
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
11 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
OE
1 O0 O1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPZH 15 28 20 28
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 25 36 21 28
tPHZ 12 20 12 20
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 15 25 15 25
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to the LE transition from HIGH-to-LOW that the logic level must
LE transition from HIGH-to-LOW in order to be recognized and be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued
transferred to the outputs. recognition.
AC WAVEFORMS
tW tW
LE 1.3 V
ts th
Dn
tPLH tPHL
OUTPUT
Figure 1
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
SWITCH POSITIONS
RL
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
tPZH Open Closed
SW1
tPZL Closed Open
tPLZ Closed Closed
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPHZ Closed Closed
5.0 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 4
AC WAVEFORMS
tWH tWL
OE 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts th tPZL tPLZ
Figure 5
OE 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPZH tPHZ
≥ VOH
VOUT 1.3 V ≈ 1.3 V
0.5 V
Figure 7
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
SWITCH POSITIONS
RL
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
tPZH Open Closed
SW1
tPZL Closed Open
tPLZ Closed Closed
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPHZ Closed Closed
5.0 kΩ
CL* SW2
Figure 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N SUFFIX
D0 Q0 Q0 E0,1 Q1 Q1 D1 GND
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
TRUTH TABLE
(Each latch) NOTES:
tn = bit time before enable
tn tn+1 negative-going transition. D SUFFIX
tn+1 = bit time after enable SOIC
D Q 16
negative-going transition. CASE 751B-03
H H 1
L L
D0 D1 D2 D3
4 E0,1
LOGIC DIAGRAM
12 E2,3
DATA Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
Q
Q 2 3 6 5 10 11 14 13
ENABLE
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
D Input 20
µA VCC = MAX, VIN = 2.7 V
E Input 80
IIH Input HIGH Current
D Input 0.1
mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 7.0 V
E Input 0.4
D Input – 0.4
IIL Input LOW Current mA VCC = MAX, VIN = 0.4 V
E Input – 1.6
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 – 100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 12 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
tPLH 12 20
Propagation Delay, Data to Q ns
tPHL 7.0 15 VCC = 5.0 V
tPLH 15 27 CL = 15 pF
Propagation Delay, Enable to Q ns
tPHL 14 25
tPLH 16 30
Propagation Delay, Enable to Q ns
tPHL 7.0 15
LOGIC DIAGRAM
Q
ENABLE
TO OTHER LATCH
AC WAVEFORMS
D 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts th
E 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
nized and transferred to the outputs. logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
SN54 / 74LS377
VCC Q7 D7 D6 Q6 Q5 D5 D4 Q4 CP
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
E Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q2 D2 D3 Q3 GND
SN54 / 74LS378
VCC Q5 D5 D4 Q4 D3 Q3 CP
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
E Q0 D0 D1 Q1 D2 Q2 GND
SN54 / 74LS379
VCC Q3 Q3 D3 D2 Q2 Q2 CP
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
NOTE:
The Flatpak version
has the same pinouts
(Connection Diagram) as
the Dual In-Line Package.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
E Q0 Q0 D0 D1 Q1 Q1 GND
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
SN54 / 74LS377
3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
E
ENABLE
1
CP
CLOCK
11
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19
SN54 / 74LS378
3 4 6 11 13 14
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5
CP
9
CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D CP D
E E E E E E
Q Q Q Q Q Q
1
E
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5
2 5 7 10 12 15
SN54 / 74LS379 4 5 12 13
D0 D1 D2 D3
CP
9
CP D CP D CP D CP D
E E E E
Q Q Q Q Q Q Q Q
1
E
Q0 Q0 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q2 Q3 Q3
3 2 6 7 11 10 14 15
DEFINITION OF TERMS
SETUP TIME (ts) — is defined as the minimum time required the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- recognition. A negative HOLD TIME indicates that the correct
nized and transferred to the outputs. logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
HOLD TIME (th) — is defined as the minimum time following LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
TRUTH TABLE
E CP Dn Qn Qn
H X No No
Change Change
L H H L
L L L H
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
AC WAVEFORMS
1/fmax 1/fmax
tW tW
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts(H) ts(L) ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) th(L)
th(H) th(L)
D OR E * 1.3 V 1.3 V
E, D * 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
tPHL tPLH
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1. Clock to Output Delays Clock Pulse Figure 2. Clock to Output Delays Clock Pulse
Width, Frequency, Setup and Hold Times Data Width, Frequency, Setup and Hold Times Data
or Enable to Clock or Enable to Clock
SN54 / 74LS379
1/fmax
tW
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
ts(H) ts(L)
th(H) th(L)
E, D * 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPLH tPHL
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
QUAD 2-INPUT
EXCLUSIVE-OR GATE
LOW POWER SCHOTTKY
VCC
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
GND
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
14 CASE 646-06
1
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 632-08
14
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CP0 MR Q0 CP1 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND N SUFFIX
NOTE: PLASTIC
The Flatpak version 14 CASE 646-06
has the same pinouts
SN54 / 74LS393 (Connection Diagram) as 1
VCC CP MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 the Dual In-Line Package.
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
D SUFFIX
SOIC
14
1 CASE 751A-02
ORDERING INFORMATION
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
CP MR Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 GND SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
Each half of the SN54 / 74LS393 operates in the Modulo 16 section operates in 4.2.1 binary sequence, as shown in the ÷ 5
binary sequence, as indicated in the ÷ 16 Truth Table. The first Truth Table, with the third stage output exhibiting a 20% duty
flip-flop is triggered by HIGH-to-LOW transitions of the CP cycle when the input frequency is constant. To obtain a ÷10
input signal. Each of the other flip-flops is triggered by a function having a 50% duty cycle output, connect the input
HIGH-to-LOW transition of the Q output of the preceding signal to CP1 and connect the Q3 output to the CP0 input; the
flip-flop. Thus state changes of the Q outputs do not occur Q0 output provides the desired 50% duty cycle output. If the
simultaneously. This means that logic signals derived from input frequency is connected to CP0 and the Q0 output is
combinations of these outputs will be subject to decoding connected to CP1, a decade divider operating in the 8.4.2.1
spikes and, therefore, should not be used as clocks for other BCD code is obtained, as shown in the BCD Truth Table. Since
counters, registers or flip-flops. A HIGH signal on MR forces the flip-flops change state asynchronously, logic signals
all outputs to the LOW state and prevents counting. derived from combinations of LS390 outputs are also subject
Each half of the LS390 contains a ÷ 5 section that is to decoding spikes. A HIGH signal on MR forces all outputs
independent except for the common MR function. The ÷ 5 LOW and prevents counting.
CP0
K CP J K CP J K CP J K CP J
CD CD CD CD
Q Q Q Q
MR
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
K CP J K CP J K CP J K CP J
CD CD CD CD
Q Q Q Q
MR
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH 12 20
CP0 to Q0 LS390 ns
tPHL 13 20
tPLH 40 60
CP to Q3 LS393 ns
tPHL 40 60 CL = 15 pF
tPLH 37 60
CP0 to Q2 LS390 ns
tPHL 39 60
tPLH 13 21
CP1 to Q1 LS390 ns
tPHL 14 21
tPLH 24 39
CP1 to Q2 LS390 ns
tPHL 26 39
tPLH 13 21
CP1 to Q3 LS390 ns
tPHL 14 21
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1
MR & MS
1.3 V 1.3 V
tW trec
CP
1.3 V
tPHL
Q 1.3 V
Figure 2
*The number of Clock Pulses required between tPHL and tPLH measurements can be determined from the appropriate Truth Table.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 D SUFFIX
MR DS P0 P1 P2 P3 S GND SOIC
16
1 CASE 751B-03
S P0 P1 P2 P3
2 DS
10 CP Q3 11
9 OE
MR O0 O1 O2 O3
1 15 14 13 12
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
S P0 P1 P2 P3
Ds
CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D
CD Q CD Q CD Q CD Q
MR
OE
O0 O1 O2 O3 Q3
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
The SN74LS395 contains four D-type edge-triggered S input is LOW, a CP HIGH-LOW transition transfers data in
flip-flops and auxiliary gating to select a D input either from a Q0 to Q1, Q1 to Q2, and Q2 to Q3. A left-shift is accomplished
Parallel (Pn) input or from the preceding stage. When the by connecting the outputs back to the Pn inputs, but offset one
Select input is HIGH, the Pn inputs are enabled. A LOW signal place to the left, i.e., O3 to P2, O2 to P1 and O1 to P0, with P3
on the S input enables the serial inputs for shift-right opera- acting as the linking input from another package.
tions, as indicated in the Truth Table. When the OE input is HIGH, the output buffers are disabled
State changes are initiated by HIGH-to-LOW transitions on and the Q0 – Q3 outputs are in a high impedance condition.
the Clock Pulse (CP) input. Signals on the Pn, Ds and S inputs The shifting, parallel loading or resetting operations can still be
can change when the Clock is in either state, provided that the accomplished, however.
recommended set-up and hold times are observed. When the
tPZH 15 25
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 17 25
tPLZ 12 20
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPHZ 11 17
AC WAVEFORMS
The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
D * 1.3 V 1.3 V
LOAD SERIAL DATA
SHIFT RIGHT LOAD PARALLEL DATA
th(L) th(H)
ts(L) ts(H)
S 1.3 V 1.3 V
CP OR 1.3 V 1.3 V
MR th(L) th(H)
tW ts(L) ts(H)
1/fmax
tPHL tPLH
Q CP 1.3 V
1.3 V
Figure 1 Figure 2
Figure 3 Figure 4
AC LOAD CIRCUIT
VCC
RL SWITCH POSITIONS
SYMBOL SW1 SW2
SW1
tPZH Open Closed
tPZL Closed Open
TO OUTPUT
UNDER TEST tPLZ Closed Closed
tPHZ Closed Closed
5 kΩ
CL* SW2
SN54 / 74LS398
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
16 CASE 648-08
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
S Qa Qa I0a I1a I1b I0b Qb Qb GND 1
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10
D SUFFIX
VCC Qd I0d I1d I1c I0c Qc CP SOIC
16
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 1 CASE 751B-03
SN54 / 74LS399
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
CASE 732-03
20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1
S Qa I0a I1a I1b I0b Qb GND
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) CASE 738-03
20
HIGH LOW 1
IOA
S
S QA
IIA
R * Q
A
IOB
S QB
IIB
* Q
R B
IOC
S QC
IIC
R *
QC
IOD
S QD
IID
R * Q
D
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
The SN54 / 74LS398 and SN54 / 74LS399 are high-speed put (CP). The 4-Bit RS type output register is fully edge-trig-
Quad 2-Port Registers. They select four bits of data from two gered. The Data inputs (I) and Select inputs (S) must be stable
sources (Ports) under the control of a common Select Input only a setup time prior to and hold time after the LOW-to-HIGH
(S). The selected data is transferred to a 4-Bit Output Register transition of the Clock input for predictable operation. The
synchronous with the LOW-to-HIGH transition of the Clock in- SN54 / 74LS398 has both Q and Q Outputs available.
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
S I0 I1 Q Q*
I I X L H
I h X H L
h X I L H
h X h H L
*SN54 / 74LS398 only
I = LOW Voltage Level one setup time pior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
h = HIGH Voltage Level one setup time prior to the LOW-to-HIGH clock transition
L = LOW Voltage Level
H = HIGH Voltage Level
X = Immaterial
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
SETUP TIME(ts) — is defined as the minimum time required the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH that the logic level
for the correct logic level to be present at the logic input prior to must be maintained at the input in order to ensure continued
the clock transition from LOW-to-HIGH in order to be recog- recognition. A negative Hold Time indicates that the correct
nized and transferred to the outputs. logic level may be released prior to the clock transition from
HOLD TIME(th) — is defined as the minimum time following LOW-to-HIGH and still be recognized.
AC WAVEFORMS
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Q or Q 1.3 V Q = I0 1.3 V Q = I1
Figure 1 Figure 2
CP 1.3 V 1.3 V
tPHL
tPHL
Figure 3
*The shaded areas indicate when the input is permitted to change for predictable output performance.
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16 CASE 648-08
CPa MRa Q0a MSa Q1a Q2a Q3a GND
1
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPLH 24 39
Propagation Delay, CP to Q1 or Q3 ns Figure 3
tPHL 26 39 VCC = 5.0 V,
tPLH 32 54 CL = 15 pF
Propagation Delay, CP to Q2 ns Figure 2
tPHL 36 54
AC WAVEFORMS
Q 1.3 V 1.3 V
Figure 1
Figure 2
MS 1.3 V 1.3 V
tW trec
CP 1.3 V
tPLH
QO, Q3 1.3 V
Figure 3
*The number of Clock Pulses required between the tPHL and tPLH measurements can be determined from the Truth Table.
SN54 / 74LS540
VCC
N SUFFIX
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
PLASTIC
CASE 738-03
20
1
DW SUFFIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 SOIC
GND 20
CASE 751D-03
SN54 / 74LS541 1
VCC
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
GND
BLOCK DIAGRAM
LS540 LS541
(1) (1)
E1 E1
(19) (19)
E2 E2 INPUTS OUTPUTS
E1 E2 D LS540 LS541
(2) (18) (2) (18)
D1 Y1 D1 Y1 L L H L H
H X X Z Z
(3) (17) (3) (17) X H X Z Z
D2 Y2 D2 Y2 L L L H L
(4) (16) (4) (16) L = LOW Voltage Level
D3 Y3 D3 Y3 H = HIGH Voltage Level
(5) (15) (5) (15) X = Immaterial
D4 Y4 D4 Y4 Z = High Impedance
(6) (14) (6) (14)
D5 Y5 D5 Y5
(7) (13) (7) (13)
D6 Y6 D6 Y6
(8) (12) (8) (12)
D7 Y7 D7 Y7
(9) (11) (9) (11)
D8 Y8 D8 Y8
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54, 74 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = – 3.0 mA
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
54, 74 2.0 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIL = 0.5 V
LS541 32 mA
AC WAVEFORMS
VCC
VIN 1.3 V 1.3 V
RL
tPLH tPHL
VE
1.5 V 1.5 V
VE
tPZL tPLZ
DW SUFFIX
CONNECTION DIAGRAM (TOP VIEW)
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
VCC RCO CCO OE YA YB YC YD CET LOAD 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
VCC = PIN 20
GND = PIN 10 ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
Note: Pin 1 is marked SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
for orientation.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
U/D CP A B C D CEP ACLR SCLR GND
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
CP D C B A LOAD CET CEP U/D ACLR SCLR OE RCO CCO YD YC YB YA
↑ X X X X H L L H H H L A/R A/R (QT – CP) + 1 Count Up
↑ X X X X H L L L H H L A/R A/R (QT – CP) – 1 Count Down
↑ X X X X H H X X H H L H H NC NC NC NC Count Inhibit
↑ X X X X H L H X H H L A/R H NC NC NC NC Count Inhibit
Ω X X X X X L L H H H L L H H H H Overflow
↑ X X X X X L H H H H L L H H H H H Overflow
↑ X X X X X H X H H H L H H H H H H Overflow Inhibit
X X X X X L L L H H L L L L L L Underflow
↑ X X X X X L H L H H L L H L L L L Underflow
↑ X X X X X H X L H H L H H L L L L Underflow Inhibit
↑ L H L H L X X X H H L H H L H L H Load Example
↑ X X X X X H X H H L L H H L L L L Clear (Synchronous)
X X X X X L L L H L L L L L L L Clear (Synchronous)
↑ X X X X X L H L H L L L H L L L L Clear (Synchronous)
↑ X X X X X H X L H L L H H L L L L Clear (Synchronous)
X X X X X X X X H L X L H H L L L L Asynchronous Clear
X X X X X L L L L X L L L L L L Asynchronous Clear
X X X X X X L H L L X L L H L L L L Asynchronous Clear
X X X X X X H X L L X L H H L L L L Asynchronous Clear
X X X X X X X X X X X H X X Hi-Z Output Disabled
(QT — CP) = Output state prior to clock edge A/R = Assumes required output state; X = Don’t care
NC = No change High except during Overflow and Underflow
LOGIC DIAGRAM
OE
* ACLR
D Q
R
CP Q A * YA
B * YB
C * YC
D * YD
SCLR
LOAD
CEP
CET
CP
U/D RCO
CCO
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
tPZH 15
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 20
tPHZ 20
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 27
LOAD1 U/D1 COUNT1 ACLR1 OE1 LOAD2 U/D2 COUNT2 ACLR2 OE2
4 4 4 4
LS569A
LS569A
LS569A
4 8 4 4 8 4
8–BIT BUS
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1
ENABLE A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 GND
GAB
GAB
A1 B1
FUNCTION TABLE
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
FUNCTION TABLE CASE 732-03
20
CONTROL OPERATION 1
INPUTS
LS640 LS641
G DIR LS642 LS645 N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
L L B data to A bus B data to A bus
CASE 738-03
20
L H A data to B bus A data to B bus
1
H X Isolation Isolation
H = HIGH Level, L = LOW Level, X = Irrelevant
DW SUFFIX
SOIC
20
CASE 751D-03
1
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
DIR A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 GND DIR A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 GND
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
IOH Output HIGH Current 54, 74 100 µA VCC = MIN, VOH = MAX
RIPPLE QA QB QC QD ENABLE
CARRY T
OUTPUT LOAD
UP/DOWN
ENABLE
CK A B C D P
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
U/D CK A B C D ENABLE GND
P
DATA INPUTS
LOGIC DIAGRAM
(7) ENP
(10) ENT
(1) U/D
RCO (15)
(RIPPLE CARRY
OUTPUT)
(2) CP
CP D CP D CP D CP D
QA QB QC QD
(14) (13) (12) (11)
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
Others 20 µA
VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 2
2.7
7V
Enable T 40 µA
IIH Input HIGH Current
Others 0.1 mA
VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 7
7.0
0V
Enable T 0.2 mA
Others –0.4 mA
IIL Input LOW Current VCC = MAX,
MAX VIN = 0
0.4
4V
Enable T –0.8 mA
IOS Short Circuit Current (Note 1) – 20 – 100 mA VCC = MAX
ICC Power Supply Current 34 mA VCC = MAX
Note 1: Not more than one output should be shorted at a time, nor for more than 1 second.
tPLH 22 35
U/D to RCO ns
tPHL 26 40
tw(clock) tw(clock)
3V
CLOCK
INPUT 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
0V
ts ts
th
3V
LOAD 1.3 V 1.3 V
INPUT
0V
ts th
3V
DATA INPUTS
A,B,C, and D 1.3 V 1.3 V
0V
ts th
0V
ENABLE P or 1.3 V 1.3 V
ENABLE T
3V
ts th ts
th
3V
UP/DOWN 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V 1.3 V
INPUT
0V
VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS
3V
ENABLE T 1.3 V 1.3 V
INPUT
0V
tPHL tPLH
VOL
RIPPLE 1.3 V 1.3 V
CARRY
OUTPUT VOH
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
D2 D3 D4 RB RA Q4 Q3 GND
ORDERING INFORMATION
PIN NAMES LOADING (Note a) SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
HIGH LOW
SN74LSXXXD SOIC
D1 – D 4 Data Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
WA, WB Write Address Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L.
EW Write Enable (Active LOW) Input 1.0 U.L. 0.5 U.L.
RA, RB Read Address Inputs 0.5 U.L. 0.25 U.L. LOGIC SYMBOL
ER Read Enable (Active LOW) Input 1.5 U.L. 0.75 U.L.
Q1 – Q4 Outputs (Note b) 65 (25) U.L. 15 (7.5) U.L. 12 15 1 2 3
NOTES:
a) 1 TTL Unit Load (U.L.) = 40 µA HIGH/1.6 mA LOW.
b) The Output LOW drive factor is 7.5 U.L. for Military (54) and 15 U.L. for Commercial 14 WA EW D1 D2 D3 D4
(74) Temperature Ranges. The Output HIGH drive factor is 25 U.L. for Military and 13 WB
65 U.L. for Commercial Temperature Ranges. 5 RA
4 RB ER Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
11 10 9 7 6
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
LOGIC DIAGRAM
D4 D3 D2 D1
3 2 1 15
12
EW
13
WB
14
WA
WORD
0
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
1
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
2
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
WORD
3
G D G D G D G D
Q Q Q Q
4
RB
11
ER
5
RA
6 7 9 10
Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1
VCC = PIN 16
GND = PIN 8
= PIN NUMBERS
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.4 3.4 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.4 3.1 V or VIL per Truth Table
tPZH 15 35
Output Enable Time ns
tPZL 22 40
tPLZ 16 35
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPHZ 30 50
AC WAVEFORMS
Figure 1 Figure 2
ts th
1.3 V 1.3 V
D
ts th
tW
1.3 V 1.3 V
EW
Figure 3
N SUFFIX
PLASTIC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CASE 738-03
20
P>Q P0 Q0 P1 Q1 P2 Q2 P3 Q3 GND
1
DW SUFFIX
VCC P=Q Q7 P7 Q6 P6 Q5 P5 Q4 P4 SOIC
20
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 CASE 751D-03
1
SN54/74LS688
ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
G P0 Q0 P1 Q1 P2 Q2 P3 Q3 GND
FUNCTION TABLE
INPUTS OUTPUTS
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V VCC = MIN, IOH = MAX, VIN = VIH
VOH Output HIGH Voltage
74 2.7 3.5 V or VIL per Truth Table
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
(17)
P7
(18) (17)
Q7 P7
(15)
P6 (18)
(16)
Q6 Q7
(13)
P5 (15)
(14) P6
Q5
(11)
P4 (16)
(12) (19) Q6
Q4
(8)
P3 P=Q (13)
(9) P5
Q3
(6) (14)
P2 Q5
(7)
Q2
(4) (11)
P1 (5) P4
Q1
(2) (12)
P0 Q4
(3) (19)
Q0 (8)
P3 P=Q
(9)
Q3
(6)
P2
(7)
Q2
(4)
P1
(5)
Q1
(1)
P>Q (2)
P0
(3)
Q0
(1)
G
tPLH 14 25
Propagation Delay, Q to P = Q ns VCC = 5.0 V
tPHL 15 25
CL = 45 pF
F
tPLH
Propagation Delay, P to P > Q
20 30
ns RL = 667 Ω
tPHL 15 30
tPLH 21 30
Propagation Delay, Q to P > Q ns
tPHL 19 30
SN54/74LS684
Limits
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions
tPLH 15 25
Propagation Delay, P to P = Q ns
tPHL 17 25
tPLH 16 25
Propagation Delay, Q to P = Q ns VCC = 5.0 V
tPHL 15 25
CL = 45 pF
F
tPLH
Propagation Delay, P to P > Q
22 30
ns RL = 667 Ω
tPHL 17 30
tPLH 24 30
Propagation Delay, Q to P > Q ns
tPHL 20 30
SN54/74LS688
Limits
Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions
tPLH 12 18
Propagation Delay, P to P = Q ns
tPHL 17 23
VCC = 5.0 V
tPLH 12 18
Propagation Delay, Q to P = Q ns CL = 45 pF
tPHL 17 23
RL = 667 Ω
tPLH 12 18
Propagation Delay, G , G1 to P = Q ns
tPHL 13 20
TRUTH TABLES
J SUFFIX
CERAMIC
LS795 LS796 CASE 732-03
20
INPUTS OUTPUT INPUTS OUTPUT
1
G1 G2 A Y G1 G2 A Y
H X X Z H X X Z
N SUFFIX
X H X Z X H X Z
PLASTIC
L L H H L L H L
CASE 738-03
L L L L L L L H 20
1
H X Z H X Z
L H H L H L
L L L L L H ORDERING INFORMATION
SN54LSXXXJ Ceramic
SN74LSXXXN Plastic
SN74LSXXXDW SOIC
LOGIC DIAGRAMS
VCC G2 A8 Y8 A7 Y7 A6 Y6 A5 Y5 VCC G2 A8 Y8 A7 Y7 A6 Y6 A5 Y5
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
G1 A1 Y1 A2 Y2 A3 Y3 A4 Y4 GND G1 A1 Y1 A2 Y2 A3 Y3 A4 Y4 GND
SN54/74LS795 SN54/74LS796
VCC G2 A8 Y8 A7 Y7 A6 Y6 A5 Y5 VCC G2 A8 Y8 A7 Y7 A6 Y6 A5 Y5
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
G1 A1 Y1 A2 Y2 A3 Y3 A4 Y4 GND G1 A1 Y1 A2 Y2 A3 Y3 A4 Y4 GND
SN54/74LS797 SN54/74LS798
VIK Input Clamp Diode Voltage – 0.65 – 1.5 V VCC = MIN, IIN = – 18 mA
54 2.5 3.5 V
VOH Output HIGH Voltage VCC = MIN,
MIN IOH = MAX
74 2.7 3.5 V
tPHZ 13 20 13 20
Output Disable Time ns CL = 5.0 pF
tPLZ 19 27 18 27
Reliability Data 6
The “BETTER” program is offered on logic only, in dual-in-line ceramic and plastic packages.
“RAP”
Reliability Audit Program
for Logic Integrated Circuits
1.0 INTRODUCTION
The Reliability Audit Program developed in March 1977 is Handbook” which contains data for all Motorola Semiconduc-
the Motorola internal reliability audit which is designed to tors (#BR518S).
assess outgoing product performance under accelerated RAP is a system of environmental and electrical tests
stress conditions. Logic Reliability Engineering has overall performed periodically on randomly selected samples of
responsibility for RAP, including updating its requirements, standard products. Each sample receives the tests specified
interpreting its results, administration at offshore locations, in section 2.0. Frequency of testing is specified per internal
and monthly reporting of results. These reports are available document 12MRM15301A.
at all sales offices. Also available is the “Reliability and Quality
Initial
Seal**
Op Life
40 hours
PTHB PTH*** Temp Cycle
48 hrs 48 hrs 40 cycles
interim
electrical
interim
test
Op Life
Interim Add 460 cycles 210 hrs (Additional)
Electrical
interim
test Final
Interim#
Electrical
Add 500 cycles
final
PTH
interim*
48 hrs test
(Additional) Op Life#
750 hrs
(Additional)
Temp Cycle#
1000 cycles
(Additional) Final#
Final Final Electrical
Electrical Electrical (1000 hrs)
(48 hrs) (96 hrs) Final
Electrical
& Seal**
(2000 cycles)
NOTES:
3.0 TEST CONDITIONS AND COMMENTS 1. All standard 25°C dc and functional parameters will be
measured Go/No/Go at each readout.
PTHB — 15 psig/121°C/100% RH at rated VCC or VEE — 2. Any indicated failure is first verified and then submitted to
PTHB — to be performed on plastic encapsulated devices the Product Analysis Lab for detailed analysis.
PTHB — only. 3. Sampling to include all package types routinely.
4. Device types sampled will be by generic type within each
TEMP CYCLING — MIL-STD-883, Method 1010, Condition logic I/C product family (MECL, TTL, etc.) and will include
TEMP CYCLING — C, – 65°C/+150°C. all assembly locations (Korea, Philippines, Malaysia, etc.)
5. 16 hrs. PTHB is equivalent to approximately 800 hours of
OP LIFE — MIL-STD-883, Method 1005, Condition C 85°C/85% RH THB for VCC ≤ 15 V.
OP LIFE — (Power plus Reverse Bias), TA = 145°C. 6. Only moisture related failures (like corrosion) are criteria
for failure on PTHB test.
7. Special device specifications (48A’s) for logic products will
reference 12MRM15301A as source of generic data for
any customer required monthly audit reports.
Package Information
Including 7
Surface Mount
BIPOLAR LOGIC SURFACE MOUNT
WHY SURFACE MOUNT? Automatic placement equipment is available that can place
Surface Mount components at the rate of a few thousand per
Surface Mount Technology is now being utilized to offer an-
hour to hundreds of thousands of components per hour.
swers to many problems that have been created in the use of
Surface Mount Technology is cost effective, allowing the
insertion technology.
manufacturer the opportunity to produce smaller units and/or
Limitations have been reached with insertion packages and
offer increased functions with the same size product.
PC board technology. Surface Mount Technology offers the
opportunity to continue to advance the State-of-the-Art de-
signs that cannot be accomplished with Insertion Technology. SURFACE MOUNT AVAILABILITY
Surface Mount Packages allow more optimum device per-
formance with the smaller Surface Mount configuration. Inter- Bipolar Logic is currently offering LS-TTL and FAST-TTL in
nal lead lengths, parasitic capacitance and inductance that production quantities in SOIC packages.
placed limitations on chip performance have been reduced. Refer to the following Selector Guide (SG366/D) which indi-
The lower profile of Surface Mount Packages allows more cate availability and package type for these families.
boards to be utilized in a given amount of space. They are These families may be ordered in rails or on Tape and Reel.
stacked closer together and utilize less total volume than in- Refer to Tape and Reel information for ordering details.
sertion populated PC boards.
Printed circuit costs are lowered with the reduction of the THERMAL DATA
number of board layers required. The elimination or reduction
of the number of plated through holes in the board, contribute The power dissipation of surface mount packages is depen-
significantly to lower PC board prices. dent on many factors that must be taken into consideration in
Surface Mount assembly does not require the preparation the initial board design. The board material, the board surface
of components that are common on insertion technology lines. metal thickness, pad area and the proximity to other heat gen-
Surface Mount components are sent directly to the assembly erating components all have a bearing on the device dissipa-
line, eliminating an intermediate step. tion capability.
200
180
160
°C/W MIN DIE SIZE
2K MILS2
θJA
140
Measurement specimens are solder mounted on printed cir- This data was collected using thermal test die in 20-pin PLCC
cuit card 19 mm × 28 mm × 1.5 mm in still air. No auxiliary ther- packages on PLCC test boards (2.24″ x 2.24″ x .062″ glass
mal condition aids are used. epoxy, type FR-4, with solder coated 1 oz./sq. ft. copper).
MECHANICAL POLARIZATION
SOIC DEVICES
Typical
GENERAL INFORMATION
— Reel Size 13 inch (330 mm) Suffix R2
— Tape Width 12 mm to 24 mm (see table)
— Units/Reel (see table)
— No Partial Reel Counts Available and Minimum Lot Size is Per Table
ORDERING INFORMATION
To order devices which are to be delivered in Tape and Reel, add the suffix R2 to the device number being ordered.
8 PL MILLIMETERS INCHES
1
8 DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 9.80 10.00 0.386 0.393
B 3.80 4.00 0.150 0.157
R X 45° C 1.35 1.75 0.054 0.068
G C D 0.35 0.49 0.014 0.019
F 0.40 1.25 0.016 0.049
G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
-T- J 0.19 0.25 0.008 0.009
SEATING
PLANE M F J K 0.10 0.25 0.004 0.009
D 16 PL K M 0° 7° 0° 7°
P 5.80 6.20 0.229 0.244
0.25 (0.010) M T B S A S
R 0.25 0.50 0.010 0.019
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
G A 15.25 15.54 0.601 0.612
B 7.40 7.60 0.292 0.299
C 2.35 2.65 0.093 0.104
R X 45° D 0.35 0.49 0.014 0.019
F 0.41 0.90 0.016 0.035
-T- C SEATING G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
PLANE J 0.229 0.317 0.0090 0.0125
M F J K 0.127 0.292 0.0050 0.0115
D 24 PL K M 0° 8° 0° 8°
P 10.05 10.55 0.395 0.415
0.25 (0.010) M T B S A S R 0.25 0.75 0.010 0.029
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 19.05 19.94 0.750 0.785
B 6.23 7.11 0.245 0.280
C 3.94 5.08 0.155 0.200
-T- D 0.39 0.50 0.015 0.020
SEATING K F 1.40 1.65 0.055 0.065
PLANE G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
M J 0.21 0.38 0.008 0.015
F G N K 3.18 4.31 0.125 0.170
D 14 PL J 14 PL L 7.62 BSC 0.300 BSC
M 0° 15° 0° 15°
0.25 (0.010) M T A S 0.25 (0.010) M T B S N 0.51 1.01 0.020 0.040
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 19.05 19.55 0.750 0.770
B 6.10 7.36 0.240 0.290
-T- — 4.19 — 0.165
C
SEATING K D 0.39 0.53 0.015 0.021
PLANE
E 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
F 1.40 1.77 0.055 0.070
E N M G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
J 0.23 0.27 0.009 0.011
F G J 16 PL K — 5.08 — 0.200
D 16 PL L 7.62 BSC 0.300 BSC
0.25 (0.010) M T B S
M 0° 15° 0° 15°
0.25 (0.010) M T A S N 0.39 0.88 0.015 0.035
B MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A A 23.88 25.15 0.940 0.990
L B 6.60 7.49 0.260 0.295
F C C 3.81 5.08 0.150 0.200
D 0.38 0.56 0.015 0.022
F 1.40 1.65 0.055 0.065
G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
H 0.51 1.27 0.020 0.050
N J J 0.20 0.30 0.008 0.012
SEATING K 3.18 4.06 0.125 0.160
H PLANE K M L 7.62 BSC 0.300 BSC
D G M 0° 15° 0° 15°
N 0.25 1.02 0.010 0.040
24 13 NOTES:
1. DIMENSION L TO CENTER OF LEADS WHEN
B FORMED PARALLEL.
2. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
1 12 Y14.5, 1973.
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 31.50 32.64 1.240 1.285
B 7.24 7.75 0.285 0.305
-A- C 3.68 4.44 0.145 0.175
L D 0.38 0.53 0.015 0.021
F C
F 1.14 1.57 0.045 0.062
G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
J 0.20 0.33 0.008 0.013
K 2.54 4.19 0.100 0.165
-T- N K J L 7.62 7.87 0.300 0.310
SEATING N 0.51 1.27 0.020 0.050
PLANE
P P 9.14 10.16 0.360 0.400
G
D 20 PL
INSIDE OF LEADS
0.25 (0.010) M T A M
MILLIMETERS INCHES
F
C L DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 18.80 19.55 0.740 0.770
S B 6.35 6.85 0.250 0.270
SEATING C 3.69 4.44 0.145 0.175
-T- PLANE D 0.39 0.53 0.015 0.021
F 1.02 1.77 0.040 0.070
G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
H K J M H 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
J 0.21 0.38 0.008 0.015
G K 2.80 3.30 0.110 0.130
D 16 PL L 7.50 7.74 0.295 0.305
M 0° 10° 0° 10°
0.25 (0.010) M T A M
0.51 1.01 0.020 0.040
S
MILLIMETERS INCHES
1 20 DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 51.69 52.45 2.035 2.065
B 13.72 14.22 0.540 0.560
A L C 3.94 5.08 0.155 0.200
C D 0.36 0.56 0.014 0.022
F 1.02 1.52 0.040 0.060
N G 2.54 BSC 0.100 BSC
H 1.65 2.16 0.065 0.085
J J 0.20 0.38 0.008 0.015
K 2.92 3.43 0.115 0.135
K M L 15.24 BSC 0.600 BSC
H G F D
M 0° 15° 0° 15°
SEATING
PLANE N 0.51 1.02 0.020 0.040
D U 0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
-L- -M-
Z1
W
D
20 1
-P-
V X G1
VIEW D-D 0.25 (0.010) M T N S –P S L S –M S
A 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
Z
R 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
H
0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
C
E K1
0.10 (0.004) K
G J -T- SEATING
PLANE 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
F
DETAIL S 0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
G1 DETAIL S
0.25 (0.010) S T L S –M S N S –P S
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 9.78 10.03 0.385 0.395
B 9.78 10.03 0.385 0.395
C 4.20 4.57 0.165 0.180
E 2.29 2.79 0.090 0.110
F 0.33 0.48 0.013 0.019
G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC
H 0.66 0.81 0.026 0.032
J 0.51 — 0.020 —
NOTES:
K 0.64 — 0.025 —
1. DATUMS -L-, -M-, -N-, AND -P- DETERMINED
R 8.89 9.04 0.350 0.356
WHERE TOP OF LEAD SHOULDER EXIT PLASTIC
U 8.89 9.04 0.350 0.356 BODY AT MOLD PARTING LINE.
V 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 2. DIM GI, TRUE POSITION TO BE MEASURED AT
W 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 DATUM -T-, SEATING PLANE.
X 1.07 1.42 0.042 0.056 3. DIM R AND U DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
Y — 0.50 — 0.020 PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE MOLD PROTRUSION
Z 2° 10° 2° 10° IS 0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE.
G1 7.88 8.38 0.310 0.330 4. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
K1 1.02 — 0.040 — Y14.5M, 1982.
Z1 2° 10° 2° 10° 5. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
6. 775-01 IS OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD 775-02.
D U 0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
-L- -M-
28
LEADS
ACTUAL Z1
W
D
28 1
-P-
V G1
X 0.25 (0.010) M T N S –P S L S –M S
VIEW D-D
A 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
Z
R 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
H
0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
C K1
E
0.10 (0.004) K
G J -T- SEATING 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
PLANE F
DETAIL S 0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
DETAIL S
G1
0.25 (0.010) S T L S –M S N S –P S
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 12.32 12.57 0.485 0.495
B 12.32 12.57 0.485 0.495
C 4.20 4.57 0.165 0.180
E 2.29 2.79 0.090 0.110
F 0.33 0.48 0.013 0.019 NOTES:
G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC 1. DUE TO SPACE LIMITATION, CASE 776-02 SHALL
H 0.66 0.81 0.026 0.032 BE REPRESENTED BY A GENERAL (SMALLER)
J 0.51 — 0.020 — CASE OUTLINE DRAWING RATHER THAN
K 0.64 — 0.025 — SHOWING ALL 28 LEADS.
R 11.43 11.58 0.450 0.456 2. DATUMS -L-, -M-, -N-, AND -P- DETERMINED
U 11.43 11.58 0.450 0.456 WHERE TOP OF LEAD SHOULDER EXIT PLASTIC
V 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 BODY AT MOLD PARTING LINE.
W 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 3. DIM G1, TRUE POSITION TO BE MEASURED AT
X 1.07 1.42 0.042 0.056 DATUM -T-, SEATING PLANE.
4. DIM R AND U DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
Y — 0.50 — 0.020
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE MOLD PROTRUSION
Z 2° 10° 2° 10° IS 0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE.
G1 10.42 10.92 0.410 0.430 5. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
K1 1.02 — 0.040 — Y14.5M, 1982.
Z1 2° 10° 2° 10° 6. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
7. 776-01 IS OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD 776-02.
D U 0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
-L- -M-
68
LEADS
ACTUAL Z1
W
D
68 1
-P-
V G1
X 0.25 (0.010) M T N S –P S L S –M S
VIEW D-D
A 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
Z
0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
R 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S H
0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
C K1
E
K
0.10 (0.004)
G J -T- SEATING 0.18 (0.007) M T L S –M S N S –P S
PLANE F
0.18 (0.007) M T N S –P S L S –M S
DETAIL S
DETAIL S
G1
0.25 (0.010) S T L S –M S N S –P S
MILLIMETERS INCHES
DIM MIN MAX MIN MAX
A 25.02 25.27 0.985 0.995 NOTES:
B 25.02 25.27 0.985 0.995 1. DUE TO SPACE LIMITATION, CASE
C 4.20 4.57 0.165 0.180 779-02 SHALL BE REPRESENTED BY A
E 2.29 2.79 0.090 0.110 GENERAL (SMALLER) CASE OUTLINE
F 0.33 0.48 0.013 0.019 DRAWING RATHER THAN SHOWING
G 1.27 BSC 0.050 BSC ALL 68 LEADS.
H 0.66 0.81 0.026 0.032 2. DATUMS -L-, -M-, -N-, AND -P-
J 0.51 — 0.020 — DETERMINED WHERE TOP OF LEAD
K 0.64 — 0.025 — SHOULDER EXIT PLASTIC BODY AT
MOLD PARTING LINE.
R 24.13 24.28 0.950 0.956
3. DIM G1, TRUE POSITION TO BE
U 24.13 24.28 0.950 0.956 MEASURED AT DATUM -T-, SEATING
V 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 PLANE.
W 1.07 1.21 0.042 0.048 4. DIM R AND U DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
X 1.07 1.42 0.042 0.056 PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE MOLD
Y — 0.50 — 0.020 PROTRUSION IS 0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE.
Z 2° 10° 2° 10° 5. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING
G1 23.12 23.62 0.910 0.930 PER ANSI Y14.5M, 1982.
K1 1.02 — 0.040 — 6. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
Z1 2° 10° 2° 10° 7. 779-01 IS OBSOLETE, NEW STANDARD
779-02.